6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
INSTRUCTION MANUAL
TRANSFORMER PROTECTION RELAY
GRT100 - ∗∗∗D
© TOSHIBA Corporation 2007
All Rights Reserved.
( Ver. 4.0 )
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
DANGER
•
Current transformer circuit
Never allow the current transformer (CT) secondary circuit connected to this equipment to be
opened while the primary system is live. Opening the CT circuit will produce a dangerous high
voltage.
WARNING
•
Exposed terminals
Do not touch the terminals of this equipment while the power is on, as the high voltage generated
is dangerous.
•
Residual voltage
Hazardous voltage can be present in the DC circuit just after switching off the DC power supply. It
takes about 30 seconds for the voltage to discharge.
•
Fiber optic
Do not view directly with optical instruments.
CAUTION
•
Earth
Earth the earthing terminal of the equipment securely.
CAUTION
•
Operation conditions
Use the equipment within the range of ambient temperature, humidity and dust as detailed in the
specification and in an environment free of abnormal vibration.
•
Ratings
Before applying AC voltage and current or DC power supply to the equipment, check that they
conform to the equipment ratings.
•
Printed circuit board
Do not attach and remove the printed circuit board while the DC power to the equipment is on, as
this may cause the equipment to malfunction.
•
External circuit
When connecting the output contacts of the equipment to an external circuit, carefully check the
supply voltage used and prevent the connected circuit from overheating.
•
Connection cable
Carefully handle the connection cable without applying excessive force.
Modification
•
Do not modify this equipment, as this may cause the equipment to malfunction, and any such
modifications will invalidate the warranty.
•
Short-link
Do not remove a short-link which is mounted at the terminal block on the rear of the relay before
⎯ 2 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
shipment, as this may cause the performance of this equipment such as withstand voltage, etc., to
reduce.
•
Disposal
When disposing of this product, do so in a safe manner according to local regulations.
This product contains a lithium-ion battery, which should be removed at the end-of-life of the
product. The battery must be recycled or disposed of in accordance with local regulations. The
battery can be removed by withdrawing the Signal Processing module (SPM) from the relay case,
and cutting the connecting leads and plastic strap which hold the battery.
⎯ 3 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Contents
Safety Precautions
1
8
1. Introduction
2. Application Notes
10
10
12
12
16
18
22
23
34
38
43
44
46
48
49
51
51
52
52
54
55
55
57
57
2.1 Protection Scheme
2.2 Current Differential Protection
2.2.1 Differential Scheme
2.2.2 Stability for CT Saturation during Through-fault Conditions
2.2.3 Matching of CT Secondary Currents
2.2.4 Connection between CT Secondary Circuit and the GRT100
2.2.5 Setting
2.3 Restricted Earth Fault Protection
2.4 Overcurrent Protection
2.5 Thermal Overload Protection
2.6 Frequency Protection
2.7 Overexcitation Protection
2.8 Trip by External Devices
2.9 Tripping Output
2.10 Characteristics of Measuring Elements
2.10.1 Percentage Current Differential Element DIF
2.10.2 High-set Overcurrent Element HOC
2.10.3 Restricted Earth Fault Element REF
2.10.4 Inverse Time Overcurrent Element OCI and EFI
2.10.5 Definite Time Overcurrent element OC and EF
2.10.6 Thermal Overload Element THR
2.10.7 Frequency Element FRQ
2.10.8 Overexcitation Element V/F
3. Technical Description
58
58
58
61
62
63
67
69
69
70
71
72
72
72
73
3.1 Hardware Description
3.1.1 Outline of Hardware Modules
3.1.2 Transformer Module
3.1.3 Signal Processing Module
3.1.4 Binary Input and Output Module
3.1.5 Human Machine Interface (HMI) Module
3.2 Input and Output Signals
3.2.1 Input Signals
3.2.2 Binary Output Signals
3.2.3 PLC (Programmable Logic Controller) Function
3.3 Automatic Supervision
3.3.1 Basic Concept of Supervision
3.3.2 Relay Monitoring and Testing
3.3.3 PLC Data and IEC61850 Mapping Data Monitoring
⎯ 4 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.3.4 IEC61850 Communication Monitoring
3.3.5 Failure Alarms
73
73
74
74
75
75
76
76
78
3.3.6 Trip Blocking
3.3.7 Setting
3.4 Recording Function
3.4.1 Fault Recording
3.4.2 Event Recording
3.4.3 Disturbance Recording
3.5 Metering Function
4. User Interface
79
79
4.1 Outline of User Interface
4.1.1 Front Panel
79
4.1.2 Communication Ports
4.2 Operation of the User Interface
4.2.1 LCD and LED Displays
4.2.2 Relay Menu
81
82
82
84
4.2.3 Displaying Records
4.2.4 Displaying the Status
4.2.5 Viewing the Settings
4.2.6 Changing the Settings
4.2.7 Testing
87
90
95
95
114
118
118
118
119
120
120
4.3 Personal Computer Interface
4.4 Communication Interface
4.4.1 RSM (Relay Setting and Monitoring System)
4.4.2 IEC 60870-5-103 Interface
4.4.3 IEC 61850 interface
4.5 Clock Function
5. Installation
121
121
121
121
121
122
5.1 Receipt of Relays
5.2 Relay Mounting
5.3 Electrostatic Discharge
5.4 Handling Precautions
5.5 External Connections
6. Commissioning and Maintenance
6.1 Outline of Commissioning Tests
6.2 Cautions
123
123
124
124
124
125
126
126
127
128
129
6.2.1 Safety Precautions
6.2.2 Cautions on Tests
6.3 Preparations
6.4 Hardware Tests
6.4.1 User Interfaces
6.4.2 Binary Input Circuit
6.4.3 Binary Output Circuit
6.4.4 AC Input Circuits
⎯ 5 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5 Function Test
6.5.1 Measuring Element
130
130
146
148
148
149
149
149
151
151
151
153
155
155
6.5.2 Timer Test
6.5.3 Protection Scheme
6.5.4 Metering and Recording
6.6 Conjunctive Tests
6.6.1 On Load Test
6.6.2 Tripping Circuit Test
6.7 Maintenance
6.7.1 Regular Testing
6.7.2 Failure Tracing and Repair
6.7.3 Replacing Failed Modules
6.7.4 Resumption of Service
6.7.5 Storage
7. Putting Relay into Service
156
⎯ 6 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix A Block Diagram
157
159
179
181
185
193
199
207
241
247
253
261
267
271
275
287
321
325
331
Appendix B Signal List
Appendix C Variable Timer List
Appendix D Binary Output Default Setting List
Appendix E Details of Relay Menu and LCD & Button Operation
Appendix F Case Outline
Appendix G External Connections
Appendix H Relay Setting Sheet
Appendix I Commissioning Test Sheet (sample)
Appendix J Return Repair Form
Appendix K Technical Data
Appendix L Setting of REF Element
Appendix M Symbols Used in Scheme Logic
Appendix N Implementation of Thermal Model to IEC60255-8
Appendix O IEC60870-5-103: Interoperability and Troublehsooting
Appendix P IEC61850: MICS & PICS
Appendix Q Inverse Time Characteristics
Appendix R Failed Module Tracing and Replacement
Appendix S Ordering
„ The data given in this manual are subject to change without notice. (Ver.4.0)
⎯ 7 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
1. Introduction
GRT100 provides high-speed transformer and reactor protection, and realises high dependability
and security for diverse faults such as single-phase faults, multi-phase faults, overload and
over-excitation.
GRT100 is used as a main protection and backup protection of the following transformers and
reactors.
• Two-winding or three-winding power transformers
• Auto-transformers
• Generator-transformer units
• Shunt reactors
GRT100 is designed to provide stability under magnetizing inrush and overexcitation conditions.
GRT100 is available for mixed 1A/5A inputs
GRT100 provides the following metering and recording functions.
• Metering
• Fault records
• Event records
• Disturbance records
GRT100 provides the following human interfaces for relay setting or viewing of stored data.
• Relay front panel:
• Local PC
LCD, LED display and operation keys
• Remote PC
Password protection is provided to change settings. Eight active setting groups are provided. This
allows the user to set one group for normal operating conditions while other groups may be set to
cover alternative operating conditions by binary input using the PLC.
GRT100 can provide the following serial interface ports:
-
-
RS232C for a local PC and Relay Setting and Monitoring System (RSM100)
RS485 for a remote PC, and Relay Setting and Monitoring System (RSM100) or Substation
control and Automation System (SAS) with IEC60870-5-103 protocol
-
-
Fibre Optic (FO, option) for a remote PC, and Relay Setting and Monitoring System
(RSM100) or Substation control and Automation System (SAS) with IEC60870-5-103
protocol
100BASE-TX, or -FX (option) for Substation control and Automation System (SAS) with
IEC61850 protocol
Another interface IRIG-B port is provided for an external clock connection.
The RS232C port is located on the front panel of the relay. Other ports (RS485, FO, 100BASE-TX
and IRIG-B) are located on the rear of the relay.
Further, the GRT100 provides the following functions.
⎯ 8 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
-
-
-
Configurable binary inputs and outputs
Programmable logic for I/O configuration, alarms, indications, recording, etc.
Automatic supervision
GRT100 has two model series which differ according to the number of three-phase current inputs
for differential protection as follows:
Relay Type and Model
Relay Type:
- Type GRT100; Numerical transformer protection relay
Relay Model:
- Model 100 series; 2 three-phase current inputs, applied to two-winding transformers
• Model 101; 16 binary inputs, 13 binary outputs, 5 binary outputs for tripping
• Model 102; 16 binary inputs, 23 binary outputs, 5 binary outputs for tripping
- Model 200 series; 3 three-phase current inputs, applied to two- and three-winding transformers
• Model 201; 16 binary inputs, 13 binary outputs, 5 binary outputs for tripping
• Model 202; 16 binary inputs, 23 binary outputs, 5 binary outputs for tripping
• Model 203; 15 binary inputs (12-independent), 13 binary outputs, 3 binary outputs for tripping
• Model 204; 15 binary inputs (12-independent), 23 binary outputs, 3 binary outputs for tripping
Model 100 series have 2 three-phase current inputs and can be applied to two-winding
transformers. Model 200 series have 3 three-phase current inputs and can be applied to two- and
three-winding transformers.
⎯ 9 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2. Application Notes
GRT100 is applied to both main protection and backup protection for the following transformers
and reactors:
• Two-winding or three-winding power transformers
• Auto-transformers
• Generator-transformer units
• Shunt reactors
2.1 Protection Scheme
GRT100 provides the following protection schemes with measuring elements in parentheses.
Appendix A shows the block diagrams of the GRT100 series.
• Current differential protection (DIFT)
• Restricted earth fault protection (1REF-3REF)
• Time-overcurrent protection (1OC-3OC, 1OCI-3OCI, 1EF-3EF and 1EFI-3EFI)
• Thermal overload protection (THR)
• Frequency protection (FRQ)
• Overexcitation protection (V/F)
• Trip and/or indication of external devices (Buchholtz relay, pressure or temperature sensing
devices etc.)
The DIFT, provided with DIF and HOC elements and the REF are applied for main protection. For
details, see Sections 2.2, 2.3 and 2.10.
They provide transformer protection coverage as follows:
REF: protection for winding to earth faults of star-winding side
DIF: protection for all internal transformer faults (The DIF can be blocked by 2F or 5F
element.)
HOC: protection for all internal transformer faults, specifically for heavy internal faults,
high-speed operation (The HOC is not blocked by 2F or 5F element. The sensitivity is
set above the estimated maximum inrush current.)
DIF
HOC
REF
For earth fault only
Small
Large
Differential current
The number of measuring elements for the restricted earth fault protection and time-overcurrent
protection is dependent on the relay models.
Figure 2.1.1, 2.1.2 and 2.1.3 show typical application and the relationship between AC inputs and
the measuring elements applied in each model.
⎯ 10 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GRT100
1OC/1OCI
THR
1CT
VT
FRQ
V/F
Calculate 3I
HV
LV
0
1nCT
1EF/1EFI
1REF
DIFT
2nCT
2CT
2OC/2OCI
2EF/2EFI
Calculate 3I
0
2REF
Figure 2.1.1 Measuring Elements of Model 100 series
GRT100
1OC/1OCI
FRQ
1CT
THR
VT
Calculate 3I
V/F
0
HV
MV
1REF
1nCT
3nCT
LV
1EF/1EFI
DIFT
3CT
2nCT
2OC/2OCI
2CT
Calculate 3I
0
2REF
2EF/2EFI
3OC/3OCI
Calculate 3I
0
3EF/3EFI
3REF
Figure 2.1.2 Measuring Elements of Model 200 series
GRT100
1OC/1OCI
1CT
2OC/2OCI
2CT
VT
Calculate 3I
0
FRQ
V/F
HV
LV
Calculate 3I
0
1nCT
1EF/1EFI
1REF
DIFT
3CT
3OC/3OCI
Figure 2.1.3 Measuring Elements of Model 200 series
⎯ 11 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2 Current Differential Protection
2.2.1 Differential Scheme
Current differential protection DIFT provides an overall transformer protection deriving phase
current from each transformer winding, calculating the differential current on a per phase basis
and detecting phase-to-phase and phase-to-earth faults.
The current differential protection is based on Kirchhoff’s first law that the vector summation of
all currents flowing into a protected zone must be zero. Figure 2.2.1.1 shows the principle of
current differential protection. Differential current (id) is the vector summation of all terminal
current of the transformer. The differential current (id=i1+i2) is zero because the current (i1)
equals current (−i2) during a load condition or an external fault. During an internal fault, the
differential current (id) is not zero because the current (i1) does not equal to the current (−i2), and
the DIFT operates.
Primary
Secondary
I2
I1
Transformer
id=i1+i2
i1
i2
Differential current
detection
DIFT
Figure 2.2.1.1 Current Differential Protection
Scheme logic
Figure 2.2.1.2 shows the scheme logic of the current differential protection. Current differential
element DIFT comprises sub-elements HOC, DIF, 2F and 5F which operate for differential
current on a per phase basis.
Note: For the symbols used in the scheme logic, see Appendix M.
HOC is a high-set overcurrent element operating for differential current. It provides high-speed
protection for heavy internal faults.
DIF is a percentage restraining element and has dual restraining characteristics, a weak restraint in
the small current region and a strong restraint in the large current region, to cope with erroneous
differential current which may be caused due to output imbalance of the CTs in case of an external
fault. (For the characteristics, see Section 2.10.)
The DIF output signal can be blocked when the 2F or 5F elements detect second harmonic inrush
current during transformer energization or fifth harmonic components during transformer
overexcitation. Blocking is enabled by setting scheme switch [2F-LOCK] or [5F-LOCK] to “ON”.
The following two or three blocking schemes are selectable by scheme switch [DIFTPMD].
“3POR”: When any one phase of the 2F or 5F element operates, tripping by the DIF
element is blocked in all 3 phases. “3POR” is recommended for transformers with
large capacity whose second harmonic component may be low. Its blocking
function is stronger than that of the “1P” or “2PAND” below.
“1P”:
When any phase of the 2F or 5F elements operate, only the corresponding phase
output of the DIF element is blocked.
“2PAND”: Even if 2F or 5F element operates during manetising inrush, the trip by DIF
element is allowed when any two phases or more of DIF element operate.
⎯ 12 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
“2PAND” is recommended for a transformer with small or midium capacity
whose second harmonic component in inrush current is genarally higher than that
of transformer with large capacity. This mode is applicable if [Phase matching] is
set to “Beta”.
Protection by DIF and HOC can perform instantaneous three-phase tripping of up to five breakers.
Any of the five breaker tripping signals DIFT-1 to DIFT-5 are enabled or disabled by the scheme
switch [DIF1] to [DIF5] settings.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with DIFT-4 and DIFT-5, and perform tripping of up to
three breakers.
DIFT
HOC-A
41
TRIP
DIFT-1
HOC
374
224
42
43
&
&
&
&
&
≥1
HOC-B
HOC-C
≥1
DIF1
+
121 DIF
DIFT-2
DIF2
+
44
DIF-A
DIF-B
DIF-C
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
≥1
≥1
45
46
DIFT-3
DIF3
&
&
&
&
+
DIFT-4 (*1)
DIFT-5 (*1)
DIF4
95
96
+
&
&
&
≥1
1
1
1
2F-A
2F-B
2F-C
≥1
≥1
≥1
DIF5
+
330
331
352
97
DIF
DIFT-DIF TP
DIFT-HOC TP
DIFT TRIP
&
&
&
98
HOC
&
&
&
5F-A
5F-B
5F-C
&
&
&
&
≥1
99
≥1
DIFTPMD
100
3POR
1P
+
2PAND (*2)
&
≥1
&
122
123
2F-Lock
5F-Lock
≥1
1
1
+
+
≥1
1
DIF-A_BLOCK
DIF-B_BLOCK
DIF-C_BLOCK
1616
Note:
1
1
1617
1618
(*1) Models 203 and 204 are not provided with DIFT-4 and DIFT-5.
(*2) [Phase matching]="Beta" setting only
Figure 2.2.1.2 Scheme Logic of Current Differential Protection
⎯ 13 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Display mode following differential tripping
Following a trip output, GRT100 can display either the operating phase or the faulted phase
according to the user’s requirements as shown in Table 2.2.1.1. The operating phase or faulted
phase display is selectable by a setting in the Record menu.
Table 2.2.1.1 Operating Phase / Faulted Phase Display
Operating phase display
Faulted phase display
Setting
1 = Operating
2 = Fault
(Setting/Record/Fault
record/Phase mode)
Displayed phase
Operating phase
Faulted phase (for single-phase to earth, phase to
phase, two-phase to earth and three-phase to
earth faults)
Generally, the operating phase of the DIF element
does not correspond with the faulted phase, but
depends on the transformer configuration and the
electrical quantities that are input to the GRT100
current differential calculation.
Application
All two- and three-winding transformers
• Faults at primary side or secondary side of Yy0
and Yy6 transformers
• Faults at primary side of Yd1, Yd3, Yd5, Yd7,
Yd9, Yd11, Yy2, Yy4, Yy8 and Yy10
transformers
• Faults at secondary side of Dy1, Dy3, Dy5, Dy7,
Dy9 and Dy11 transformers
• Faults on Dd2, Dd4, Dd6, Dd8 and Dd10
transformers, faults at Zig-zag connected side
of transformers and faults at tertiary side of
three-winding transformers are not supported.
Logic
Refer to Figure 2.2.1.4.
Refer to Figure 2.2.1.4.
∗ Phase (A/B/C) display is based on the operating ∗ Phase (A/B/C) display is based on the operating
signal of DIF or HOC element, and “N” display is
based on the operating signal of REF and DIFT
elements. If the REF is not used, “N” is not
displayed.
signal of DIF or HOC element and a differential
current value, and “N” display is based on the
operating signal of REF and DIFT elements. If the
REF is not used, “N” is not displayed.
⎯ 14 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
DIFT
HOC-A
[Operating phase]
Phase A
41
42
43
≥1
≥1
≥1
HOC-B
HOC-C
Phase B
Phase C
121
DIF
≥1
&
&
&
44
&
Phase N
DIF-A
DIF-B
DIF-C
&
&
&
45
46
Faulted phase
selection logic
95
96
1REF
&
&
&
≥1
&
&
&
1
1
1
2F-A
2F-B
2F-C
≥1
≥1
≥1
≥1
1REF1
+
97
1REF5
+
[Faulted phase]
2REF
98
99
&
&
&
5F-A
5F-B
5F-C
≥1
2REF1
+
2REF5
+
100
3REF
2F-Lock
5F-Lock
≥1
+
+
3REF1
+
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with 1REF-4,
1REF-5, 2REF-4, 2REF-5, 3REF-4 and 3REF-5.
3REF5
+
Figure 2.2.1.4 Operating Phase and Faulted Phase Selection Logic
⎯ 15 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2.2 Stability for CT Saturation during Through-fault Conditions
For current differential protection of transformers, GRT100 has a strong restraint characteristic in
the large current region for erroneous differential current due to CT saturation. Further, GRT100
provides a CT saturation countermeasure function. If any CTs saturate due to a large through-fault
current, an apparent differential current is generated in the differential circuit and may cause false
operation of the differential protection.
Operation Principle
Even when a CT saturates under very large primary currents, the waveform of the saturated CT
secondary current has two identifiable periods in each cycle: a non-saturated period and a
saturated period. The GRT100 utilizes this phenomenon and provides very secure operation for
external faults with a large through-fault current.
Figure 2.2.2.1 shows a block diagram of the CT saturation countermeasure (CTS). The CTS has a
waveform discriminating element (WDE) and starting element (SE). WDE operates if the change
in the instantaneous value of the differential current is less than a specified percentage of the
change in the instantaneous value of the restraining current. In the CTs non-saturated period, the
differential current is theoretically zero for through-fault currents. The element operates in this
period.
Current
Input
Differential Element
(DIFT_DIF)
Tripping
Output
[CTSEN]
ON
&
Waveform Discriminating
Element
0
t
&
Starting Element
CTS
Figure 2.2.2.1 Differential Element with CT Saturation Countermeasure
The algorithm of this element is given by the following equation:
ΔId < 0.15×(ΔIp + ΔIn)
where,
ΔId : Change in the differential current Id
(ΔIp + ΔIn) : Change in the restraining current in the positive and negative cycles
Id : Differential current
Ip : Sum of positive input currents
In : Sum of negative input currents
SE operates when the sum of the absolute values of the difference between the instantaneous
values of current data at each current input from one cycle is greater than 0.5 × (CT secondary
rated current).
SE discriminates between healthy and faulty power system conditions and blocks the output of
WDE which may otherwise operate during healthy conditions.
Figure 2.2.2.2 shows CT secondary current waveforms of the incoming and outgoing terminals,
⎯ 16 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
and also the differential current at the time of an external fault with outgoing terminal CT
saturation.
Incoming terminal
current
Outgoing terminal
current
Differential
current
No change period
Figure 2.2.2.2 CT Secondary Current Waveforms and Differential Current for an External
Fault with CT Saturation
From the inception of the fault until the CT secondary current at the outgoing terminal saturates,
the differential current Id is zero and the change in the differential current ΔId obtained from
equation (2) is also zero. However, the change in the restraining current given by equation (3) is a
sufficiently large positive value, so equation (1) is met and WDE operates.
SE detects changes in the terminal currents and rapidly operates, producing an AND output with
WDE. After this, since there is a period during which equation (1) is not satisfied, a certain time
delay is inserted to reliably block the operation of the DIFT_DIF differential element.
If, during an internal fault, there is a period during which the change in the instantaneous value of
the differential current is small due to CT saturation, WDE will not operate because the change in
the restraining current is also small during that period. Thus, during an internal fault, operation of
the differential element is not blocked falsely.
The CTS function can be disabled by the scheme switch [CTSEN].
⎯ 17 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2.3 Matching of CT Secondary Currents
The currents supplied to the differential elements must be matched in phase displacement and
amplitude under through-load and through-fault conditions.
Generally, it is difficult to completely match the incoming current with the outgoing current for
the relay input because the CT ratios at the primary, secondary and tertiary sides of a transformer
are not matched in terms of the CT ratio, phase angle and cancelling of zero-sequence current.
GRT100 provides the following matching method:
Primary
Secondary
Ip
Is
CT ratio: N1
CT ratio: N2
Transformer
Ip/N1=i1
GRT100
Is/N2=i2
Matching of phase
angle / Zero-sequence
current elimination
Matching of phase
angle / Zero-sequence
current elimination
Matching of CT ratio
Matching of CT ratio
Kct1×i1
Kct2×i2
Differential relay calculation
Figure 2.2.2.1 Matching Method
GRT100 supports selectable two matching methods, α-method (Alpha) and β-method (Beta). The
method is selected by the scheme switch [Phase matching].
Phase matching is performed by setting according to the hands of a clock and the transformer
connections described in IEC60076-1. For details of the setting, refer to 2.2.5.
2.2.3.1 α-method phase matching
This method corrects the phase angle by using each winding current calculated as follows:
- Current substructed zero-sequence current from each phase current in Star- winding side of
transformer
- Phase-to-phase Current in Delta-winding side of transformer
The followings show calculation formula and current vectors in an example of a transformer
Yd11.
Isa
Ipa
Is1
Isb
Ip1
Isc
Ipc
Ipb
&
&
&
&
&
2Ipa − Ipb − Ipc
Isa − Isc
&
&
,
(1)
Ip1=
Is1=
3
3
⎯ 18 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
&
&
&
&
&
2Ipb − Ipc − Ipa
Isb − Isa
&
&
,
,
(2)
(3)
Ip2 =
Is2 =
3
3
&
&
&
&
&
2Ipc − Ipa − Ipb
Isc − Isb
&
&
Ip3 =
Is3 =
3
3
where,
&
&
&
Ipa, Ipb, Ipc: Primary side terminal current of transformer
&
&
&
Isa, Isb, Isc : Secondary side terminal current of transformer
Further, zero-sequence current is eliminated from the relay input current (Ip∗) for the calculation
of the differential current as follows:
&
&
&
2Ipa − Ipb − Ipc 3Ipa − (Ipa + Ipb + Ipc)
&
Ip1=
=
= Ipa − Ipo
= Ipb − Ipo
= Ipc − Ipo
3
3
&
&
&
2Ipb − Ipc − Ipa 3Ipb − (Ipa + Ipb + Ipc)
&
Ip2 =
=
3
3
&
&
&
2Ipc − Ipa − Ipb 3Ipa − (Ipa + Ipb + Ipc)
&
Ip3 =
=
3
3
2.2.3.2 β-method (Traditional method) phase matching
This is a traditional method that delta current (phase-to-phase current) on the Star-winding side of
a Star/Delta transformer and phase current on the Delta-winding side of that is introduced into a
relay input for the calculation of the differential current. Traditionally, the phase matching is
realized by Delta connecting the CTs on the Star-winding side and by Star connecting the CTs on
the Delta-winding side. In GRT100, however, it is realized by software.
The followings show calculation formula and current vectors in an example of a transformer
Yd11.
I
Ipa
Is1
Ip1
I
Ipb
I
Isc
&
&
Ipa − Ipb
&
&
&
,
,
,
(4)
(5)
(6)
Is1= Isa
Ip1=
3
&
&
Ipb − Ipc
&
&
&
Is2 = Isb
Ip2 =
3
&
&
Ipc − Ipa
&
&
&
Is3 = Isc
Ip3 =
3
⎯ 19 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2.3.3 Zero-sequence current elimination
In addition to compensating for the phase angle between the primary and secondary currents of the
transforemer, also phase angle matching prevents unnecessary operation due to zero-sequence
current during an external earth fault, such as in the following cases.
Case 1:
When an external fault occurs at the star-connected side of the transformer shown in Figure
2.2.3.2, a zero-sequence current flows in star-connected side, but the zero-sequence current at the
delta-side circulates in the delta winding. The zero-sequence current is only fed into the star
winding side of the DIFT which is star-connected at the CT secondary, thus causing the DIFT to
operate incorrectly. In α-method phase matching, the zero-sequence current is eliminated from a
relay input current as described above. In β-method phase matching, the zero-sequence current is
eliminated from the relay input current by Delta connection on the Star-winding side.
Since the DIFT provides a function to eliminate the zero-sequence current by software, the DIFT
is insensitive the fault described.
I0
Transforme
I
I0
I0
I0
I0
I
I
I0
3 0
DIFT
Figure 2.2.3.2 External Earth Fault at the Star-connected side of a Transformer
Case 2:
When the delta winding of a power transformer is earthed through an earthing transformer as
shown in Figure 2.2.3.3 and the earthing transformer is located within the differential protection
zone, in case of an external earth fault the zero-sequence current flows only on the delta side of the
power transformer and appears as a differential current.
Ia
I0
Ib
I0
Ic
I0
Earthing
Transforme
3I0
DIF
Figure 2.2.3.3 External Earth Fault at the Delta-winding side of a Transformer with
in-zone Earthing Transformer
⎯ 20 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
In α-method phase matching, since the DIFT provides a function to eliminate the zero-sequence
current by software, the DIFT is insensitive to the fault described.
In β-method phase matching, however, since the zero-sequence current is not eliminated because
of Star connection on the Delta-winding side, the DIFT may operate unnecessary.
In case the GRT100 is applied to a transformer with in-zone earthing transformer, the [Phase
matching] = “Alpha” setting is recommended.
2.2.3.4 Matching of CT Ratio
If I1 to I3 correspond to 1CT to 3CT secondary currents, differential current Id is calculated
according to the following equation,
Id = kct1⋅I1 + kct2⋅I2 + kct3⋅I3
where kct1 to kct3 are settings corresponding to 1CT to 3CT.
Setting kct1 is obtained by using the following equation.
kct1 = In/Ibase1
= In/( 3 × Ibase1) if 1CT is delta-connected.
where
In = rated secondary current of 1CT (1A or 5A)
I
base1 = secondary current of 1CT based on the kVA rating of the power transformer.
= transformer capacity(kVA)/( 3 × rated voltage(kV)) × CT ratio of 1CT
If the 1CT secondary circuit is delta-connected, 3 × Ibase1 is used instead of Ibase1 in the equation
above.
Settings kct2 and kct3 are obtained in the same way.
The differential current Id is zero under through-load and through-fault conditions.
kct1 × I1 to kct3 × I3 are equal to the rated secondary current of each CT when the rated line
currents based on the kVA rating of the power transformer flow.
⎯ 21 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2.4 Connection between CT Secondary Circuit and the GRT100
GRT100 is provided with 2 or 3 three-phase current input terminals depending on the relay model.
To validate the phase angle matching described previously and apply in-phase current from each
winding to the relay, connect the CT secondary circuits to the current input terminals of the relay
as follows;
As shown below, the phases used in the phase angle setting (indicated by an arrowhead) must be
connected to the AC input terminals with the lowest number in the terminal group such as 1, 9, 17,
then the other two phases should be connected to the terminals with a larger number clockwise
from the setting phase, such as 3 and 5, 11 and 13, or 19 and 21.
Primary
Secondary
Tertiary
21 19 17
13 11
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
GRT100
22 20 18
14 12 10
Figure 2.2.4.1 Connection of CT Secondary Circuit and the GRT100
Terminal numbers and corresponding input currents are shown in the following table.
Model
Terminal block Terminal number
Input current
100 series / 200 series TB1
1-2
3-4
Current of primary winding
5-6
9-10
11-12
13-14
17-18
19-20
21-22
Current of secondary winding
Current of tertiary winding
⎯ 22 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.2.5 Setting
The following shows the setting elements necessary for the current differential protection and their
setting ranges. Setting can be performed on the LCD screen or PC screen.
Element
DIFT
Range
Step
Default Remarks
0.10 − 1.00 (∗)
i
DIF
0.01
0.30
Minimum operating current
k
p1
p2
kp
1%
100%
200%
1.00
% slope of small current region
% slope of large current region
Break point of dual characteristics
Second harmonic detection
Fifth harmonic detection
10 − 100%
1%
10 − 200%
0.01
1%
1.00 − 20.00(*)
10 − 50%
k2f
k5f
kh
15%
30%
2.00
1%
10 − 100%
HOC
0.01
High-set overcurrent protection
2.00 − 20.00(*)
CT matching
kct1
kct2
kct3
0.01
0.01
0.01
1.00
1.00
1.00
Primary winding
0.05 − 50.00
0.05 − 50.00
0.05 − 50.00
CT ratio
Secondary winding
Tertiary winding
Phase angle matching
(α-method)
If [Phase matching]=Alpha setting
Primary winding
yd_p
yd_s
yd_t
1(star) / 2(delta)
1(star) / 2(delta)
1(star) / 2(delta)
1
1
1
0
Secondary winding
Tertiary winding
vec_s 0 – 11
1
1
Phase angle difference between primary
and secondary
vec_t 0 – 11
0
Phase angle difference between primary
and tertiary
If [Phase matching]=Beta setting
Primary winding
d1
d2
d3
1
1
1
0
0
0
0 − 11
0 − 11
0 − 11
Secondary winding
Tertiary winding
(β-method)
Scheme switch
[Phase matching]
Alpha / Beta
Beta
Matching methods of CT secondary
currents
[DIFTPMD]
[DIFTPMD]
[2F – LOCK]
[5F - LOCK]
[DIF1] to [DIF5]
[CTSEN]
3POR / 1P
3POR / 2PAND / 1P
Off / On
3POR
3POR
On
Trip mode (if [Phase matching] = Alpha)
Trip mode (if [Phase matching] = Beta)
Block by second harmonic
Block by fifth harmonic
Off / On
On
Off / On
(**)
Output tripping signal
Off / On
Off
CT saturation function
(∗): Multiplier of CT secondary rated current including CT ratio correction.
(**): Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
⎯ 23 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting of ik
ik determines the minimum operation sensitivity of the DIF element. ik is set as a ratio to the CT
secondary rated current.
The minimum sensitivity setting ik is determined from the maximum erroneous differential
current under normal operating conditions.
Setting of p1, p2 and kp
Percentage restraining factor (% slope)
= (Differential current) / (Through current)
= (Differential current) / [{(Incoming current) + (Outgoing current)} /2]
p1 is the percentage restraining factor which defines the DIF restraining characteristic in the small
current region. The setting is determined by the sum of:
•
•
CT accuracy error (generally considered as 5%)
Tap error: Error between maximum/minimum tap and the middle tap when taking the middle
tap of the tap changer as a reference.
•
•
Matching error: The error due to CT mismatch may be small enough to be neglected in the
setting.
Relay calculation error, and others (5%)
The recommended setting is “Sum of above” × 1.5 (margin).
p2 is the percentage restraining factor which defines the restraining characteristic in the large
current region. The setting is determined from the maximum erroneous differential current which
is generated when a large through fault current flows.
kp is the break point of the dual percentage restraining characteristics. It is set above the maximum
operating current level of the transformer between the maximum forced-cooled rated current and
the maximum emergency overload current level, as a ratio to the CT secondary rated current.
Setting of k2f
k2f is set to detect the second harmonic content in the inrush current during transformer
energization and blocks GRT100 to prevent incorrect operation due to the inrush current. A
setting of 15% is suggested if there is no data on the minimum second harmonic content.
Setting of k5f
k5f is set to detect the fifth harmonic content during transformer over-excitation and blocks
GRT100 to prevent incorrect operation due to transient over-excitation conditions.
A setting of 30% is suggested if there is no data on the minimum fifth harmonic content.
Setting of kh
Kh is the HOC setting and should be set above the estimated maximum inrush current.
The recommended setting is more than “Maximum peak value of Inrush current” × kct.
Setting for CT ratio matching
Taking the transformer shown in Figure 2.2.5.1 as an example, the CT ratio matching settings kct1
to kct3 can be calculated as follows. For transformer capacity, take the maximum of the rated
capacites of the three windings.
⎯ 24 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Calculation steps
Primary
Secondary
40 × 103
66
Tertiary
(1) Transformer capacity (kVA)
(2) Voltage(kV)
154
150
11
(3) Rated line current(A)
350
2100
=(1)/( 3 × (2))
(4) CT ratio
60
120
240
8.75
5
(5) Secondary rated line current(A) =(3)/(4) 2.50
2.92
(6) CT secondary rating(A)
(7) Setting =(6)/(5)
5
5
Kct1=2.00
Kct2=1.71
Kct3=0.57
Note: kct1 to kct3 should be set to 2.00 or less. If more, the CT ratio matching of relay input current
may be not stable.
Primary
40MVA
154kV
Secondary
40MVA
66kV
CT1
300/5
CT2
600/5
A
B
CT3
1200/5
Tertiary
12MVA
11kV
C
kct1
kct3
kct2
GRT100
Figure 2.2.5.1 CT Ratio Matching
As explained in Section 2.2.3 for Mathcing of CT Secondary Currents, examples of setting for
both α-method and β-method are described as follows:
⎯ 25 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting for phase angle matching
The phase angle difference between line currents on either side of the power transformer are
corrected by setting according to the hands of a clock and the transformer connections described in
IEC60076-1 as follows:
(When α-method is selected for [Phase matching])
If a winding is star-connected, set 1 (=star) for winding setting yd_p, yd_s, and yd_t. If
delta-connected, set 2 (=delta). Next, set the phase angle difference vec_s and vec_t from the
primary winding as a lagging angle winding expressed in hours. One hour corresponds to lagging
by thirty degrees.
Note: In the case of a zigzag connected winding, set 2 (=delta).
Example:
Setting for star/star/delta transformer.
IEC60076-1
Setting
yd_p
yd_s vec_s yd_t vec_t
Primary
Secondary
Tertiary
Y y 0 d 11
1
1
0
2
11
yd_p:
yd_s:
vec_s:
yd_t:
Because the primary winding is star-connected, set 1.
Because the secondary winding is star-connected, set 1.
Because the secondary winding is in phase with the primary winding, set 0.
Because the tertiary winding is delta-connected, set 2.
vec_t:
Because the tertiary winding lags the primary winding by 330°, set 11.
The settings for the transformer connections described in IEC60076-1 are listed in Table 2.2.5.2.
Note: The following calculation is performed in the relay for phase angle correction.
Table 2.2.5.1 Phase Angle Matching Calculation
O’clock
Calculation
Remarks
0
1
Ia’ = (2Ia − Ib − Ic)/ 3 Ib’ = (2Ib − Ic − Ia)/ 3 Ic’ = (2Ic − Ia − Ib)/ 3
Setting value
0
11
Ia’ = (Ia – Ib)/
Ia’ = (Ia − 2Ib + Ic)/ 3 Ib’ = (Ia + Ib − 2Ic)/ 3 Ic’ = (Ib + Ic −2Ia)/ 3
Ia’ = (Ic − Ib)/ Ib’ = (Ia – Ic)/ Ic’ = (Ib − Ia)/
Ia’ = (2Ic − Ia − Ib)/ 3 Ib’ = (2Ia − Ib − Ic)/ 3 Ic’ = (2Ib − Ia − Ic)/ 3
Ia’ = (Ic – Ia)/ Ib’ = (Ia – Ib)/ Ic’ = (Ib – Ic)/
Ia’ = (Ib + Ic −2Ia)/ 3 Ib’ = (Ia − 2Ib + Ic)/ 3 Ic’ = (Ia + Ib − 2Ic)/ 3
Ia’ = (Ib − Ia)/ Ib’ = (Ic − Ib)/ Ic’ = (Ia – Ic)/
Ia’ = (2Ib − Ia − Ic)/ 3 Ib’ = (2Ic − Ia − Ib)/ 3 Ic’ = (2Ia − Ib − Ic)/ 3
Ia’ = (Ib – Ic)/ Ib’ = (Ic – Ia)/ Ic’ = (Ia – Ib)/
Ia’ = (Ia + Ib − 2Ic)/ 3 Ib’ = (Ib + Ic −2Ia)/ 3 Ic’ = (Ia − 2Ib + Ic)/ 3
Ia’ = (Ia – Ic)/ Ib’ = (Ib − Ia)/ Ic’ = (Ic − Ib)/
3
Ib’ = (Ib − Ic)/
3
Ic’ = (Ic – Ia)/
3
2
1
3
3
3
3
10
2
4
4
5
3
3
3
9
3
6
7
3
3
3
8
8
7
5
6
9
3
3
3
10
11
3
3
3
⎯ 26 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table 2.2.5.2 Setting for Phase Angle Matching (for α-method)
(a) Settings for typical connections of 2-windings transformer
Transformer connections
described in IEC60076-1
Primary, Secondary
Settings for phase angle correction
Remarks
Primary, Secondary, Phase angle Diff.
Phase angle matching
calculation (Table 2.2.5.1)
(yd_p)
(yd_s)
(vec_s)
(P)
(S)
Yy0
Dd0
Yd1
1
1
0
P: 0 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
2
1
2
2
0
1
P: 1 O’clock
S: 1 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 1 O’clock
Dy1
Dd2
Dd4
Yd5
2
2
2
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
4
5
P: 11 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
P: 1 O’clock
S: 3 O’clock
P: 1 O’clock
S: 5 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 5 O’clock
Dy5
Yy6
Dd6
Yd7
2
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
5
6
6
7
P: 7 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 6 O’clock
P: 1 O’clock
S: 7 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 7 O’clock
Dy7
2
1
7
P: 5 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
Dd8
2
2
1
2
2
2
8
P: 1 O’clock
S: 9 O’clock
Dd10
Yd11
10
11
P: 1 O’clock
S: 11 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 11 O’clock
Dy11
Dz10
2
2
1
2
11
10
P: 1 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
P: 1 O’clock
S: 11 O’clock
Note: A 2-windings transformer covers a 3-windings transformer with a stabilizing-winding circuit
for which 2-windings transformer protection relay can be applied.
⎯ 27 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(b) Settings for typical connections of 3-windings transformer
Transformer connections described in
IEC60076-1
Settings for phase angle correction
Remarks
Primary, Secondary, PA Diff., Tertiary, PA Diff.
Phase angle matching
calculation (Table
2.2.5.1)
Primary , Secondary,
Tertiary
(yd_p)
(yd_s)
(vec_s) (yd_t) (vec_t)
(P)
(S)
(T)
P: 0 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
T: 1 O’clock
1
1
0
0
2
2
2
2
2
1
11
1
Yy0d1
P: 0 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
T: 11 O’clock
1
1
1
2
1
2
2
1
Yy0d11
Yd1d1
P: 0 O’clock
S: 1 O’clock
T: 1 O’clock
1
P: 0 O’clock
S: 11 O’clock
T: 11 O’clock
11
11
11
0
Yd11d11
P: 1 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
T: 1 O’clock
Dy11d0
Dy1d0
Dd0d0
Yy0y0
P: 11 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
T: 11 O’clock
P: 1 O’clock
S: 1 O’clock
T: 1 O’clock
P: 0 O’clock
S: 0 O’clock
T: 0 O’clock
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
0
0
2
2
1
0
0
0
Note: Dotted line: Reference phase
<How to set phase angle matching for GRT100>
Reference phase for phase angle matching
The phase of a star-connected winding side is used as the reference phase for phase angle
matching.
Yd: primary
Dy: secondary
Yy: primary
Dd: the reference vector leads the A phase of the primary side by 30°.
Phase rotation
The relationship between each terminal current vector of a transformer, which depends on the
transformer connection and the connection between the transformer and the power system, must
be checked. The phase displacement of a delta-connected side may not be determined only by the
transformer connection described in IEC60076. Table 2.2.5.3 shows an example illustrating the
connection of a transformer and power system and their current vectors when a Yd1 type
transformer is connected to the power system with both clockwise and anticlockwise phase
rotation. In this case, the setting for phase angle correction is not corresponding to that of Table
2.2.5.1.
⎯ 28 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table 2.2.5.3 Transformer Connection and Current Vector
Delta-side connected with 30° lagging
Delta-side connected with 30° leading
Transformer
Yd1
Transformer
Connection between
Yd1 Transformer
and Power system
Primary
Secondary
Primary
Secondary
Yd1
u
a
b
c
a
u
a
a
U
U
v
v
b
c
b
c
b
c
V
V
W
w
W
w
Transformer
I2a
Transformer
u
a
b
c
u
a
a
b
c
a
Each winding
connection and
Incoming/Outgoing
current
U
V
U
V
I1c
I1a
I1b
I1c
I2c
I2b
I2a
I1a
I1b
I1c
I2a’=I2a−I2b
I2a’=I2a−I2c
v
v
b
b
I1b
I2b
I2b’=I2b
−
I
I2b’=I2b−I2a
2c
W
w
c
W
w
c
I1a
I2c
−
I2c’=I2c I
I2c’=I2c−I2b
2a
I2b’=I2b−I2a
I
2c’=I2c−I2a
I1a
I1a
Incoming current
vector and Outgoing
current vector
I2b
I2b’=I2b−I2c
I2c
I2b
I2c
30
30
°
°
I2c’=I2c−I2b
I1c
I1b
I1c
I1b
I2a
I2a
I2a’=I2a−I2b
I2a’=I2a−I2c
Outgoing
Current
Incoming
Current
Incoming
Current
Outgoing
Current
Setting
Yd_p=1, yd_s=2, vec_s=1 (Same as Yd1)
Yd_p=1, yd_s=2, vec_s=11 (same as Yd11)
Auto-transformer (with internal delta-winding)
Set Yy0.
Zigzag connected transformer
Set yd_p, yd_s and vec_s to 2 (=delta) for zigzag connected side. Zero-sequence current is
canceled.
When three-winding model (model 200 series) applied to two-winding transformer:
Keep the settings of “yd_t” and “vec_t” to the default setting values.
One-and-a-half breaker system
When applied to one-and-a-half breaker system, note the DIFT and REF setting as shown in Table
2.2.5.4.
Table 2.2.5.4 Example of DIFT and REF Setting
Setting
DIFT
1REF
1I0
2REF
--
Yd11
Yd11
yd_p=1
yd_s=2
vec_s=11
One-and-a-half breaker system
Yd11
Yy0d11
yd_p=1
yd_s=1
vec_s=0
yd_t=2
2Io
1I0
--
vec_s=11
Yy0d11
Yy0d11
yd_p=1
yd_s=1
1I0
vec_s=0
yd_t=2
vec_s=11
⎯ 29 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(When β-method is selected for [Phase matching])
The phase angle differences between line currents on each side of the power transformer are
corrected by setting according to the hands of a clock as follows:
Rule 1:
If all the windings are star-connected, then take one of the windings as a reference winding and set
1 (= one o’clock) for it. For other winding(s), set the phase angle difference from the reference
winding by the expression of the leading angle. One hour corresponds to leading by thirty degrees.
Example 1
Example 2
If the setting winding leads the reference winding by 60°, set 3 (= three o’clock).
If the setting winding is in phase with the reference winding, set 1 (= one
o’clock).
Example 3
If the setting winding lags the reference winding by 60° (that is leading by 300°),
set 11 (= eleven o’clock).
Rule 2:
If any of the windings are delta-connected, take one of the delta-connected winding(s) as a
reference winding and set 0 (= noon) for it. For other star- or delta-connected winding(s), set
according to the Rule 1 mentioned above.
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
If the setting winding leads the reference winding by 60°, set 2 (= two o’clock).
If the setting winding is in phase with the reference winding, set 0 (= noon).
If the setting winding lags the reference winding by 60° (that is leading by 300°),
set 10 (ten o’clock).
The settings for the two-winding transformer connections described in IEC60076-1 are listed in
Table 2.2.5.5.
Three-winding transformers are also set according to the above mentioned rules.
Example 4
Setting for star/star/delta transformer.
Setting (d1 / d2 / d3)
Primary (d1)
11
11
0
Secondary (d2)
Primary
Secondary
Tertiary
Tertiary (d3)
⎯ 30 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Note: The following calculation is performed in the relay for phase angle correction.
Setting
Calculation
Ia = Ia
Remarks
0
1
Setting value
0
Ia = (Ia – Ic)/
3
2
3
Ia = −Ic
11
1
Ia = (−Ic + Ib)/
3
3
Ia
10
2
4
4
5
Ia = Ib
Ia = (Ib – Ia)/
3
9
3
6
7
Ia = −Ia
Ia = (−Ia + Ic)/
8
8
9
Ia = Ic
7
5
6
Ia = (Ic – Ib)/
Ia = −Ib
3
3
10
11
Ia = (Ia – Ib)/
⎯ 31 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table 2.2.5.5 Setting for Phase Angle Matching (for β-method)
(a) Settings for typical connections of 2-windings transformer
Transformer connections
described in IEC60076-1
Settings for phase angle correction
Primary , Secondary
Remarks
(d1)
(d2)
Yy0
Dd0
Yd1
1
,
,
,
1
0
1
0
0
Dy1
Dd2
Dd4
Yd5
0
0
,
11
,
,
,
,
,
10
0
Based on primary winding.
Based on secondary winding.
Based on primary winding.
Based on secondary winding.
or
2
0
4
5
8
or
0
0
Dy5
Yy6
Dd6
Yd7
0
,
7
1
7
0
6
7
,
,
,
,
,
7
1
6
0
0
Based on primary winding.
or
or
Based on secondary winding.
Dy7
0
,
5
Dd8
0
8
0
,
,
,
,
,
4
0
2
0
0
Based on primary winding.
Based on secondary winding.
Based on primary winding.
Based on secondary winding.
or
Dd10
Yd11
or 10
11
Dy11
0
,
1
Note: A 2-windings transformer covers a 3-windings transformer with a stabilizing-winding circuit
for which 2-windings transformer protection relay can be applied.
⎯ 32 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(b) Settings for typical connections of 3-windings transformer
Transformer connections described in
IEC60076-1
Settings for phase angle correction
Primary, Secondary, Tertiary
Remarks
(d1)
(d2)
(d3)
1
,
1
,
0
Yy0d1
11
1
,
11
,
0
0
0
0
0
Yy0d11
Yd1d1
,
0
0
,
11
0
,
,
Yd11d11
Dy11d0
Dy1d0
,
,
1
,
0
11
,
0
1
,
0
1
,
0
1
Dd0d0
,
,
Yy0y0
Note :
1. If all the windings are star-connected, then take one of the windings as a reference winding
and set 1 (= one hour) for it.
2. If any of the windings are delta-connected, take one of the delta-connected winding(s) as a
reference winding and set 0 for it.
⎯ 33 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.3 Restricted Earth Fault Protection
Restricted earth fault protection (REF) is a zero-phase current differential scheme applied to a
star-connected winding whose neutral is earthed directly or through a low impedance. It gives
highly sensitive protection for internal earth faults.
REF employs a low impedance current differential scheme which detects the differential current
between the zero-sequence current I0 derived from the three-phase line currents and the neutral
current IN in the neutral conductor as shown in Figure 2.3.1.
Ia+Ib+Ic
REF
IN
Figure 2.3.1 Restricted Earth Fault Protection
REF and the overall differential protection DIFT use the three-phase line currents in common.
GRT100 has two or three REF elements depending on the model, providing separate protection
for all star-connected and neutral-earthed windings.
The elements have the same percentage restraining characteristics and are stable for all faults
outside the protected zone.
Figure 2.3.2 shows the block diagram of the REF element which is composed of REF_DIF and
REF_DEF. The REF_DIF has a percentage restraining characteristic while the REF_DEF
provides a directional check feature to discriminate between internal and external faults. When the
REF_DEF is “ON”, the REF_DEF element is used. The REF_DEF element provides additional
security against incorrect operation of the REF element in the event of saturation of the neutral
CT. The REF_DEF is blocked when the maximum phase current exceeds 2 × kct × (Rated current
of neutral CT), since the REF element is used for earth fault protection of transformer winding.
For details, see Section 2.10.3. In case of terminal current larger than that, the DIFT element
provides tripping. The REF_DEF can be disabled by setting the scheme switch [REF_DEF] to
“OFF”.
REF_DIF
REF
REF_DEF
&
internal fault detection
&
≥1
Ires≦2.0×Max_kct
[REF_DEF]
ON
+
OFF
Figure 2.3.2
Block Diagram of REF
Figure 2.3.3 shows the scheme logic of the restricted earth fault protection when three REF
elements are applied. Each REF element can perform instantaneous or time-delayed tripping of up
to five breakers. Any of the five breaker tripping signals 1REF-1 to 3REF-5 are enabled or
disabled by the scheme switch [1REF1] to [3REF5] settings.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with 1REF-4, 1REF5, 2REF-4, 2REF-5, 3REF-4 and
⎯ 34 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3REF-5.
T1REF
t
0
71
1REF
&
&
&
&
&
1REF-1
1REF-2
1REF-3
1REF-4
[1REF1]
“ON”
0.00 - 10.00s
+
+
+
+
+
[1REF2]
“ON”
[1REF3]
“ON”
[1REF4]
“ON”
1REF-5
332
[1REF5]
“ON”
1REF TRIP
≥1
2REF-1
2REF-2
2REF-3
2REF-4
2REF-5
74
2REF
Same as above
333
2REF TRIP
≥1
3REF-1
3REF-2
3REF-3
3REF-4
3REF-5
77
3REF
Same as above
334
3REF TRIP
≥1
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with 1REF-4, 1REF-5, 2REF-4, 2REF-5, 3REF-4 and
3REF-5.
Figure 2.3.3 Scheme Logic of Restricted Earth Fault Protection
Appendix L shows applications of the three REF elements to various types of transformers. When
protecting a two- or three-winding transformer, 1REF, 2REF and 3REF elements should be
applied to the primary (or high-voltage) winding, secondary (or medium-voltage) winding and
tertiary (or low-voltage) winding respectively. This is also valid for auto-transformer protection
but the application must comply with Appendix L.
In the application to auto-transformers, one REF element may introduce two or three line currents
and one neutral current as shown in Appendix L. 1REF to 3REF elements recognize the number of
the line currents according to the scheme switch setting of [1REF] to [3REF].
⎯ 35 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for the restricted earth fault protection and their setting
ranges.
Element
Range
Step
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
1%
Default
0.50
Remarks
1REF
1ik
Minimum operating current
0.05 − 0.50(*)
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
50 − 100%
0.50 − 2.00(*)
1kct1
1kct2
1kct3
1p2
1.00
1.00
CT ratio matching
1.00
100%
1.00
% slope of DF2
1kp
0.01
DF2 restraining current section of
large current characteristic
2REF
2ik
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
1%
0.50
1.00
1.00
1.00
100%
1.00
Minimum operating current
0.05 − 0.50(*)
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
50 − 100%
2kct1
2kct2
2kct3
2p2
CT ratio matching
% slope of DF2
2kp
0.01
DF2 restraining current section of
large current characteristic
0.50 − 2.00(*)
3REF
3ik
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
1%
0.50
1.00
1.00
1.00
100%
1.00
Minimum operating current
0.05 − 0.50(*)
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
1.00 − 50.00
50 − 100%
3kct1
3kct2
3kct3
3p2
CT ratio matching
% slope of DF2
3kp
0.01
DF2 restraining current section of
large current characteristic
0.50 − 2.00(*)
T1REF
T2REF
T3REF
0.01s
0.01s
0.01s
0.00s
0.00s
0.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
Delayed tripping
Scheme switch
[1REF1] to [1REF5]
[2REF1] to [2REF5]
[3REF1] to [3REF5]
[1REF] to [3REF]
[REF_DEF]
Off/On
(**)
(**)
(**)
1Io
Off
Enable or disable to output
tripping signal
Off/On
Off/On
Number of line currents input to
1REF, 2REF and 3REF elements
1Io/2Io/3Io
Off/On
(*):
Multiplier of secondary rated current
(**): Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
Setting of ik (1ik, 2ik and 3ik)
1ik, 2ik and 3ik are minimum operating current settings and are set as a ratio to the line CT
secondary rated current. ik is determined from the maximum erroneous zero sequence differential
current under normal operating conditions. A typical setting would be between 10% and 50%.
⎯ 36 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting of kct (1kct1-1kct3, 2kct1-2kct3 and 3kct1-3kct3)
CT ratio matching is performed between the line CT(s) and the neutral CT by setting 1kct1-1kct3
for 1REF element, 2kct1-2kct3 for 2REF element and 3kct1-3kct3 for 3REF element. The settings
are obtained as a ratio of the line CTs ratio to the neutral CT ratio and the line CTs have the
notations shown in Appendix L according to 1REF to 3REF applications.
For example, the settings of 1kct1, 1kct2, 2kct1 and 2kct2 are calculated;
1kct1 = (CT ratio of line CT 1ct-1)/(CT ratio of neutral CT 1nCT)
1kct2 = (CT ratio of line CT 1ct-2)/(CT ratio of neutral CT 1nCT)
2kct1 = (CT ratio of line CT 2ct-1)/(CT ratio of neutral CT 2nCT)
2kct2 = (CT ratio of line CT 2ct-2)/(CT ratio of neutral CT 2nCT)
where,
CT ratio = (primary rated current)/(secondary rated current).
Setting of scheme switch [1REF] to [3REF]
[1REF] to [3REF] are set to "1I0", "2I0" or "3I0" when they introduce one, two or three line
currents respectively.
Setting of scheme switch [REF_DEF]
The function of REF_DEF is set to “On/Off” by setting.
⎯ 37 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.4 Overcurrent Protection
GRT100 provides definite time and inverse time overcurrent elements for both phase faults and
earth faults, separately for each transformer winding. Three phase currents from each set of line
CTs are used for the phase fault protection elements, while the earth fault protection is based on
the neutral CT input.These elements can be used selectively depending on the requirements of the
particular application, but the following points should be noted:
• In the case of large power transformers, overcurrent protection is usually employed only as
back-up protection for terminal faults, and for uncleared LV system faults. In such cases, the
overcurrent elements can be applied either on one or both sides of the transformer as
required.
• Coverage of internal transformer faults is generally limited.
• It is common practice to apply IDMTL phase and earth fault overcurrent protection as
back-up for the LV system. Current and time settings must be arranged to grade with
downstream relays and fuses. The phase fault current setting must also be set to exceed the
maximum overload current.
• High-set instantaneous overcurrent protection can be applied on the primary side to provide
back-up protection for terminal faults. The current setting must be higher than the maximum
through-fault current to ensure that the element does not operate for faults on the LV side.
One of the following IEC-standard-compliant inverse time characteristics or one long time inverse
characteristic is available for the inverse current protection.
• standard inverse
• very inverse
IEC 60255-3
IEC 60255-3
IEC 60255-3
• extremely inverse
Up to three definite time elements (1OC to 3OC) and inverse time elements (1OCI to 3OCI) input
three phase currents from line CTs in the transformer windings.
Up to three definite time elements (1EF to 3EF) and inverse time elements (1EFI to 3EFI) input
neutral currents from CTs in the neutral circuit.
Figure 2.4.1 and Figure 2.4.2 show the scheme logic of overcurrent protection. Each element can
perform time-delayed tripping of up to five breakers. The breaker tripping signals are blocked by
the scheme switch settings.
The number of overcurrent elements applied depends on the relay models.
⎯ 38 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
T1OC
47
48
49
A
B
C
370
t
0
≥1
&
&
&
&
&
1OC-1
1OC
[1OC1]
[1OC2]
[1OC3]
[1OC4]
[1OC5]
0.00 - 10.00s
+
+
+
+
+
1OC-2
1OC-3
1OC-4
1OC-5
335
1OC TRIP
≥1
50
51
52
A
B
C
225
≥1
&
&
&
&
&
1OCI-1
1OCI-2
1OCI-3
1OCI-4
1OCI
[1OCI1]
[1OCI2]
[1OCI3]
[1OCI4]
[1OCI5]
+
+
+
+
+
1OCI-5
339
1OIC TRIP
≥1
Note: 2OC and 3OC provide the same logic as 1OC. 2OCI and 3OCI provide the same logic as 1OCI.
Models 203 and 204 are not provided with 1OC-4, 1OC-5, 2OC-4, 2OC-5, 3OC-4, 3OC-5,
1OCI-4, 1OCI-5, 2OCI-4, 2OCI-5, 3OCI-4 and 3OCI-5.
Figure 2.4.1 Scheme Logic of the Overcurrent Protection
⎯ 39 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
T1EF
t
0
72
1EF
&
&
&
&
&
1EF-1
[1EF1]
[1EF2]
[1EF3]
[1EF4]
[1EF5]
0.00 - 10.00s
+
+
+
+
+
1EF-2
1EF-3
1EF-4
1EF-5
343
1EF TRIP
≥1
73
1EFI
&
&
&
&
&
1EFI-1
1EFI-2
1EFI-3
1EFI-4
[1EFI1]
[1EFI2]
[1EFI3]
[1EFI4]
[1EFI5]
+
+
+
+
+
1EFI-5
346
1EFI TRIP
≥1
Note: 2EF and 3EF provide the same logic as 1EF. 2EFI and 3EFI provide the same logic as 1EFI.
Models 203 and 204 are not provided with 1EF-4, 1EF-5, 2EF-4, 2EF-5, 3EF-4, 3EF-5, 1EFI-4,
1EFI-5, 2EFI-4, 2EFI-5, 3EFI-4 and 3EFI-5.
Figure 2.4.2 Scheme Logic of the Overcurrent Protection for Earth Faults
⎯ 40 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for the overcurrent protection and their setting ranges.
Element
1OC
Range
Step
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01s
0.01s
0.01s
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01s
0.01s
0.01s
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
Default Remarks
Definite time overcurrent (line)
2.00
2.00
2.00
1.00s
1.00s
1.00s
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
2.00
2.00
2.00
1.00s
1.00s
1.00s
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.10 − 20.0(*)
0.10 − 20.0(*)
0.10 − 20.0(*)
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.05 − 1.00
2OC
Definite time overcurrent (line)
Definite time overcurrent (line)
Delayed tripping for 1OC
Delayed tripping for 2OC
Delayed tripping for 3OC
Inverse time overcurrent (line)
Inverse time overcurrent (line)
Inverse time overcurrent (line)
Time multiplier setting for 1OCI
Time multiplier setting for 2OCI
Time multiplier setting for 3OCI
Definite time overcurrent (neutral)
Definite time overcurrent (neutral)
Definite time overcurrent (neutral)
Delayed tripping for 1EF
3OC
T1OC
T2OC
T3OC
1OCI
2OCI
3OCI
T1OCI
T2OCI
0.05 − 1.00
T3OCI
0.05 − 1.00
1EF
0.10 − 20.00(*)
0.10 − 20.00(*)
0.10 − 20.00(*)
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.00 − 10.00s
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.10 − 5.00(*)
0.05 − 1.00
2EF
3EF
T1EF
T2EF
Delayed tripping for 2EF
T3EF
Delayed tripping for 3EF
1EFI
Inverse time overcurrent (neutral)
Inverse time overcurrent (neutral)
Inverse time overcurrent (neutral)
Time multiplier setting for 1EFI
Time multiplier setting for 2EFI
Time multiplier setting for 3EFI
Inverse time characteristic selection of
OCI elements
2EFI
3EFI
T1EFI
T2EFI
0.05 − 1.00
T3EFI
0.05 − 1.00
Scheme switch
M1OCI to M3OCI
M1EFI to M3EFI
Scheme switch
[1OC1] to [3OC5]
[1OCI1] to [3OCI5]
[1EF1] to [3EF5]
[1EFI1] to [3EFI5]
Long-Std-Very-Ext
Long-Std-Very-Ext
Off/On
Std
Std
(**)
EFI elements
Enable or disable tripping by
OC elements
OCI elements
EF elements
EFI elements
(*) : Multiplier of CT secondary rated current.
(**) : Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
The overcurrent elements use the same three-phase line currents and neutral current as the
⎯ 41 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
differential protection and the restricted earth fault protection. When choosing settings, the
following relationships between the overcurrent elements and the connected windings must be
taken into account.
1OC, 1OCI :
2OC, 2OCI :
3OC, 3OCI :
1EF, 1EFI :
2EF, 2EFI :
3EF, 3EFI :
Primary (high-voltage) winding
Secondary (medium-voltage) winding
Tertiary (low-voltage) winding
1REF applied neutral circuit
2REF applied neutral circuit
3REF applied neutral circuit
⎯ 42 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.5 Thermal Overload Protection
The thermal overload protection is applied to protect transformers from electrical thermal damage.
A-phase current is used to detect the thermal overload of a transformer. The characteristics are
exponential functions according to the IEC 60255-8 standard and take into account the I2R losses
due to the particular operational current and the simultaneous cooling due to the coolant. In this
way the tripping time during an overload condition takes the pre-load into consideration. An alarm
stage can be set to operate before reaching the tripping condition.
Figure 2.5.1 shows the scheme logic of the thermal overcurrent protection. THR tripping output
can be given to up to five breakers. Any of the five breaker tripping signals THR-1 to THR-5 can
be blocked by the scheme switch [THR1] to [THR5] settings. Alarming signal THR-A can be
blocked by the scheme switch [THRA] setting.
83
&
&
&
THR-1
THR-2
THR-3
S
A
[THR1]
+
+
+
+
+
THR
87
“ON”
[THR2]
“ON”
[THR3]
“ON”
&
&
THR-4
THR-5
[THR4]
“ON”
[THR5]
351
THR TRIP
“ON”
≥1
248
&
THR-A
[THRA]
“ON”
+
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with THR-4 and THR-5.
Figure 2.5.1 Scheme Logic of Thermal Overload Protection
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for the thermal overload protection and their setting
ranges.
Element
Range
Step
0.1min
0.01
Default
60.0min
1.30
Remarks
Thermal time constant
Constant
τ
0.5 − 500.0min
0.10 − 4.00
0.50 − 2.50(*1)
0.00 − 1.00(*1)
0 − 10min
k
IB
Ip
TA
0.01
1.00
Basic current
0.01
0.00
Pre-specified load current
Time for alarm (before trip) (*3)
1min
10min
Scheme switch
THR1 to THR5
THRA
Enable or disable
Off/On
Off/On
(*2)
On
Trip
Alarm
(∗1): Multiplier of CT secondary rated current
(*2): Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
(*3): Alarming time = THR trip time (operating time) – T (setting time)
A
Note: Ip sets a minimum level of previous load current to be used by the thermal element, and is
typically used when testing the element. For the majority of applications, Ip should be set to
zero, in which case the previous load current, Ip, is calculated internally by the thermal
model, providing memory of conditions occurring before an overload.
⎯ 43 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.6 Frequency Protection
GRT100 provides underfrequency or overfrequency protection and/or alarms for load shedding or
for detecting such an overfrequency condition caused by disconnecting load from a particular
generation location.
The frequency element FRQ comprises two frequency elements 81-1 and 81-2, the former is used
for tripping and the latter for alarms.
Figure 2.6.1 shows the scheme logic of the frequency protection. The tripping element 81-1
outputs underfrequency and overfrequency trip signals L1 and H1. Either underfrequency or
overfrequency protection is selected by setting the scheme switch [FRQ-UF1] to “ON” or “OFF”.
The alarm element 81-2 outputs underfrequency and overfrequency alarm signals L2 and H2.
Either underfrequency or overfrequency alarms are selected by setting the scheme switch
[FRQ-UF2] to “ON” or “OFF”.
Frequency protection can perform time-delayed tripping of up to five breakers. Any of the breaker
tripping signals FRQ-1 to FRQ-5 can be blocked by the scheme switch [FRQ1] to [FRQ5]
settings.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with FRQ-4 and FRQ-5.
Alarm signal FRQ-A can be blocked by the scheme switch [FRQA] setting.
Frequency protection is blocked under the condition that the system voltage is lower than the
setting of the undervoltage element UV.
TFRQL
t
0
89
&
&
&
&
&
&
L1
L2
H1
FRQ-1
FRQ-2
FRQ-3
FRQ-4
FRQ-5
≥1
[FRQ1]
[FRQ2]
[FRQ3]
[FRQ4]
[FRQ5]
0.00 - 60.00s
TFRQH
+
+
+
+
+
90
91
&
&
81-1
81-2
t
0
1
1
92
0.00 - 60.00s
H2
&
119
UV
1
[FRQ-UF1]
[FRQ-UF1]
ON
353
+
ON
+
FRQ-UF TRIP
&
&
354
249
OFF
[FRQ-UF2]
ON
FRQ-OF TRIP
FRQ TRIP
+
≥1
[FRQ-UF2]
355
ON
+
FRQ-UF ALARM
&
&
356
257
OFF
FRQ-OF ALARM
FRQ A
TFRQA
t
0
≥1
&
[FRQA]
0.00 - 60.00s
+
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with FRQ-4 and FRQ-5.
Figure 2.6.1 Scheme Logic of Frequency Protection
⎯ 44 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for the frequency protection and their setting ranges.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
81-1 (L1, H1)
0.01Hz
0.01Hz
49.00Hz
59.00Hz) (*)
Trip
45.00 − 55.00Hz
(54.00 − 66.00Hz
81-2 (L2, H2)
0.01Hz
0.01Hz
48.00Hz
58.00Hz)
Alarms
45.00 − 55.00Hz
(54.00 − 66.00Hz
UV
1V
40V
Undervoltage block
40 − 100V
TFRQL
0.01s
10.00s
Underfrequency trip time
delay
0.00 − 60.00s
TFRQH
0.01s
0.01s
10.00s
10.00s
Overfrequency trip time
delay
0.00 − 60.00s
TFRQA
Alarm time delay
Enable or disable
Trip
0.00 − 60.00s
Scheme switch
[FRQ-UF1]
[FRQ-UF2]
[FRQ1] to [FRQ5]
[FRQA]
Off/On
Off/On
Off/On
Off/On
On
On
(**)
On
Alarm
Trip
Alarm
(*) : Frequency values shown in parentheses are for the case of 60Hz rating. Other frequency values
are shown for the case of 50Hz rating.
(**): Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
⎯ 45 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.7 Overexcitation Protection
Overexcitation protection is applied to protect transformers from overvoltage and overfluxing
conditions.
Any single phase-to-phase connected voltage is used to detect overexcitation. Trip and alarm
characteristics, which are based on a measurement of the voltage/frequency ratio, are provided.
Figure 2.7.1 shows the scheme logic of overexcitation protection. Overexcitation element V/F
responds to voltage/frequency and outputs three signals. Signal T has an inverse time
characteristic. Signals H and A have high-set and low-set definite time characteristics
respectively. Signal T and signal H with a delayed pick-up timer TVFH are used for tripping.
Signal A is used for alarm with a delayed pick-up timer TVFA.
The V/F element has a reset feature with definite time reset. The reset time RT is set to match the
cooling characteristic that is the time for the protected transformer to reach a normal temperature
after releasing the overexitation condition.
V/F-T
81
80
82
V/F-1
&
&
&
&
&
T
H
A
≥1
TVFH
[V/F1]
[V/F2]
[V/F3]
[V/F4]
[V/F5]
TV/F-H
0
t
+
+
+
+
+
V/F
V/F-2
V/F-3
V/F-4
1 - 600s
362
V/F-T
V/F-L TRIP
V/F-H TRIP
V/F TP
&
&
V/F-5
363
350
TV/F-H
≥1
TVFA
0
t
242
&
V/F-A
[V/FA]
1 - 600s
+
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with V/F-4 and V/F-5.
Figure 2.7.1 Scheme Logic of Overexcitation Protection
Overexcitation protection can trip up to five breakers. Any of the breaker tripping signals V/F-1 to
V/F-5 can be blocked by the scheme switch [V/F1] to [V/F5] settings.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with V/F-4 and V/F-5.
Alarm signal V/F-A can be blocked by the scheme switch [V/FA] setting.
⎯ 46 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for the overexcitation protection and their setting
ranges.
Element
Range
Step
0.1V
0.01
0.01
0.01
1s
Default Remarks
V
100.0V
1.03
Transformer rated voltage / VT ratio
100.0 − 120.0V
1.03 − 1.30(∗)
1.05 − 1.30
1.10 − 1.40
1 − 600s
A
Alarm
L
1.05
Low level
High level
H
LT
1.40
600s
Operation time at low level
(Inverse time curve)
HT
1s
1s
1s
1s
1s
Operation time at high level
(Inverse time curve)
1 − 600s
60 − 3600s
1 − 600s
1 − 600s
RT
250s
10s
10s
Reset time after removing
overexcitation condition
TVFH
Operating time at high level setting
(Definite time delay)
TVFA
Alarm time
(Definite time delay)
Scheme switch
[V/F1] to [V/F5] Off/On
[V/FA] Off/On
(**)
On
Enable or disable tripping
Enable or disable alarm
(∗): Multiplier of (rated voltage) / (rated frequency)
(**): Refer to Appendix H for default setting.
A: Alarm level
H: High level (definite time tripping)
V/Hz
H
L: Low level (pick up level)
HT: Operating time at high level
LT: Operating time at low level
TVFH: Operating time at high level setting
TVFA: Alarm time
Withstand curve for transformer overexcitation
L
A
sec
LT
HT
0 TVFA
TVFH
(log T)
Figure 2.7.2 Setting Points
⎯ 47 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.8 Trip by External Devices
Up to four binary signals EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP1 to EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP4 can be
used for tripping external devices. Figure 2.8.1 shows the scheme logic for the signal
EXT_MEC.TP1. The signal can trip up to five breakers. Any of the tripping signals
EXT_MEC.TP1-1 to EXT_MEC.TP4-5 can be blocked by the scheme switches [M.T1-1] to
[M.T1-5] setting.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with EXT_MEC.TP1-4 and EXT_MEC.TP1-5, and
[M.T1-4] and [M.T1-5].
The other binary signals have the same scheme logic.
1536
EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP1
EXT_MEC.TP1-1
EXT_MEC.TP1-2
&
&
&
&
&
[M.T1-1]
[M.T1-2]
[M.T1-3]
[M.T1-4]
[M.T1-5]
+
+
+
+
+
EXT_MEC.TP1-3
EXT_MEC.TP1-4
EXT_MEC.TP1-5
357
MEC.TRIP1
≥1
Figure 2.8.1
Scheme Logic of Trip by External Device
Setting
The following shows the setting elements for tripping by external devices and their setting ranges.
Element
Range
Step
Default
Remarks
Scheme switch
Enable or disable tripping
EXT_MEC.TP1-1 to -5
EXT_MEC.TP2-1 to -5
EXT_MEC.TP3-1 to -5
EXT_MEC.TP4-1 to -5
Off/On
(*)
(*): Default settings are dependent on the model. See Appendix H.
⎯ 48 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.9 Tripping Output
Figure 2.9.1 shows the tripping logic. Each protection can output five tripping signals to enable
tripping for five breakers. The tripping signals are set according to the number of breakers to be
tripped and drive the heavy duty, high-speed tripping output relays TRIP-1 to TRIP-5.
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with TRIP-4 and TRIP-5.
When the scheme switch [L/O] is set to “ON”, tripping signals can be locked and reset with the
〔RESET〕key on the front panel. When the switch is set to “OFF”, they are reset automatically
after clearing the fault.
The tripping output relays reset 200ms after the tripping signal disappears. When [L/O] is set to
“OFF”, the tripping circuit must be opened with the auxiliary contact of the breaker prior to reset
of the tripping relay to prevent the tripping relay from directly interrupting the tripping current of
the breaker.
⎯ 49 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TRIP-1
[L/O]
“ON”
+
Tripping output
relay
DIFT-1
Q
&
1
S
0
t
284
TRIP-1
≥1
≥1
F/F
≥1
R
1OC-1
1OCI-1
1REF-1
1EF-1
0.2s
≥1
≥1
≥1
&
1EFI-1
≥1
[RESET]
2OC-1
2OCI-1
2REF-1
2EF-1
2EFI-1
3OC-1
3OCI-1
3REF-1
3EF-1
3EFI-1
FRQ-1
V/F-1
≥1
THR-1
MECHANICAL TRIP1-1
MECHANICAL TRIP2-1
MECHANICAL TRIP3-1
MECHANICAL TRIP4-1
≥1
TRIP-2
0
t
291
298
305
312
TRIP-2
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
TRIP-5
Same as TRIP-1
0.2s
TRIP-3
0
t
Same as TRIP-1
0.2s
TRIP-4
0
t
Same as TRIP-1
0.2s
TRIP-5
t
0
Same as TRIP-1
0.2s
Figure 2.9.1 Tripping Logic
⎯ 50 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.10 Characteristics of Measuring Elements
2.10.1 Percentage Current Differential Element DIF
The segregated-phase current differential element DIF has dual percentage restraining
characteristics. Figure 2.10.1 shows the characteristics of DF1 and DF2 on the differential current
(I ) and restraining current (I ) plane. I is a vector summation of phase current of all windings
d
r
d
and I is a scalar summation of phase current of all windings.
r
I
I = 2I (one-end infeed)
d
d
r
DF2
ik
DF1
ik
2
kp
I
r
Figure 2.10.1 Current Differential Element
Characteristic DF1 is expressed by the following equation:
I ≥ p1 x I + (1 −p1/2)ik
d
r
where,
p1 : slope of DF1
ik : minimum operating current
Id and Ir are defined as follows for a three-winding transformer.
Id = | kct1⋅I1 + kct2⋅I2 + kct3⋅I3 |
Ir =(kct1⋅|I1 |+ kct2⋅|I2 |+ kct3⋅|I3 |)/2
where,
kct1 ,kct2 ,kct3 : CT ratio matching settings of primary, secondary and tertiary winding
I1 ,I2 ,I3 : currents of primary, secondary and tertiary winding
This characteristic has weaker restraint in the small current region and ensures sensitivity to low
level faults.
Characteristic DF2 is expressed by the following equation:
I ≥ p2 x I + (p1 −p2)kp + (1 −p1/2)ik
d
r
where,
p2 : slope of DF2
kp : break point of DF1 characteristic
This characteristic has stronger restraint in the large current region and ensures stability against
CT saturation during through faults.
⎯ 51 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.10.2 High-set Overcurrent Element HOC
High-set overcurrent element HOC is an instantaneous overcurrent characteristic, and is applied in
the differential circuit. The characteristic is expressed by the following equation:
I ≥ kh
d
Id is defined as follows for three-winding transformer.
Id = | kct1⋅I1 + kct2⋅I2 + kct3⋅I3 |
where,
kct1, kct2, kct3: CT ratio matching settings of primary, secondary and tertiary winding
HOC is an un-restrained current differential element which can protect a transformer against
damage due to a heavy internal fault, because it has a simple operation principle and high-speed
operation. Note that HOC is not immune to transformer inrush currents and therefore cannot be
applied with a sensitive setting.
2.10.3 Restricted Earth Fault Element REF
The restricted earth fault element REF is composed of REF_DIF and REF_DEF, as was shown in
Figure 2.3.2.
The REF_DIF has dual percentage restraining characteristics. Figure 2.10.2 shows the
characteristics on the differential current (Id) and restraining current (Ir) plane. Id is the
differential current between the residual current of each winding and the neutral current and Ir is
the restraining current which is the larger of the residual current and the neutral current.
I
d
DF2
DF1
max-kct⋅ik
kp
max-kct⋅ik
I
r
Figure 2.10.2 REF_DIF Characteristic
Characteristic DF1 is expressed by the following equation:
Id ≥ p1⋅Ir + (1-p1) ⋅ik⋅max-kct
where,
p1 : slope of DF1 (fixed to 10%)
ik : minimum operating current
max-kct : CT ratio matching of line CT to neutral CT (when plural line CTs are applied,
maximum kct is employed.)
For the 1REF element, Id and Ir are calculated by the following equations when applied to a circuit
with one neutral CT and three line CTs. (For the REF element application, see Appendix L.)
Id = |1kct1⋅I1o + 1kct2⋅I2o + 1kct3⋅I3o + IN |
⎯ 52 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Ir = max.( 1kct1⋅|I1a| , 1kct1⋅|I1b| , 1kct1⋅|I1c| , 1kct2⋅|I2a| , 1kct2⋅|I2b| , 1kct2⋅|I2c| ,1kct3⋅|I3a| ,
1kct3⋅|I3b| , 1kct3⋅|I3c| , |IN| )
where,
I1o ,I2o ,I3o : residual current of primary, secondary and tertiary winding
I1a ,I1b ,I1c ,I2a ,I2b ,I2c ,I3a ,I3b ,I3c : phase current of primary, secondary and tertiary winding
IN : residual current of neutral circuit
1kct1, 1kct2, 1kct3: CT ratio matching of primary, secondary and tertiary line CT to neutral
CT
Characteristic DF2 is expressed by the following equation:
Id ≥ p2 (Ir−kp)
where
p2 : slope of DF2
kp : break point of DF1 characteristic
The characteristic of REF_DEF is composed of a directional characteristic and a non-directional
characteristic as shown in Figure 2.10.3 (a) and (b). This characteristic is employed so that the
REF is not blocked at one-end infeed current IN.
90°
(*1)
3I0
180°
0°
0
IN
Ik2
3I0
Ik1
Operating
270°
Ik1, ik2: Current sensitivity (0.01pu, 0.025pu fixed)
IN: Neutral current of transformer
3I0: Zero sequence current (calculated from Ia, Ib, Ic)
*1: MAX(Ia,Ib,Ic) ≤ 2×MAX(kct1,kct2,kct3)
(a)
(b)
Figure 2.10.3 REF_DEF Characteristic
The REF_DEF detects an internal fault by checking the direction between transformer neutral
current IN and zero-sequence current 3I0 calculated from phase currents Ia, Ib and Ic. The REF_DEF
is blocked when the maximum phase current is larger than 2 times of Max-kct as follows:
Max.(1kct1•I1a, ….1kct3•I3c) ≥ IBLK=Max.(1kct1,1kct2,1kct3)×2
⎯ 53 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(Example)
Primary
Secondary
CT ratio: 2400/1
CT ratio: 3600/1
kct1=2
I01
kct2=3
I02
max-kct = 3
Therefore, REF is blocked at
I
BLK=3×2.0=6A (CT secondary)
CT ratio:
1200/1
IN
If the maximum of phase
currents of both primary and
secondary windings is 7200A
(=6x1200A), the REF is blocked.
Reference current: 1200A
(Rated current of neutral CT)
1REF
2.10.4 Inverse Time Overcurrent Element OCI and EFI
The OCI and EFI elements have one long time inverse characteristic and three inverse time
characteristics in conformity with IEC 60255-3 as shown in Figure 2.10.4. One of these
characteristics can be selected.
These characteristics are expressed by the following equations and curves.
(s)
T=1.0
200
100
50
Long Time Inverse
120
(I/Is)−1
t = T ×
20
10
Standard Inverse
0.14
t = T ×
(I/Is)0.02 − 1
Long-time Inverse
5
Very Inverse
13.5
Operating
time
t = T ×
(I/Is) − 1
Standard Inverse
Very Inverse
2
1
Extremely Inverse
80
t = T ×
(I/Is)2 − 1
where,
0.5
t : operating time
I : fault current
Is : current setting
T : time multiplier setting
0.2
0.1
Extremely Invease
1
2
5
10
20 30
Current I (Multiple of setting current)
Figure 2.10.4 Characteristics of Inverse Time Overcurrent Element
⎯ 54 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.10.5 Definite Time Overcurrent element OC and EF
The OC and EF elements measure the phase currents and the residual current respectively.
2.10.6 Thermal Overload Element THR
Thermal overload element THR has a characteristic based on thermal replica according to the IEC
60255-8 standard (see Appendix N), which evaluates the phase current (A-phase) of the CT
secondary circuits. Figure 2.10.5 shows the characteristic of THR element. The element has trip
and alarm stages.
Trip stage:
I2 − Ip2
I − (k x IB)
2
2
t = τ x Ln
Alarm stage:
(I2 − Ip2) x (1 − T /τ)
A
t = τ x Ln
I2 − (k x IB)2
where
t : operating time
τ : thermal time constant
I : load current
kxI : allowable overload current as specified in IEC 60255-8 (refer to Appendix N)
B
I : basic current of transformer (rated current)
B
k : constant (allowable overload current / I )
B
Ip : prior load current before the overload occurs
T
: time for alarm
A
(Alarming time = t (operating time) – T
A (setting time)
Ln : natural logarithm
Figure 2.10.6 shows the thermal curve for a range of time constant settings in the cold state when
the prior load current Ip is zero.
⎯ 55 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
t
T
A
Trip
Alarm
T
A
0
I
K ⋅ I
B
Figure 2.10.5 Characteristic of Thermal Overload Element
Thermal Curves (Cold Curve - no
prior load)
10000
1000
100
τ
10
500
100
1
50
20
10
0.1
5
2
1
0.01
1
10
Overload Current (Multiple of kIB)
Figure 2.10.6 Thermal Curves
⎯ 56 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2.10.7 Frequency Element FRQ
GRT100 has two elements for trip or alarm. Each element operates either in overfrequency or
underfrequency.
2.10.8 Overexcitation Element V/F
The characteristic is based on the ratio of voltage to frequency. The alarm is definite time
delayed, while the tripping characteristic is either definite time or inverse time, as shown in
Figure 2.10.7.
A: Alarm level
H: High level (definite time tripping)
V/Hz
H
L: Low level (pick up level)
HT: Operating time at high level
LT: Operating time at low level
TVFH: Operating time at high level setting
TVFA: Alarm time
L
A
sec
LT
HT
0 TVFA
TVFH
(log T)
Figure 2.10.7 Characteristic of Overexcitation Element
The inverse time characteristic of V/F is expressed by the following equation.
K2
t =
(V/F) − K1
where,
t : operating time
V : voltage (any phase-to-phase voltage)
F : frequency
V/F=(Vm/Fm) / (Vs/Fs)
(Vm: Input voltage, Fm: Input frequency, Vs: Setting of rated voltage, Fs: Rated frequency)
(LT) × L − (HT) × H
K1=
(LT) − (HT)
(LT) × (HT) × (H − L)
K2=
(LT) − (HT)
The V/F element has a reset feature with definite time reset (RT). When the V/F falls below the
reset threshold, the integral state of the inverse time function is reset to the initial value after the
RT time.
Example: V/F=(Vin/Fin)/(V/Fs)=(130/50)/(100/50)=1.3, in case of Vin: Input voltage (130V),
Fin: Input frequency (50Hz), V: Rated voltage (100V), Fs: Rated frequency (50Hz)
⎯ 57 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3. Technical Description
3.1 Hardware Description
3.1.1 Outline of Hardware Modules
The case outline of GRT100 is shown in Appendix F.
The hardware structures of the models are shown in Figure 3.1.1 and Figure 3.1.2. The front
view shows the equipment without the human machine interface module.
The GRT100 consists of the following hardware modules. The human machine interface module
is provided with the front panel.
• Transformer module (VCT)
• Signal processing module (SPM)
• Binary input and output module #1 (IO1 or IO8)
• Binary input and output module #2 (IO2)
• Binary output module #3 (IO3)
• Human machine interface module (HMI)
Front view without front panel
VCT
IO2 SPM IO1 or
IO8
Figure 3.1.1 Hardware Structure (Model: 101, 201, 203)
⎯ 58 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
VCT
IO3 IO2 SPM IO1 or
IO8
Figure 3.1.2 Hardware Structure (Model: 102, 202, 204)
The correspondence between each model and module used is as follows:
Models 101
102
201
202
203
204
Module
VCT
SPM
IO1
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
IO2
×
×
×
×
×
IO3
IO8
×
×
HMI
×
×
×
×
Note: The VCT and SPM modules are not interchangeable among different models.
The hardware block diagram of the GRT100 using these moduls is shown in Figure 3.1.3.
⎯ 59 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Binary I/O Module (IO1 or IO8)
DC/DC
DC
Converter
supply
Transformer
Signal Processing Module (SPM)
Module (VCT)
Binary input
×13 or 12
I
×
CT 8
A/D
Analogue
filter
Binary output
(High speed)
×
Converter
or CT 12
Trip
command
MPU1
×
AC input
V
or CT 15
×
5 or 3
×
VT 1
Binary I/O Module (IO2)
Opt. I/F
or
Ethernet
LAN I/F
Binary output
×14
External
clock
IRIG-B
port
Binary input
×
3
RS485
Remote
Transceiver
Setting and
Monitoring
System
Human Machine Interface (HMI)
Remote PC
Liquid crystal display
(*1)
Binary I/O Module (IO3)
40characters×4lines
Binary output
Operation keys
Monitoring jacks
LEDs
×
10
Local
Personal
RS232C
I/F
Computer
(*1) I03: required for Model 102, 202, 204
Figure 3.1.3 Hardware Block Diagram (Models 101, 102, 201, 202, 203 and 204)
⎯ 60 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.2 Transformer Module
The transformer module (VCT module) provides isolation between the internal and external
circuits through auxiliary transformers and transforms the magnitude of the AC input signals to
suit the electronic circuits. The AC input signals are as follows:
• three-phase currents (I , I and I ) for each winding
a b
c
• neutral current (I ) for each winding
N
• phase-to-phase voltage
Figure 3.1.4 shows a block diagram of the transformer module. There are 8 to 12 auxiliary CTs
and 1 auxiliary VT mounted in the transformer module depending on the relay model. (For the
correspondence between the relay model and number of AC input signals, see Table 3.2.1.)
The transformer module is also provided with an IRIG-B port. This port collects the serial
IRIG-B format data from an external clock for synchronization of the relay calendar clock. The
IRIG-B port is isolated from the external circuit by a photo-coupler. A BNC connector is used as
the input connector.
I
a1
I
b1
I
c1
I
N1
I
I
I
I
a2
b2
c2
N2
Signal
processing
module
V
IRIG-B port
External
clock
BNC connector
Figure 3.1.4 Transformer Module (e.g. models 101, 102)
⎯ 61 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.3 Signal Processing Module
The signal processing and communication module (SPM) incorporates a signal processing
circuit and a communication control circuit. Figure 3.1.3.1 shows the block diagram.
The signal processing circuit consists of an analog filter, multiplexer, analog to digital (A/D)
converter, main processing unit (MPU) and memories (RAM and ROM), and executes all kinds
of processing including protection, measurement, recording and display.
The SPM contains a lithium-ion battery, which should be removed at the end-of-life of the
product. The nominal backup time of a lithium-ion battery is one year after the shipment from
the factory.
The analog filter performs low-pass filtering for the corresponding current and voltage signals.
The A/D converter has a resolution of 16 bits and samples input signals at sampling frequencies
of 2400Hz (at 50Hz) and 2880Hz (at 60Hz).
The MPU carries out operations for the measuring elements and scheme logic operations for
protection, recording, displaying and signal transmission control.
The SPM can be provided with Optical interface or Ethernet LAN interface for serial
communication system.
Analog filter
A/D
converter
MPU
Other
modules
Analog filter
Analog filter
Multiplexer
Analog
input
RAM
ROM
Link with Serial
communication
system
Optical I/F
(Option)
Ethernet LAN
I/F (Option)
Figure 3.1.3.1 Signal Processing Module
⎯ 62 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.4 Binary Input and Output Module
There are four types of binary input and output module (IO module): These modules are fitted
according to the model (see Section 3.1.1).
3.1.4.1 IO1 and IO8 Module
IO1 and IO8 provide a DC/DC converter, binary inputs and binary outputs for tripping.
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.1, the IO1 module incorporates a DC/DC converter, 15 photo-coupler
circuits (BI) for binary input signals and 6 auxiliary relays (TP1 to 5) dedicated to the circuit
breaker tripping command.
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.2, the IO8 module incorporates a DC/DC converter, 12 photo-coupler
circuits (BI) for binary input signals and 3 auxiliary relays (TP) dedicated to the circuit breaker
tripping command. The 12 binary inputs have dedicated positive and negative inputs suitable for
double-pole switching.
The nominal input voltage rating of the DC/DC converter is 24V, 48V, 110V/125V or
220V/250V. The normal range of input voltage is −20% to +20%.
The five or three tripping command auxiliary relays are the high-speed operation type and have
one normally open output contact.
DC
supply
Line filter
(+)
(−)
FG
DC/DC
converter
Photo-coupler
BI
Auxiliary relay
(high speed)
TP-1
BI
BI
Binary
input
signals
TP-2
TP-3
Tripping
command
(× 15)
TP-4
TP-5
BI
BI
Figure 3.1.4.1 IO1 Module
⎯ 63 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IO8 module
Line filter
DC/DC
converter
(+)
DC
supply
(−)
FG
Photo-coupler
Auxiliary relay
(high speed)
BI
TP-1
BI
BI
Tripping
command
(× 3)
Binary
input
signals
TP-2
TP-3
(× 12)
BI
BI
Figure 3.1.4.2 IO8 Module
⎯ 64 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.4.2 IO2 Module
As shown in Figure 3.1.4.3, the IO2 module incorporates 3 photo-coupler circuits (BI14-BI16) for
binary input signals, 14 auxiliary relays (BO1-BO13 and FAIL) for binary output signals and an
RS-485 transceiver.
The auxiliary relay FAIL has one normally closed contact, and operates when a relay failure or
abnormality in the DC circuit is detected. BO1 to BO13 each have one normally open contact.
BO12 and BO13 are the high-speed operation type.
The RS-485 transceiver is used for the link with the relay setting and monitoring (RSM) system.
The external signal is isolated from the relay internal signal.
Auxiliary relay
BO1
Photo-coupler
BI14
BO2
FAIL
Binary
output
signals
Binary
input
signals
BI15
BI16
RS-485
Transceiver
Link with RSM
system
RS-485
Transceiver
Link with
IEC60870-5-103
Communication
system
Figure 3.1.4.3 IO2 Module
⎯ 65 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.4.3 IO3 Module
The IO3 module is used to increase the number of binary outputs.
The IO3 module incorporates 10 auxiliary relays (BO1-BO10) for binary outputs. All auxiliary
relays each have one normally open contact.
IO3 module
Auxiliary relay
BO1
BO2
Binary
output
signals
BO9
BO10
Figure 3.1.4.4 IO3 Module
⎯ 66 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.1.5 Human Machine Interface (HMI) Module
The operator can access the GRT100 via the human machine interface (HMI) module. As shown
in Figure 3.1.5, the HMI module has a liquid crystal display (LCD), light emitting diodes (LED),
view and reset keys, operation keys, testing jacks and an RS-232C connector on the front panel.
The LCD consists of 40 columns by 4 rows with a backlight and displays record, status and setting
data.
There are a total of 8 LED indicators and their signal labels and LED colors are defined as follows:
Label
Color
Green
Red
Remarks
IN SERVICE
TRIP
Lit when relay is in service.
Lit when trip command is issued.
Lit when failure is detected.
ALARM
TESTING
Red
Lit when disabling automatic monitoring function or resetting
the time counting of THR and V/F elements by the
scheme switches.
Red
(LED1)
(LED2)
(LED3)
(LED4)
Red
Red
Red
Red
LED1 to LED4 are user-configurable.
Once it has started operating, the TRIP LED continues to operate even after the trip command
disappears. Pressing the RESET key resets it. Other LEDs operate as long as a signal is present.
The RESET key is ineffective for these LEDs.
The VIEW key starts the LCD indication and switches between windows. The reset key clears the
LCD indication and turns off the LCD backlight.
The operation keys are used to display the record, status and setting data on the LCD, input the
settings or change the settings.
The monitoring jacks and two pairs of LEDs, A and B, on top of the jacks can be used while the
test mode is selected in the LCD window. Signals can be displayed on LED A or LED B by
selecting the signal to be observed from the "Signal List" or "Variable Timer List" and setting it in
the window and the signals can be transmitted to an oscilloscope via the monitoring jacks. (For the
"Signal List" or "Variable Timer List", see Appendix B or C.)
The RS-232C connector is a 9-way D-type connector for serial RS-232C connection. This
connector is used for connection with a local personal computer.
⎯ 67 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TRANSFORMER PROTECTION
GRT100
101D-21-11
Operation
keys
Figure 3.1.5 Front Panel
⎯ 68 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.2 Input and Output Signals
3.2.1 Input Signals
AC input signals
Table 3.2.1 shows the AC input signals necessary for each of the GRT100 models and their
respective input terminal numbers. See Appendix G for external connections.
Winding 1, 2 and 3 in the Table correspond to high-voltage or primary, medium-voltage or
secondary, and low-voltage or tertiary winding respectively.
Table 3.2.1
Terminal GRT100-101, 102
AC Input Signals
Terminal GRT100-201, 202, 203, 204
No.
No.
TB1
TB1
1-2
A phase current of winding 1
1-2
A phase current of winding 1
B phase current of winding 1
C phase current of winding 1
Neutral current of winding 1
A phase current of winding 2
B phase current of winding 2
C phase current of winding 2
Neutral current of winding 2
A phase current of winding 3
B phase current of winding 3
C phase current of winding 3
Neutral current of winding 3
⎯
3-4
B phase current of winding 1
3-4
5-6
C phase current of winding 1
5-6
7-8
Neutral current of winding 1
7-8
9-10
A phase current of winding 2
9-10
11-12
13-14
15-16
17-18
19-20
21-22
23-24
25-26
27-28
B phase current of winding 2
11-12
13-14
15-16
17-18
19-20
21-22
23-24
25-26
27-28
C phase current of winding 2
Neutral current of winding 2
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Phase to phase voltage of
winding 1
Phase to phase voltage of
winding 1
30
30
(earth)
(earth)
Binary input signals
Table 3.2.2 shows the binary input signals necessary for the GRT100, their driving contact
conditions and functions enabled. See Appendix G for external connections.
The binary input circuit of the GRT100 is provided with a logic level inversion function as shown
in Figure 3.2.1. Each input circuit has a binary switch BISW which can be used to select either
normal or inverted operation. This allows the inputs to be driven either by normally open or
normally closed contacts. Where the driving contact meets the contact conditions indicated in
Table 3.2.2 then the BISW can be set to “N” (normal). If not, then “I” (inverted) should be
selected.
The default setting of the BISW is "N" (normal) for all input signals.
Further, all binary input functions are programmable by PLC (Programmable Logic Circuit)
function.
If a signal is not required, the function concerned is disabled.
The operating voltage of binary input signal is typical 74V DC at 110V/125V DC rating and 138V
DC at 220/250V DC. The minimum operating voltage is 70V DC at 110/125V DC rating and
125V DC at 220/250V DC.
⎯ 69 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table 3.2.2 Binary Input Signals
Signal Names
Driving Contact Condition / Function Enabled
BISW∗ (default)
External Mechanical trip Closed when external device operated. / Initiate trip command
(EXT_MEC.TP1) from operation of external device.
External Mechanical trip Closed when external device operated. / Initiate trip command
(EXT_MEC.TP2) from operation of external device.
External Mechanical trip Closed when external device operated. / Initiate trip command
(EXT_MEC.TP3) from operation of external device.
External Mechanical trip Closed when external device operated. / Initiate trip command
1
2
3
4
(EXT_MEC.TP4)
Indication reset
from operation of external device.
Closed to reset TRIP LED indication. / Reset indication
externally.
5
Protection block
Closed to block the protection. / Block the protection
externally.
6
Signal for event record
Signal for event record
Signal for event record
Closed when external device operated. / Initiate event record
with external signal.
Closed when external device operated. / Initiate event record
with external signal.
Closed when external device operated. / Initiate event record
with external signal.
14
15
16
Signal No.
GRT100
(+)
(−)
BI1
External Mechanical trip
BISW1 (Norm)
Protection
schemes
BI1
BI2
BI3
PLC function
1
(Inv)
BI2
BI3
External Mechanical trip
External Mechanical trip
BISW2 (Norm)
Programmable
logic
1
(Inv)
BISW3 (Norm)
1
(Inv)
1
0V
Figure 3.2.1 Logic Level Inversion
3.2.2
Binary Output Signals
The number of output binary signals and their output terminals vary depending on the relay model.
See Appendix G for details. For all models, all outputs except the tripping command, signal for
command protections and relay failure signal can be configured.
The signals shown in the signal list in Appendix B can be assigned to the output relay individually
or in arbitrary combinations. Signals can be combined using either an AND circuit or OR circuit
with 6 gates each as shown in Figure 3.2.2. The output circuit can be configured according to the
setting menu. Appendix D shows the factory default settings.
A 0.2s delayed drop-off timer can be attached to these assigned signals. The delayed drop-off time
is disabled by the scheme switch [BOTD].
The relay failure contact closes when a relay defect or abnormality in the DC power supply circuit
is detected.
⎯ 70 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal List
+(ON)
−(OFF)
0
BOTD
&
Auxiliary relay
t
Appendix C
&
6 GATES
6 GATES
≧1
0.2s
OR
≧1
Figure 3.2.2 Configurable Output
3.2.3 PLC (Programmable Logic Controller) Function
GRT100 is provided with a PLC function allowing user-configurable sequence logics on binary
signals. The sequence logics with timers, flip-flops, AND, OR, NOT logics, etc. can be produced
by using the PC software “PLC tool” and linked to signals corresponding to relay elements or
binary circuits.
Configurable binary inputs, binary outputs and LEDs, and the initiation trigger of disturbance
record are programmed by the PLC function. Temporary signals are provided for complicated
logics or for using a user-configured signal in many logic sequences.
PLC logic is assigned to protection signals by using the PLC editor tool. For PLC tool, refer to
PLC tool instruction manual.
Figure 3.2.3
Sample Screen of PLC Tool
⎯ 71 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.3 Automatic Supervision
3.3.1 Basic Concept of Supervision
Though the protection system is in a non-operating state under normal conditions, it is waiting for
a power system fault to occur at any time and must operate for the fault without fail. Therefore, the
automatic supervision function, which checks the health of the protection system during normal
operation by itself, plays an important role. A numerical relay based on microprocessor
technology is able to implement such as automatic supervision function. GRT100 implements an
automatic supervision function based on the following concept:
• The supervising function should not affect protection performance.
• Perform supervision with no omissions wherever possible.
• When a failure occurs, it should be possible to easily identify the failure location.
Note: Automatic supervision function includes automatic monitor function and automatic test
function. For the terminology, refer to IEC IEV 60448.
3.3.2 Relay Monitoring and Testing
The relay is supervised with the following items.
AC input imbalance monitoring
The AC current input is monitored such that the following equation is satisfied and the health of
the AC input circuit is checked.
Max(|I |, |I |, |I |) − 4 × Min(|I |, |I |, |I |) ≥ k
0
a
b
c
a
b
c
where,
Max(|I |, |I |, |I |) = Maximum amplitude among I , I and I
a
b
c
a b
c
Min(|I |, |I |, |I |) = Minimum amplitude among I , I and I
a
b
c
a b
c
k = 20% of rated current
0
A/D accuracy checking
An analogue reference voltage is transmitted to a prescribed channel in the analogue-to-digital
(A/D) converter, and it is checked that the data after A/D conversion is within a prescribed range
and that the A/D conversion characteristics are correct.
Memory monitoring
The memories are monitored as follows depending on the type of the memory and checked that the
memory circuits are healthy:
• Random access memory monitoring:
Writes/reads prescribed data and checks the storage function.
• Program memory monitoring: Checks the checksum value of the written data.
• Setting value monitoring:
Checks discrepancy between the setting values stored in
duplicate.
Watchdog Timer
A hardware timer which is cleared periodically by software is provided and it is checked that the
software is running normally.
⎯ 72 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
DC Supply monitoring
The secondary voltage level of the built-in DC/DC converter is monitored and checked that the
DC voltage is within a prescribed range.
3.3.3 PLC Data and IEC61850 Mapping Data Monitoring
If there is a failure in PLC data and IEC61850 mapping data, the function may be stopped.
Therefore, the PLC data and IEC61850 mapping data are monitored and an alarm of "PLC stop" or
"MAP stop" is issued if any failure detected.
3.3.4 IEC61850 Communication Monitoring
The sending and receiving functions in the Ethernet LAN communication are monitored. The
receiving function is executed by checking GOOSE message receiving status, and the sending
function is executed by checking Ping response to the other party. If a failure is detected, an alarm
of "GOOSE stop" or "Ping err" is issued.
These functions are disabled by setting the scheme switches [GSECHK] and [PINGCHK].
3.3.5 Failure Alarms
When a failure is detected by the automatic supervision, it is followed with LCD display, LEDs
indication, external alarms and event recording. Table 3.3.1 summarizes the supervision items and
alarms.
The LCD messages are shown on the "Auto-supervision" screen which is displayed automatically
VIEW
when a failure is detected or displayed by pressing the
key. The event record messages
are shown on the "Event record" screen by opening the "Record" sub-menu.
Those alarms are retained until the failure is recovered.
Those alarms can be disabled collectively by setting the scheme switch [AMF] to OFF. The setting
is used to block unnecessary alarms during commissioning test or maintenance.
When the Watchdog Timer detects that the software fails to run normally, LCD display and event
recording on the failure cannot be expected.
DC supply failure disables the LCD display and event recording on the failure as well.
For the discrimination of the two failures mentioned above, refer to Section 6.7.2.
Table 3.3.1 Supervision Items and Alarms
Supervision Item
LCD Message LED
LED
Ext. alarm
Event record
Message
"IN SERVICE" "ALARM"
AC input
imbalance monitoring
(1)
On/Off (2)
Off
On
On
(4)
(4)
CT err
Relay fail
A/D accuracy check
CPU, Memory monitoring
Watchdog Timer
A/D err
(1)
Relay fail
----
Off
Off
On
(3)
(4)
(4)
----
DC supply monitoring
----
Relay fail
PLC data or IEC61850
mapping data monitoring
PLC stop or
MAP stop
on
on
on
on
(4)
(4)
Relay fail-A
Relay fail-A
GOOSE message check
GOOSE stop
⎯ 73 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Supervision Item
LCD Message LED
LED
Ext. alarm
Event record
Message
"IN SERVICE" "ALARM"
Ping response check
Ping err
on on
(4)
Relay fail-A
(1): Diverse messages are provided as expressed with "---fail" in the Table in Section 6.7.2.
(2): The LED is on when the scheme switch [SVCNT] is set to "ALM" and off when set to
"ALM & BLK" (refer to Section 3.3.4).
(3): Whether the LED is lit or not depends on the degree of the voltage drops.
(4): The binary output relay "FAIL" operates.
3.3.6 Trip Blocking
When a failure is detected by the following supervision items, the trip function is blocked as long
as the failure exists and restored when the failure is removed.
• A/D accuracy check
• Memory monitoring
• Watchdog Timer
• DC supply monitoring
When a failure is detected by the AC input imbalance monitoring, the scheme switch [SVCNT]
setting can be used to determine if both tripping is blocked and an alarm is initiated, or, if only an
alarm is initiated.
3.3.7 Setting
The setting elements necessary for the automatic supervision and its setting range are shown in the
table below.
Element
Range
Step
Default
ALM&BLK
OFF
Remarks
[SVCNT]
ALM&BLK / ALM
OFF/ON
Alarming and/or blocking
GOOSE check
[GSECHK]
[PINGCHK]
OFF/ON
OFF
Ping response check
⎯ 74 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.4 Recording Function
GRT100 is provided with the following recording functions:
Fault recording
Event recording
Disturbance recording
These records are displayed on the LCD of the relay front panel or on the local or remote PC.
3.4.1 Fault Recording
Fault recording is started by a tripping command of the GRT100 or PLC command by user-setting
(max. 8) and the following items are recorded for one fault:
Date and time of fault occurrence
Operating phase or fault phase
Tripping command
Tripping mode
Power system quantities
Up to the 8 most-recent faults can be stored as fault records. If a new fault occurs when 8 faults
have been stored, the record of the oldest fault is deleted and the record of the latest fault is then
stored.
Date and time of fault occurrence
The time resolution is 1ms using the relay internal clock.
To be precise, this is the time at which a tripping command has been initiated, and thus it is
approximately 10 ms after the occurrence of the fault.
Operating phase or fault phase
The operating phase or fault phase can be selected to be displayed following tripping, depending
on the requirements of user.
For details, see Section 2.3.1.
Tripping command
The tripping output relay(s) operated is shown in terms of its number (e.g. TP-1: 1, TP-2: 2 etc.).
Tripping mode
This shows the protection scheme that initiated the tripping command.
Power system quantities
The following power system quantities for pre-fault and post-fault are recorded.
-
-
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current of each winding (I , I , I up to I , I , I )
a1 b1 c1 a3 b3 c3
Magnitude and phase angle of neutral current of each winding (I up to I
n1
)
n3
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component current of each winding (I , I , I
11 21 01
up to I , I , I
)
13 23 03
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase-to-phase voltage (V)
⎯ 75 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
-
-
-
Magnitude of phase differential current (I
I
I )
da, db, dc
Magnitude of residual differential current for REF protection (I
up to I
)
d03
d01
Percentage of thermal capacity (THM%)
Phase angles above are expressed taking that of the voltage as a reference phase angle. If the
voltage input is not provided, then the positive sequence current of the primary winding is used as
a reference phase angle.
3.4.2 Event Recording
The events shown are recorded with a 1 ms resolution time-tag when the status changes. The user
can set a maximum of 128 recording items, and their status change mode. The event items can be
assigned to a signal number in the signal list. The status change mode is set to “On” (only
recording On transitions) or “On/Off”(recording both On and Off transitions) mode by setting.
The “On/Off” mode events are specified by “Bi-trigger events” setting. If the “Bi-trigger events”
is set to “100”, No.1 to 100 events are “On/Off” mode and No.101 to 128 events are “On” mode.
The name of an event cannot be set on LCD. It can set only by RSM100. Maximum 22 characters
can be set and can be viewed on both of the LCD and RSM Setting(view) screen. But the LCD
screen of event record displays only 11 characters. Therefore, it is recommended the maximum 11
characters are set.
The elements necessary for event recording and their setting ranges are shown in the table below.
The default setting of event record is shown in Appendix H.
Element
Range
0 - 128
0 - 3071
Step
Default
Remarks
BITRN
1
100
Number of bi-trigger(on/off) events
Assign the signal number
EV1 – EV128
Up to 1024 records can be stored. If an additional event occurs when 1024 records have been
stored, the oldest event record is deleted and the latest event record is then stored.
3.4.3 Disturbance Recording
Disturbance Recording is started when overcurrent starter elements operate or a tripping command
is output, or PLC command by user-setting (max. 4: Signal No. 2632 to 2635) is output. The
records include 13 analog signals (primary: I , I , I , I , secondary: I , I , I , I
,
a1 b1 c1 n1 a2 b2 c2 n2
tertiary: I , I , I , I , voltage: V), 32 binary signals and the dates and times at which
a3 b3 c3 n3
recording started. Any binary signal in shown in Appendix B can be assigned by the binary signal
setting of disturbance record. The default setting of binary signal is shown in Appendix H.
The name of binary signal can be set only by RSM100. Maximum 22 characters can be set and can
be viewed on both of the LCD and RSM Setting(view) screen. But the waveform data analysis
screen of disturbance record displays up to 11 characters of them. Therefore, it is recommended
the maximum 11 characters are set.
The LCD display only shows the dates and times of the disturbance records stored. Details can be
displayed on a PC. For how to obtain disturbance records on the PC, see the PC software
instruction manual.
The post-fault recording time can be set between 0.1 and 3.0s and the default setting is 1.0s. The
pre-fault recording time depends on the post recording time. The pre-fault recording time is fixed
at 0.3s.
⎯ 76 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
The number of records stored depends on the post-fault recording time. The approximate
relationship between the post-fault recording time and the number of records stored is shown in
Table 3.4.2.
Note: If the recording time setting is changed, all previously recorded data is deleted.
Table 3.4.2 Post Fault Recording Time and Number of Disturbance Records Stored
Recording
time
Model
0.1s
0.5s
1.0s
1.5s
2.0s
2.5s
3.0s
Frequency
101,102
50Hz
60Hz
50Hz
60Hz
40
40
40
40
34
28
25
21
20
17
15
13
15
12
11
9
11
9
9
8
7
6
8
6
6
5
201,202
203,204
8
7
Disturbance recording is initiated when overcurrent elements operate, a tripping signal is output,
2F or 5F element operates or external event signals are input. Three phase overcurrent elements
1OCP-S to 3OCP-S are applied to the line CTs and neutral overcurrent elements 1OCP-G to
3OCP-G to the neutral CTs.
The initiations are blocked by the scheme switches.
Settings
The elements necessary for starting disturbance recording and their setting ranges are shown in the
table below.
Element
1OCP-S
2OCP-S
3OCP-S
1OCP-G
2OCP-G
3OCP-G
Range
Step
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
Default(**)
Remarks
0.10 - 20.00(*)
0.10 - 20.00(*)
0.10 - 20.00(*)
0.05 - 20.00(*)
0.05 - 20.00(*)
0.05 - 20.00(*)
ON/OFF
Phase overcurrent element
Neutral overcurrent element
Scheme switch
TRIP1 to TRIP5
1OCPS to 3OCPS
1OCPG to 3OCPG
2F
Initiating disturbance record
by tripping
by phase overcurrent element
by neutral overcurrent element
by 2F element
5F
by 5F element
EVENT1 to EVENT3
by external event
(*) : Multiplier of CT secondary rated current
(**): Default settings are dependent on the models. See Appendix H.
⎯ 77 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3.5 Metering Function
The GRT100 performs continuous measurement of the analogue input quantities. The
measurement data shown below are displayed on the LCD of the relay front panel or on the local
or remote PC.
-
-
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase current of each winding (I , I , I up to I , I , I )
a1 b1 c1 a3 b3 c3
Magnitude and phase angle of neutral current of each winding (I up to I
n1
)
n3
Magnitude and phase angle of symmetrical component current of each winding (I , I , I
11 21 01
up to I , I , I
)
13 23 03
-
-
Magnitude and phase angle of phase-to-phase voltage (V)
Magnitude of phase differential current (I I )
I
da, db, dc
-
-
-
Magnitude of residual differential current for REF protection (I
Percentage of thermal capacity (THM%)
Frequency
up to I
)
d03
d01
Phase angles above are expressed taking that of positive sequence voltage as a reference phase
angle, where leading phase angles are expressed as positive values.
The above system quantities are displayed in values on the primary side or on the secondary side
of the CT according to a setting. To display accurate values, it is necessary to set the CT ratio and
VT ratio too. For the setting method, see "Setting the transformer parameters" in 4.2.6.7.
⎯ 78 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4. User Interface
4.1 Outline of User Interface
The user can access the relay from the front panel.
Local communication with the relay is also possible using a personal computer (PC) via an
RS232C port. Furthermore, remote communication is also possible using RSM (Relay Setting and
Monitoring), IEC103 communication via an RS485, optical fibre or Ethernet LAN etc.
This section describes the front panel configuration and the basic configuration of the menu tree of
the local human machine communication ports and HMI (Human Machine Interface).
4.1.1 Front Panel
As shown in Figure 3.1.13, the front panel is provided with a liquid crystal display (LCD), light
RESET
keys, monitoring jack and RS232C
emitting diodes (LED), operation keys,
connector.
and
VIEW
LCD
The LCD screen, provided with a 4-line, 40-character back-light, displays detailed information of
the relay interior such as records, status and setting. The LCD screen is normally unlit, but
pressing the
key will display the digest screen and pressing any key other than
VIEW
VIEW
RESET
and
will display the menu screen.
END
RESET
These screens are turned off by pressing the
key or
key. If any display is left for 5
minutes or longer without operation, the back-light will go off.
LED
There are 8 LED displays. The signal labels and LED colours are defined as follows:
Label
Color
Remarks
IN SERVICE Green
Lit when the relay is in service.
Lit when a trip command is issued.
Lit when a failure is detected.
TRIP
Red
Red
Red
ALARM
TESTING
Lit when disabling automatic monitoring function or resetting the
time counting of THR and V/F elements by the scheme
switches.
(LED1)
(LED2)
(LED3)
(LED4)
Red
Red
Red
Red
Configurable LED to assign signals with or without latch when relay operates.
Configurable LED to assign signals with or without latch when relay operates.
Configurable LED to assign signals with or without latch when relay operates.
Configurable LED to assign signals with or without latch when relay operates.
LED1 to LED4 are configurable.
The TRIP LED lights up once the relay is operating and remains lit even after the trip command
RESET
goes off. The TRIP LED can be turned off by pressing the
key. Other LEDs are lit as
RESET
long as a signal is present and the
key is invalid while the signal is being maintained.
⎯ 79 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Operation keys
The operation keys are used to display records, status, and set values on the LCD, as well as to
input or change set values. The function of each key is as follows:
c 0-9, −:
Used to enter a selected number, numerical values and text strings.
Used to move between lines displayed on a screen
d
,
:
Keys 2, 4, 6 and 8 marked with
strings.
,
and
are also used to enter text
,
CANCEL
e
f
g
: Used to cancel entries and return to the upper screen.
Used to end entry operation, return to the upper screen or turn off the display.
Used to store or establish entries.
END
:
ENTER
:
VIEW and RESET keys
Pressing
key displays digest screens such as "Metering", "Latest fault" and "Auto-
VIEW
supervision".
RESET
Pressing
key turns off the display.
Monitoring jacks
The two monitoring jacks A and B and their respective LEDs can be used when the test mode is
selected on the LCD screen. By selecting the signal to be observed from the "Signal List" and
setting it on the screen, the signal can be displayed on LED A or LED B, or transmitted to an
oscilloscope via a monitoring jack.
RS232C connector
The RS232C connector is a 9-way D-type connector for serial RS232C connection with a local
personal computer.
⎯ 80 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.1.2 Communication Ports
The following 3 individual interfaces are mounted as the communication ports:
•
•
•
RS232C port
Serial communication port (RS485 port, optional Fibre optic or Ethernet LAN etc.)
IRIG-B port
(1) RS232C port
This connector is a standard 9-way D-type connector for serial port RS232C transmission and
mounted on the front panel. By connecting with a personal computer using this connector, setting
operation and display functions can be performed on the personal computer.
(2) Serial communication port
Two serial communication ports can be provided. In one port, it is connected to the RSM (Relay
Setting and Monitoring system) via the protocol converter G1PR2 or IEC60870-5-103
communication via BCU/RTU (Bay Control Unit / Remote Terminal Unit) to connect between
relays and to construct a network communication system. (See Figure 4.4.1 in Section 4.4.)
In another port, it is connected to the substation automation system via Ethernet communication
networks using IEC 61850 protocol.
Screw terminal for RS485, ST connector for fibre optic, or 100Base-TX (RJ-45 connector) or
100Base-FX (SC connector) for Ethernet LAN is provided on the back of the relay as shown in
Figure 4.1.1.
(3) IRIG-B port
The IRIG-B port is mounted on the transformer module. This port collects serial IRIG-B format
data from the external clock to synchronize the relay calendar clock. The IRIG-B port is isolated
from the external circuit by using a photocoupler. A BNC connector is used as the input connector.
This port is provided on the back of the relay and Figure 4.1.1 shows the location of this connector.
36-pin terminal block
20-pin terminal block
100Base-TX
(RJ45, option)
IRIG BNC
connector
Opt. I/F for IEC103
(ST, option)
RS485
connection
terminal
100Base-FX
(SC, option)
Figure 4.1.1 Locations of Communication Port
⎯ 81 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2 Operation of the User Interface
The user can access such functions as recording, measurement, relay setting and testing with the
LCD display and operation keys.
4.2.1 LCD and LED Displays
Displays during normal operation
When the GRT100 is operating normally, the green "IN SERVICE" LED is lit and the LCD is off.
Press the VIEW key when the LCD is off to display the digest screens which are "Metering",
"Latest fault" and "Auto-supervision" screens in turn. The last two screens are displayed only
when there is some data. The following are the digest screens and can be displayed without
entering the menu screens.
1
Mete ri n g
0 8/ Dec / 1997
22 : 56
Ia1 ** * . * kA
Ib1 ** * . * kA
Ic1 ** * . * kA
I a2 ** . **kA
I b2 ** . **kA
I c2 ** . **kA
I n1 ** . **kA
I n2 ** . **kA
2
Mete ri n g
0 8/ Dec / 1997
22 : 56
Ia3 ** * . * kA
Ib3 ** * . * kA
Ic3 ** * . * kA
I n3 ** . **kA
V
** * . *kV
**. *H z
Note: I 1 for primary(high-voltage) winding current
I 2 for secondary(medium-voltage) winding current
I 3 for tertiary(low-voltage) winding current
Ia , Ib , Ic for phase current
In for neutral current
RESET
Press the
key to turn off the LCD.
For any display, the back-light is automatically turned off after five minutes.
Displays in tripping
Late st fa ul t
08 /De c/ 199 7
Tr ip
22 :5 6: * *. * **
1-2 -3- 4 -5
Phas e
DIFT
BC
If a fault occurs and a tripping command is output when the LCD is off, the red "TRIP" LED and
other configurable LED if signals assigned to trigger by tripping.
Press the
Press the
key to scroll the LCD screen to read the rest of messages.
key to turn off the LEDs and LCD display.
VIEW
RESET
Notes:
1) When configurable LEDs (LED1 through LED4) are assigned to latch signals by trigger of
RESET
tripping, press the
key more than 3s until the LCD screens relight. Confirm turning off
the configurable LEDs. Refer to Table 4.2.1 Step 1.
RESET
2) Then, press the
key again on the "Latest fault" screen in short period, confirm turning
⎯ 82 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
off the "TRIP" LED. Refer to Table 4.2.1 Step 2.
RESET
3) When only the "TRIP" LED is go off by pressing the
key in short period, press the
RESET
key again to reset remained LEDs in the manner 1) on the "Latest fault" screen or other
digest screens. LED1 through LED4 will remain lit in case the assigned signals are still active
state.
Table 4.2.1 Turning off latch LED operation
LED lighting status
Operation
"TRIP" LED
Configurable LED
(LED1 - LED4)
Step 1
Step 2
RESET
Press the
key more than 3s on
the "Latest fault" screen
continue to lit
turn off
RESET
Then, press the
key in short
period on the "Latest fault" screen
turn off
RESET
When any of the menu screens is displayed, the VIEW and
To return from menu screen to the digest "Latest fault" screen, do the following:
END
keys do not function.
• Return to the top screen of the menu by repeatedly pressing the
key.
END
• Press the
key to turn off the LCD.
• Press the
key to display the digest "Latest fault" screen.
VIEW
Displays in automatic supervision operation
A u t o - s u p e r v i s i o n
0 8 / D e c / 1 9 9 7
2 2 : 5 6
D I O e r r
If the automatic supervision function detects a failure while the LCD is off, the
"Auto-supervision" screen is displayed automatically, showing the location of the failure and the
"ALARM" LED lights.
Press the VIEW key to display other digest screens in turn including the "Metering" and "Latest
fault" screens.
RESET
Press the
key to turn off the LEDs and LCD display. However, if the failure continues,
the "ALARM" LED remains lit.
After recovery from a failure, the "ALARM" LED and "Auto-supervision" display turn off
automatically.
If a failure is detected while any of the screens is displayed, the current screen remains displayed
and the "ALARM" LED lights.
Notes:
⎯ 83 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
1) When configurable LEDs (LED1 through LED4) are assigned to latch signals by issuing an
RESET
alarm, press the
2) When configurable LED is still lit by pressing
again to reset remained LED in the above manner.
3) LED1 through LED4 will remain lit in case the assigned signals are still active state.
key more than 3s until all LEDs reset except "IN SERVICE" LED.
RESET
RESET
key
key in short period, press
RESET
While any of the menu screens is displayed, the VIEW and
keys do not function. To
return to the digest "Auto-supervision" screen, do the following:
END
• Return to the top screen of the menu by repeatedly pressing the
key.
END
• Press the
• Press the
• Press the
key to turn off the LCD.
key to display the digest screen.
VIEW
RESET
key to turn off the LCD.
4.2.2 Relay Menu
Figure 4.2.1 shows the menu hierarchy in the GRT100. The main menu has five sub-menus,
"Record", "Status", "Setting (view)", "Setting (change)", and "Test". For details of the menu
hierarchy, see Appendix E.
⎯ 84 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Menu
Record
Status
Fault record
Event record
Disturbance record
Metering
Binary input & output
Relay element
Time synchronization source
Clock adjustment
Setting (view)
Relay version
Description
Communication
Record
Status
Protection
Binary input
Binary output
LED
Setting (change)
Password
Description
Communication
Record
Status
Protection
Binary input
Binary output
LED
Test
Switch
Binary output
Timer
Logic circuit
Figure 4.2.1 Relay Menu
⎯ 85 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Record
In the "Record" menu, the fault records, event records and disturbance records are displayed or
erased.
Status
The "Status" menu displays the power system quantities, binary input and output status, relay
measuring element status, signal source for time synchronization (IRIG-B, RSM or IEC) and
adjusts the clock.
Setting (view)
The "Setting (view)" menu displays the relay version, plant name and the current settings of relay
address and RS232C baud rate in communication, record, status, protection, configurable binary
inputs and outputs, and configurable LEDs.
Setting (change)
The "Setting (change)" menu is used to set or change the settings of password, plant name, relay
address and RS232C baud rate in communication, record, status, protection, configurable binary
inputs and outputs, and configurable LEDs.
Since this is an important menu and is used to set or change settings related to relay tripping, it has
password security protection.
Test
The "Test" menu is used to set testing switches, to forcibly operate binary output relays, to
measure variable timer time and to observe the binary signals in the logic circuit.
This menu also has password security protection.
RESET
keys to display the top
When the LCD is off, press any key other than the
and
VIEW
"MENU" screen and then proceed to the relay menus.
M EN U
1 = Re co r d
2 = Sta t us
4 = Set t in g( ch an g e)
3 = Se tt i ng (v ie w)
5 = Te st
RESET
To display the "MENU" screen when the digest screen is displayed, press the
RESET
key to turn
off the LCD, then press any key other than the
and
keys.
VIEW
END
Press the
key when the top screen is displayed to turn off the LCD.
An example of the sub-menu screen is shown below. The top line shows the hierarchical layer of
the screen, screen title and total number of lines of the screen. The last item is not displayed for all
the screens. "/6" displayed on the far left means that the screen is in the sixth hierarchical layer,
while 1/7 displayed on the far right means that the screen has seven lines excluding the top line and
that the cursor is on the first line.
To move the cursor downward or upward for setting or for viewing other lines not displayed on the
window, use the
and
keys.
⎯ 86 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/6 V T & CT ra t io
1 / 7
1 C T
2 C T
(
(
1- 2 0 O00 ):
1- 2 0 O00 ):
2 0 00
1 0 00
3 C T
(
1-
4 00
2 0 O00 ):
1 n CT
2 n CT
(
(
1- 2 0 O0 0 ) :
1- 2 0 O00 ):
1- 2 0 O00 ) :
1- 2 0 O00 ):
1 00
1 00
3 n CT (
V T
1 00
4 00
(
To move to the lower screen or move from the left-side screen to the right-side screen in Appendix
E, select the appropriate number on the screen. To return to the higher screen or move from the
END
right-side screen to the left-side screen, press the
key.
CANCEL
The
key can also be used to return to the higher screen but it must be used carefully
because it may cancel entries made so far.
To move between screens of the same hierarchical depth, first return to the higher screen and then
move to the lower screen.
4.2.3 Displaying Records
The sub-menu of "Record" is used to display fault records, event records and disturbance records.
4.2.3.1 Displaying Fault Records
To display fault records, do the following:
RESET
• Open the top "MENU" screen by pressing any keys other than the VIEW and
keys.
• Select 1 (= Record) to display the "Record" sub-menu.
r d
/ 1 R e c o
1 = F a u l t r e c o r d
2 = E v e n t r e c o r d
3 = D i s t u r b a n c e r e c o r d
• Select 1 (= Fault record) to display the "Fault record" screen.
R e c o r d
F
au l t
/ 2
2 = C l e a r
1 = Dis p l
a y
• Select 1 (= Display) to display the dates and times of fault records stored in the relay from the
top in new-to-old sequence.
/3 F au l t re co rd
1/ 4
#1
#2
#3
16 / Oc t/ 19 97 1 8: 1 3: 57. 0 31
20 / Se p/ 19 97 1 5: 29 : 22 .4 6 3
04 / Ju l/ 19 97 1 1: 5 4: 53. 9 77
• Move the cursor to the fault record line to be displayed using the
and
keys and press the
ENTER
key to display the details of the fault record.
⎯ 87 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/4 Fault Record #1
3/42
Date and Time
Fault phase
16/Oct/1997
Phase BC
DIFT
18:13:57.031
Trip
1-2-3-4-5
CB tripped
Tripping mode
Prefault values
Ia1 **.**kA
Ib1 **.**kA
Ic1 **.**kA
I11 **.**kA
I21 **.**kA
I01 **.**kA
In1 **.**kA
Ia3 **.**kA
Ib3 **.**kA
Ic3 **.**kA
I13 **.**kA
I23 **.**kA
***.*°
la2 **.**kA
lb2 **.**kA
lc2 **.**kA
l12 **.**kA
l22 **.**kA
l02 **.**kA
ln2 **.**kA
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
I03 **.**kA
In3 **.**kA
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
Power system
quantities
V
***.*kV
Ida ***.**pu
Idb ***.**pu
ld01 ***.**pu
ld02 ***.**pu
Idc ***.**pu
ld03 ***.**pu
Fault values
Ia1 **.**kA
Ib1 **.**kA
Ic1 **.**kA
I11 **.**kA
I21 **.**kA
I01 **.**kA
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
la2 **.**kA
lb2 **.**kA
lc2 **.**kA
l12 **.**kA
l22 **.**kA
l02 **.**kA
ln2 **.**kA
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
In1 **.**kA
Ia3 **.**kA
Ib3 **.**kA
Ic3 **.**kA
I13 **.**kA
I23 **.**kA
I03 **.**kA
In3 **.**kA
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
***.*°
V
***.*kV
Ida ***.**pu
Idb ***.**pu
Idc ***.**pu
THM ***.*%
ld01 ***.**pu
ld02 ***.**pu
ld03 ***.**pu
Note: I 1 for primary(high-voltage) winding current
I 2 for secondary(medium-voltage) winding current
I 3 for tertiary(low-voltage) winding current
In for neutral current
I1 , I2 , I0 for symmetrical component current
Ida, Idb, Idc for differential current
Ido1, Ido2, Ido3 for zero-phase differential current in 1REF, 2REF, 3REF
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the and
keys.
To clear all the fault records, do the following:
• Open the "Record" sub-menu.
• Select 1 (Fault record) to display the "Fault record" screen.
• Select 2 (= Clear) to display the following confirmation screen.
⎯ 88 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/ 2 F au lt re co rd
C lea r al l f au lt rec ord s?
ENT ER =Ye s
C AN CE L=N o
ENTER
• Press the
(= Yes) key to clear all the fault records stored in non-volatile memory.
If all fault records have been cleared, the "Latest fault" screen of the digest screens is not
displayed.
4.2.3.2 Displaying Event Records
To display events records, do the following:
RESET
keys.
• Open the top "MENU" screen by pressing any keys other than the
and
VIEW
• Select 1 (= Record) to display the "Record" sub-menu.
• Select 2 (= Event record) to display the "Event record" screen.
Rec o rd
E
ve n t
/ 2
2 = Clea r
1 = Dis p l
ay
• Select 1 (= Display) to display the events with date and time from the top in new-to-old
sequence.
/3 Eve nt re co rd
2/ 48
Off
16/Oct /1998 2 3:18 :04. 2 94
16/Oct /1998 2 3:18 :03.9 13
12/Feb /1998 0 3:51 :37. 6 22
Trip
On
Trip
Rly .
se
ch ange
t
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the and
keys.
To clear all the event records, do the following:
• Open the "Record" sub-menu.
• Select 2 (Event record) to display the "Event record" screen.
• Select 2 (= Clear) to display the following confirmation screen.
/2 E ve n t re co rd
Cl ea r a ll e ve nt r ec o rd s?
E NT ER =Y es
C ANC E L= No
ENTER
• Press the
(= Yes) key to clear all the event records stored in non-volatile memory.
4.2.3.3 Displaying Disturbance Records
Details of the disturbance records can be displayed on the PC screen only (*); the LCD displays
only the recorded date and time for all disturbances stored in the relay. To display them, do the
following:
(*) For the display on the PC screen, refer to RSM100 manual.
RESET
keys.
• Open the top "MENU" screen by pressing any keys other than the
and
VIEW
⎯ 89 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• Select 1 (= Record) to display the "Record" sub-menu.
• Select 3 (= Disturbance record) to display the "Disturbance record" screen.
reco rd
D
is t u rba n c e
/ 2
2 = Clea r
1 = Dis p l
ay
• Select 1 (= Display) to display the date and time of the disturbance records from the top in
new-to-old sequence.
/3 D is t ur ba nc e re co r d
3/12
#1
#2
#3
16 / Oc t/ 19 97 1 8: 1 3: 57. 0 31
20 / Se p/ 19 97 1 5: 29 : 22 .4 6 3
04 / Ju l/ 19 97 1 1: 5 4: 53. 9 77
The lines which are not displayed in the window can be displayed by pressing the
and keys.
To clear all the disturbance records, do the following:
• Open the "Record" sub-menu.
• Select 3 (Disturbance record) to display the "Disturbance record" screen.
• Select 2 (= Clear) to display the following confirmation screen.
/2 D is t ur ba nc e re co r d
Cl ea r a ll d is tu rb an c e rec o rd s?
E NT ER =Y es
C ANC E L= No
ENTER
• Press the
(= Yes) key to clear all the disturbance records stored in non-volatile
memory.
4.2.4 Displaying the Status
From the sub-menu of "Status", the following statuses can be displayed on the LCD:
Metering data of the protected transformer
Status of binary inputs and outputs
Status of measuring elements output
Status of time synchronization source
The data are renewed every second.
This sub-menu is also used to adjust the time of the internal clock.
4.2.4.1 Displaying Metering Data
To display metering data on the LCD, do the following.
• Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
⎯ 90 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/1 S ta t us
1= Me te r in g
2= Bin a ry I /O
3= Re la y e le me nt
4= Tim e s yn c so u rce
5 = Cl oc k
a dj us tm e
nt
• Select 1 (= Metering) to display the "Metering" screen.
/ 2 M e t e r i n g
1 6 / O c t / 1 9 9 7
1 8 : 1 3 3 / 2 0
I a 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I a 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I b 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I b 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I c 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I c 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 1 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 1 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 2 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 2 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 0 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 0 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I n 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I n 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I a 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I b 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I c 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 1 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 2 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 0 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I n 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
V
∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ k V ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I d a ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d b ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 1 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 2 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 3 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d c ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
T H M ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ %
Frequency
∗ ∗ . ∗ H z
Note: I 1 for primary(high-voltage) winding current
I 2 for secondary(medium-voltage) winding current
I 3 for tertiary(low-voltage) winding current
Ia , Ib , Ic for phase current
In for neutral current
I1 , I2 , I0 for symmetrical component current
Ida, Idb, Idc for differential current
Ido1, Ido2, Ido3 for zero-phase differential current in 1REF, 2REF, 3REF
Metering data is expressed as primary values or secondary values depending on the setting. For
setting, see Section 4.2.6.6.
⎯ 91 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2.4.2 Displaying the Status of Binary Inputs and Outputs
To display the binary input and output status, do the following:
• Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
• Select 2 (= Binary I/O) to display the binary input and output status. (Binary inputs and outputs
depend oh the relay model.)
/2 B in a ry i np ut & o u tp ut
3/ 5
In pu t ( IO #1)
[0 0 0 0 00 00 0 000
]
]
]
In pu t ( IO #2 )
[0 0 0
)
Ou tp ut ( IO# 1 -t ri p
[0 00 00
Ou tp ut ( IO# 2 )
Ou tp ut ( IO# 3 )
[0 00 00 0 0 00 000 00 ]
[0 00 00 0 0 00 0
]
The display format is shown below.
[„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
—
—
—
„
—
—
—
„]
—
—
—
—
—
Input (IO#1)
Input (IO#2)
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
—
BI5
—
BI6 BI7 BI8 BI9 BI10 BI11 BI12
BI14 BI15 BI16
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Output (IO#1-trip) TP-1 TP-2 TP-3 TP-4 TP-5
Output (IO#2)
Output (IO#3)
BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10 BO11 BO12 FAIL BO13
BO1 BO2 BO3 BO4 BO5 BO6 BO7 BO8 BO9 BO10
—
—
—
—
Lines 1 and 2 show the binary input status. BI1 to BI16 corresponds to each binary input signal.
For details of the binary input signals, see Appendix G. The status is expressed with logical level
"1" or "0" at the photo-coupler output circuit. IO#1 and IO#2 in the table indicates the name of the
module containing the binary input circuits.
Lines 3 to 5 show the binary output status. TP-1 to TP-5 of line 3 corresponding to the tripping
command outputs. Models 203 and 204 are not provided with TP-4 and TP-5. FAIL of line 4
corresponds to the relay failure output. Other outputs expressed with BO1 to BO13 are
configurable. The status of these outputs is expressed with logical level "1" or "0" at the input
circuit of the output relay driver. That is, the output relay is energized when the status is "1".
IO#1 to IO#3 in the table indicate the names of the module containing the binary output relays.
To display all the lines, press the
and
keys.
⎯ 92 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2.4.3 Displaying the Status of Measuring Elements
To display the status of the measuring elements on the LCD, do the following:
• Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
• Select 3 (= Relay element) to display the status of the relay elements.
/ 2 Re lay e le men t
3 / 9
D I F T
R E F
O C
[00 0 0 00 0 00 000
[00 0
]
]
]
]
]
]
[00 0 0 00 0 00
[00 0 0 00 0 00
[00 0
O CI
E F
E FI
[00 0
T HR
V /F
[00
]
]
[00 0
F RQ
[000 0
]
The display format is as shown below.
[„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„
„]
A
B
DIF
C
A
B
2f
C
A
B
5f
C
A
B
HOC
C
—
—
—
DIFT
REF
OC
1
2
3
—
—
—
—
A
—
—
C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
A
B
C
A
A
B
C
C
B
—
—
—
—
1OC
2OC
3OC
A
B
1OCI
C
B
2OCI
A
B
3OCI
C
OCI
EF
1
1
2
3
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EFI
—
—
2
THR
V/F
S
H
A
T
—
A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FRQ
L1
L2
H1
H2
Line 1 shows the operation status of current differential elements. Line 2 shows the status of
restricted earth fault elements. Line 3 shows the status of overcurrent elements. Line 4 shows the
status of time overcurrent elements. Line 5 shows the status of the overcurrent element for earth
fault. Line 6 shows the status of time overcurrent elements for earth fault. Lines 7, 8 and 9 show
the status of thermal overload element, overexcitation element and frequency element
respectively.
The status of each element is expressed with logical level "1" or "0". Status "1" means the element
is in operation.
To display all the lines on the LCD, press the
and
keys.
⎯ 93 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2.4.4 Displaying the Status of the Time Synchronization Source
The inner clock of the GRT100 can be synchronized with external clocks such as the IRIG-B time
standard signal clock or RSM (relay setting and monitoring system) clock or by an
IEC60870-5-103 or SNTP server. To display on the LCD whether these clocks are active or
inactive and which clock the relay is synchronized with, do the following:
• Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
• Select 4 (= Time sync source) to display the status of time synchronization sources.
/2 T im e s yn ch ro ni za t io n so u r ce
I R I G : I n a c t i ve
4 / 4
R S M :
I E C :
I n a c ti ve
I n a c ti ve
*S NT P: Ac ti v e (S e r ve r ∗ )
The asterisk on the far left shows that the internal clock is synchronized with the marked source
clock. If the marked source clock is inactive, the internal clock runs locally.
For details of the setting time synchronization, see Section 4.2.6.6.
4.2.4.5 Adjusting the Time
To adjust the clock when the internal clock is running locally, do the following:
• Select 2 (= Status) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Status" screen.
• Select 5 (= Clock adjustment) to display the setting screen.
/2
1 2 /F eb /1 99 8 22 : 56 :19
[ lo ca l]
1/ 5
Mi nu te (
0-
0-
1-
59 ) :
23 ) :
31 ) :
4 1
2 2
1 2
Ho ur
Da y
(
(
Mo nt h (
Ye ar
1 -
12 ) :
2
( 199 0 - 20 89 ) :
1 99 8
Line 1 shows the current date, time and time synchronization source with which the internal clock
is synchronized. The time can be adjusted only when [Local] is indicated on the top line, showing
that the clock is running locally. When [IRIG] or [RSM] or [IEC] or [SNTP] is indicated, the
following adjustment is invalid.
ENTER
• Enter a numerical value within the specified range for each item and press the
key.
END
• Press the
key to adjust the internal clock to the set hours without fractions and return to
the previous screen.
END
If a date which does not exist in the calendar is set and
is pressed, "Error: Incorrect date" is
displayed on the top line and the adjustment is discarded. Adjust again.
⎯ 94 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2.5 Viewing the Settings
The sub-menu "Setting (view)" is used to view the settings made using the sub-menu "Setting
(change)" except for the relay version.
The following items are displayed:
Relay version
Description
Address in the RSM, IEC60870-5-103 or IEC61850 communication
Recording setting
Status setting
Protection setting
Binary input setting
Binary output setting
LED setting
Enter a number on the LCD to display each item as described in the previous sections.
4.2.5.1 Relay Version
To view the relay version, do the following.
• Press 3 (= Setting (view)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (view)" screen.
)
/1 S et t in g ( vi e w
1 = Ve r si on
4 = Re c or d
2 = Des c r ipt ion
5 = Sta t u s
3 = C om m.
6 = Pro t e cti on
9= LE D
7 = Bi n ar y i npu t
8 = Bin a r y o ut p u t
• Press 1 (= Version) on the "Setting (view)" screen and the "Relay version" screen appears.
3/ 8
* *** * * **** ****** ** ****
* *** * * **** ****** ** ****
* *** * * **** ****** ** ****
/2 R el a y vers ion
R el a y t ype
:
N o. :
S e r i a l
M a i n s o f t w a r e :
I E C 6 1 8 5 0 en g. :
* *** * * **** ****** ** ****
* *** * * **** **(*** ** ***)
* *** * * **** **(*** ***** )
* *** * * **** **(*** ***** )
d at a :
PLC
I EC10 3 d at a :
IEC61 85 0 da ta:
G OOSE s ub s c ript: * *** * * **** **(*** ***** )
4.2.5.2 Settings
The "Description", "Comm.", "Record", "Status", "Protection", "Binary input", "Binary output"
and "LED" screens display the current settings input using the "Setting (change)" sub-menu.
4.2.6 Changing the Settings
The "Setting (change)" sub-menu is used to make or change settings for the following items:
Password
Description
Address in the RSM, IEC60870-5-103 or IEC61850 communication
⎯ 95 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Recording
Status
Protection
Binary input
Binary output
LED
All of the above settings except the password can be seen using the "Setting (view)" sub-menu.
4.2.6.1 Setting Method
There are three setting methods as follows.
- To enter a selective number
- To enter numerical values
- To enter a text string
To enter a selected number
If a screen as shown below is displayed, perform setting as follows.
The number to the left of the cursor shows the current setting or default setting set at shipment. The
cursor can be moved to upper or lower lines within the screen by pressing the
and
keys. If
setting (change) is not required, skip the line with the
and
keys.
/6 S c h e m e swi t ch
1 / ***
PM D
O R
0
DI FT
1R EF
1=3P
1=1I
2 =1P
2= 2I 0
1
1
3=3 I0
3=3I 0
3=3I 0
0
2R EF
3R EF
1=1I
2= 2I 0
1
1=1I 0
0=Of
2= 2I 0
1= On
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
:
1
1
1
:
1
1
RE F_D EF
M1 OCI
M2 OCI
M3 OCI
M1 EFI
M2 EFI
M3 EFI
L/ O
f
1=Lo n g 2 =Std 3=Ver y 4 =E xt
1=Lo g 2=Std 3=Ver y 4 =E xt
n
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3=Ver
=
n
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
=
=
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
0=Of
0=Of
0=Of
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
f
f
f
2F -LO CK
5F -LO CK
DI F1
0=Of f
0=Of
DI F2
DI F3
f
0=Of f
:
M. T4- 1
M. T4- 2
M. T4- 3
:
SV CNT
CT SEN
0=Of
0=Of
0=Of
1= On
1= On
1= On
f
f
f
0=AL &BL K 1= ALM
M
0=Of
1= On
f
• Move the cursor to a setting line.
• Enter the selected number. (Numbers other than those displayed cannot be entered.)
ENTER
• Press the
key to confirm the entry and the cursor will move to the next line below.
(On the lowest line, the entered number blinks.)
END
• After completing the setting on the screen, press the
key to return to the upper menu.
⎯ 96 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
To correct the entered number, do the following.
CANCEL
ENTER
• If it is before pressing the
key, press the
key and enter the new number.
ENTER
• If it is after pressing the
key, move the cursor to the correct line by pressing the
and
keys and enter the new number.
Note: If the
key is pressed after any entry is confirmed by pressing the
key, all
ENTER
CANCEL
the entries performed so far on the screen concerned are canceled and screen returns to the
upper one.
When the screen shown below is displayed, perform setting as follows.
The number to the right of "Current No.=" shows the current setting.
/3 C ha n ge a ct i ve gro u p ( A ct i ve gro u p
= * )
1 =G r ou p 1
5= G rou p 5
2= G r ou p 2
6= G r ou p 6
3= G r ou p 3
7= G r ou p 7
4= G r ou p 4
8= G r ou p 8
Cu rr e nt N o. = *
S elec t No . =
• Enter a number to the right of "Select No. = ". (Numbers other than those displayed cannot be
entered.)
ENTER
• Press the
key to confirm the entry and the entered number blinks.
END
• After completing the setting on the screen, press the
key to return to the upper screen.
To correct the entered number, do the following.
CANCEL
key and enter the new number.
ENTER
• If it is before pressing the
key, press the
ENTER
• If it is after pressing the
key, enter the new number.
To enter numerical values
When the screen shown below is displayed, perform setting as follows:
The number to the left of the cursor shows the current setting or default setting set at shipment. The
cursor can be moved to upper or lower lines within the screen by pressing the
and
keys. If
setting (change) is not required, skip the line with the
and
keys.
/6 V T &
1 /7
C T
r ati o
1C T
2C T
3C T
(
(
(
1 - 2 0 00 0 ):
1 - 2 0 00 0 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
2 000
1 000
400
1n CT (
2n CT (
3n CT (
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
100
100
100
400
VT
(
• Move the cursor to a setting line.
• Enter the numerical value.
ENTER
• Press the
key to confirm the entry and the cursor will move to the next line below. (If
a numerical value outside the displayed range is entered, "Error: Out of range" appears on the
CANCEL
top line and the cursor remains on the line. Press the
key to clear the entry.)
END
• After completing the setting on the screen, press the
key to return to the upper screen.
⎯ 97 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
To correct the entered numerical value, do the following.
CANCEL
ENTER
• If it is before pressing the
key, press the
key and enter the new
numerical value.
ENTER
• If it is after pressing the
and keys and enter the new numerical value.
Note: If the key is pressed after any entry is confirmed by pressing the
key, move the cursor to the correct line by pressing the
key, all
ENTER
CANCEL
the entries made so far on the screen concerned are canceled and the screen returns to the upper
one.
To enter a text string
Text strings are entered in the bracket under the "Plant name" or "Description" screen.
To select a character, use keys 2, 4, 6 and 8 to move the blinking cursor down, left, right and up.
"→" and "←" on each of lines 2 to 4 indicate a space and backspace, respectively. A maximum of
22 characters can be entered within the brackets.
/3 P la n t na me
[
_
]
←→
←→
←→
AB CD EF G HI JK LM NO PQ RS T UV WXY Z ( )[ ]@ _
ab cd ef g hi jk lm no pq rs t uv wxyz { }* /+ -< = >
01 23 45 6 78 9 !”#$ %& ’:;,.^`
ENTER
• Set the cursor position in the bracket by selecting "→" or "←" and pressing the
key.
• Move the blinking cursor to select a character.
ENTER
• Press the
to enter the blinking character at the cursor position in the brackets.
END
• Press the
key to confirm the entry and return to the upper screen.
To correct the entered character, do either of the following.
ENTER
• Discard the character by selecting "←" and pressing the
key and enter the new
character.
CANCEL
• Discard the whole entry by pressing the
key and restart the entry from the first.
To complete the setting
ENTER
Enter after making entries on each setting screen by pressing the
key, the new settings
are not yet used for operation, though stored in the memory. To validate the new settings, take the
following steps.
END
• Press the
key to the upper screen. Repeat this until the confirmation screen shown
below is displayed. The confirmation screen is displayed just before returning to the "Setting
(change)" sub-menu.
/2 * ** * ** ** ** ** **
Ch an ge se tt in gs ?
E NT ER =Y es
C ANC E L= No
ENTER
• When the screen is displayed, press the
key to start operation using the new settings,
CANCEL
or press the
key to correct or cancel entries. In the latter case, the screen turns back
CANCEL
to the setting screen to enable re-entries. Press the
key to cancel entries made so far
⎯ 98 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
and to turn to the "Setting (change)" sub-menu.
4.2.6.2 Password
For the sake of security of changing the settings and testing the relay, password protection can be
set as follows;
• Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
/1 S et t in g ( ch a ng e )
1 = Pa s sw or d 2 = Des c r ipt ion
4 = Re c or d 5 = Sta t u s
7 = Bi n ar y i npu t
3 = RS M c omm
6 = Pro t e cti on
9= LE D
8 = Bin a r y o ut p u t
• Press 1 (= Password) to display the "Password" screen.
/2 P as s wo rd
I n pu t ne w pa ss w or d
Re t yp e ne w pa ss w or d
[
[
]
]
ENTER
• Enter a 4-digit number within the brackets after "Input new password" and press the
key.
• For confirmation, enter the same 4-digit number in the brackets after "Retype new password"
ENTER
and press the
key.
• Press the
key to display the confirmation screen. If the retyped number is different from
END
that first entered, the following message is displayed on the bottom of the "Password" screen
before returning to the upper screen.
"Mismatch-password unchanged."
Re-entry is then requested.
• Press 2 (= Test) on the "Password" screen to set the password for the test.
/ 2 T e s t
I np ut n e w p a s sw or d
R e ty pe n e w p a ss w or d
[
[
]
]
Set the password the same manner as that of the "Setting" above.
Password trap
After the password has been set, the password must be entered in order to enter the setting change
and the test screens.
If 4 (= Setting (change)) is entered on the top "MENU" screen, the password trap screen
"Password" is displayed. If the password is not entered correctly, it is not possible to move to the
"Setting (change)" sub-menu screens.
P as sw o rd
In pu t pa ss w or d
[
]
⎯ 99 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Canceling or changing the password
To cancel the password protection, enter "0000" in the two brackets on the "Password" screen. The
"Setting (change)" screen is then displayed without having to enter a password.
The password can be changed by entering a new 4-digit number on the "Password" screen in the
same way as the first password setting.
If you forget the password
CANCEL
RESET
together for one second on the top "MENU" screen. The screen
Press
and
disappears, and the password protection of the GRT100 is canceled. Set the password again.
4.2.6.3 Description
To enter the plant name and other data, do the following. These data are attached to records.
• Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
• Press 2 (= Description) to display the "Description" screen.
/2 D es c ri pt ion
a
=D e
s c r i pt
i
m
on
1 =P l an t n
e
2
• To enter the plant name, select 1 (= Plant name) on the "Description" screen.
/3 P la n t na me
[
_
]
←→
AB CD EF G HI JK LM NO PQ RS T UV WXY Z ( )[ ]@
←→
←→
ab cd ef g hi jk lm no pq rs t uv wxyz { }* /+ -< = >
”
01 23 45 6 78 9 ! #$ %& :;,.^`
’
To enter special items, select 2 (= Description) on the "Description" screen.
i
/3 D es c r pt io n [
_
]
←→
AB CD EF G HI JK LM NO PQ RS T UV WXY Z ( )[ ]@
←→
←→
ab cd ef g hi jk lm no pq rs t uv wxyz { }* /+ -< = >
”
’
01 23 45 6 78 9 ! #$ %& :;,.^`
• Enter the text string.
4.2.6.4 Communication
If the relay is linked with RSM (relay setting and monitoring system), IEC60870-5-103 or
Ethernet LAN, the relay address must be set. Do this as follows:
• Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
• Press 3 (= Comm.) to display the "Communication" screen.
/2 Co mm unica t i on
1 =A d dre ss
2 =S w itc h
e r
/P ar amet
• Press 1 (= Address/Parameter) to enter the relay address number.
⎯ 100 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/ 3 Add re ss/P a r a m e te r
1 / **
_
H DL C (
I EC
1 -
32 ) :
2 54 ) :
1
2
0
-
0
(
- 99 99 -
99 9 9 ) :
ms
S Y A D J (
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
:
-
-
-
-
-
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
I P1 -1 (
I P1 -2 (
I P1 -3 (
I P1 -4 (
S M1 -1 (
S M1 -2 (
S M1 -3 (
S M1 -4 (
G W1 -1 (
G W1 -2 (
G W1 -3 (
G W1 -4 (
S I1 -1 (
S I1 -2 (
S I1 -3 (
S I1 -4 (
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
For channel 1(port 1)
0
0
0
0
For SNTP server 1
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
1 ) :
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
S I4 -1 (
S I4 - 2(
S I4 -3 (
S I4 -4 (
S MO DE (
G OI NT(
P G1 -1 (
P G1 - 2(
P G1 -3 (
P G1 - 4(
0
0
0
0
0
For SNTP server 4
1 -
6 0 ) :
6
s
-
0
-
0
-
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
2 54 ) :
For channel 1(port 1)
0
0
-
•
Enter the address number on "HDLC" column for RSM and/or "IEC" column for
IEC60870-5-103 and the compensation value on "SYADJ" column for adjustment of time
synchronization of protocol used (−: lags the time, +: leads the time).
Enter IP address for IP1-1 to IP1-4, Subnet mask for SM1-1 to SM1-4, Default gateway for
GW1-1 to GW1-4, and SNTP server address for SI1-1 to SI4-4. Four SNTP servers are
available.
Enter "0" or "1" on "SMODE" column to set the standard time synchronized mode for SNTP
server. Using low accuracy level of time server, synchronized compensation to maintain
synchronization accuracy may not be done automatically. Therefore enter "1", and
synchronized compensation is done forcibly. The default setting is "0".
Enter the time on "GOINT" to set the maximum GOOSE message publishing term if GOOSE
message receive checked.
Enter the IP address of the device for PG1-1 to PG1-4 if Ping response checked.
IP address: ∗∗∗, ∗∗∗, ∗∗∗, ∗∗∗
IP1-1 IP1-2 IP1-3 IP1-4
SM1-1 to SM1-4, GW1-1 to GW1-4, SI1-1 to SI4-4, PG1-1 to PG1-4: same as above.
ENTER
• Press the
key.
CAUTION: Do not overlap the number in a network.
•
Press 2 (= Switch) on the "Communication" screen to select the protocol, transmission speed
⎯ 101 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(baud rate) and test mode setting, etc., of the RSM or IEC60870-5-103 or IEC61850.
/3 Swi t ch
1/ *
L1
L C
6
1
P R T C
23 2C
1 = H D
1=9.
2 =IEC 03
2
2= 19. 2 3=38. 4 4 =57. 6 4
6
IE CBR
1=9.
2= 19. 2
2
IE CBL K
85 0BL K
85 0AU T
TS TMO D
GS ECH K
PI NGC HK
1=No mal 2=B locked
1=No mal 2=B locked
r
0=Of f 1= On
1
1
1
0
0
0
r
0=Of
0=Of
0=Of
1 = On
1= On
1= On
f
f
f
ENTER
• Select the number corresponding to the system and press the
key.
<PRTCL1>
PRTCL1 is used to select the protocol for channel 1 (COM1 or OP1) of the serial communication
port RS485 or FO (fibre optic).
•
When the remote RSM system applied, select 1 (=HDLC). When the IEC60870-5-103
applied, select 2 (=IEC103).
<232C>
This line is to select the RS-232C baud rate when the RSM system applied.
Note: The default setting of the 232C is 9.6kbps. The 57.6kbps setting, if possible, is recommended to
serve user for comfortable operation. The setting of RSM100 is also set to the same baud rate.
<IECBR>
This line is to select the baud rate when the IEC60870-5-103 system applied.
<IECBLK>
Select 2 (=Blocked) to block the monitor direction in the IEC60870-5-103 communication.
<850BLK>
Select 2 (=Blocked) to block the monitor direction in the IEC61850 communication.
<850AUT>
In the IEC61850 communication, GRT100 provides the access restriction which permits a client
to access only if an authentication parameter matches with a valid parameter (password).
Password is 4-digit number and shared with RSM100.
Select 1 (=On) to use the authentication function.
<TSTMOD>
Select 1 (=On) to set the test mode in the IEC61850 communication.
<GSECHK>
This function is to alarm if any one of GOOSE messages written in GOOSE subscribe file cannot
be received.
Select 1 (=On) to execute GOOSE receive check in the IEC61850 communication.
⎯ 102 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
<PINGCHK>
This function is to check the health of network by regularly sending Ping to IP address which is set
on PG∗-∗.
Select 1 (=On) to execute Ping response check.
4.2.6.5 Setting the Recording
To set the recording function as described in Section 4.2.3, do the following:
• Press 4 (= Setting (change)) on the main "MENU" screen to display the "Setting (change)"
screen.
• Press 4 (= Record) to display the "Record" screen.
Rec o rd
/ 2
1 = Fau l t r e c o r d
2 =E ven t re cord
3 = D i s t u r b a n c e re cor d
Setting the fault recording
• Press 1 (= Fault record) to display the "Fault record" screen.
/ 3 F
t
r ec or d
1 = O
1 / 1
1 _
au l
P
a t in g 2 = F au lt
ha s e m o de
pe r
ENTER
• Enter 1 or 2 and press the
key.
Enter 1 (= Operating) to display the operating phase.
Enter 2 (= Fault) to display the fault phase.
Setting the event recording
• Press 2 (= Event record) to display the "Event record" screen.
/ 3 E v e n t r e c o r d
1 / 1 2 9
B I T R N (
0 -
0 -
0 -
1 2 8 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
1 2 8 _
E V 1
E V 2
(
(
0
1
E V 3
E V 4
E V 5
E V 6
E V 7
E V 8
E V 9
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
1
1
3 0 7 1
3 0 7 1
3 0 7 1
3 0 7 1
3 0 7 1
3 0 7 1
E V 1 0 (
:
:
:
E V 1 2 8 (
0 -
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1
⎯ 103 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
<BITRN>
•
Enter the number of event to record the status change both to "On" and "Off". If enter 20, both
status change is recorded for EV1 to EV20 events and only the status change to "On" is
recorded for EV21 to EV128 events.
<EV∗>
Enter the signal number to record as the event in Appendix B. It is recommended that this
•
setting can be performed by RSM100 because the signal name cannot be entered by LCD
screen. (Refer to Section 3.4.2.)
Setting the disturbance recording
• Press 3 (= Disturbance record) to display the "Disturbance record" screen.
a ce
/3 D i s t u r b n
re co rd
1= Re cor d
t i me & sta r te r
2 = Sc he me s wi tc h
3 =Bi nar y s igna l
• Press 1 (= Record time & starter) to display the "Record time & starter" screen.
/ 4 R e c o r d t i m e & s t a r t e r
1 / 5
T i m e (
0 . 1 -
3 . 0 ) :
2 0 . 0 0 ) :
2 0 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 _
1 . 0 0
s
1 O C P S ( 0 . 1 0 -
2 O C P S ( 0 . 1 0 -
p u
p u
1 . 0 0
1 O C P G ( 0 . 0 5 -
2 O C P G ( 0 . 1 0 -
2 0 . 0 0 ) :
2 0 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0
1 . 0 0
p u
p u
• Enter the recording time and starter element settings.
To set starters, do the following:
• Press 2 (= Scheme switch) on the "Disturbance record" screen to display the "Scheme switch"
screen.
/4 Scheme swit ch
TRI P1 0=Off 1=On
1/ 14
1
1
1
2
TRI P
0=Off 1=On
0=Off 1=On
TRI P3
:
:
:
1
1
EVE N T 3 0=Off 1=On
• Enter 1 to use as a starter or enter 0 if not to use.
•
Press 3 (= Binary signal) on the "Disturbance record" screen to display the "Binary signal"
screen.
/ 4 B i n a r y s i g n a l
1 / 3 2
S I G 1 (
S I G 2 (
S I G 3 (
S I G 4 (
0 -
0 -
0 -
0 -
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
3 0 7 1 ) :
1 _
2
3
4
S I G 3 2 (
0 -
3 0 7 1 ) :
0
• Enter the signal number to record binary signals in Appendix B. It is recommended that this
⎯ 104 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
setting can be performed by RSM100 because the signal name cannot be entered by LCD
screen. (Refer to Section 3.4.3.)
4.2.6.6 Status
To set the status display described in Section 4.2.4, do the following.
Press 5 (= Status) on the "Setting (change)" sub-menu to display the "Status" screen.
/ 2 S t a t u s
1 = M e t e r i n g
2 = T i m e s y n c h r o n i z a t i o n
3 = T i m e z o n e
Setting the metering
• Press 1 (= Metering) to display the "Metering" screen.
/3 Met e ri ng
1/ 1
Di spla y v alue 1 =P rima ry 2=S e co ndary 1 _
ENTER
• Enter the selected number and press the
key. Repeat this for all items.
Setting the time synchronization
The calendar clock can run locally or be synchronized with external IRIG-B time standard signal,
RSM clock, IEC60870-5-103(IEC) or SNTP. This is selected by setting as follows:
• Press 2 (= Time synchronization) to display the "Time synchronization" screen.
/ 3 T i m e s y n c h r o n i z a t i o n
0 = O f f 1 = I R I G 2 = R S M 3 = I E C 4 = S N T P
C u r r e n t N o . = 0
S e l e c t N o . = _
ENTER
• Enter the selected number and press the
key.
Note: When to select IRIG-B, RSM, IEC, or SNTP, check that they are active on the "Time
synchronization source" screen in "Status" sub-menu. If it is set to an inactive IRIG-B, RSM,
IEC, or SNTP, the calendar clock runs locally.
Setting the time zone
When the calendar clock is synchronized with the IRIG-B time standard, it is possible to transform
GMT to the local time.
• Press 3 (= Time zone) to display the "Time zone" screen.
/ 3 T i m e z o n e
1 / 2
h r s
m i n
G M T
(
- 1 2 -
- 5 9 -
+ 1 2 ) :
+ 5 9 ) :
+ 9 _
+ 0
G M T m (
•
Enter the difference between GMT and local time. Enter a numerical value to GMT (hrs) and
ENTER
GMTm (min), and press the
key.
⎯ 105 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.2.6.7 Protection
The GRT100 can have 8 setting groups for protection according to the change of power system
operation, one of which is assigned to be active. To set protection, do the following:
• Press 6 (= Protection) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "Protection" screen.
/2 P ro t ec ti on
1 = Ch an g e ac ti ve g ro u p
2 = Ch an g e se tt in g
3 = Co py gr ou p
Changing the active group
• Press 1 (= Change active group) to display the "Change active group" screen.
/3 C ha n ge a ct iv e gr o up (Ac t iv e gr ou p = * )
1 = Gr ou p1
5 = Gr ou p5
2 =G ro up2
6 =G ro up6
3 = Gro u p3
7 = Gro u p7
4 = Gr o up4
8 = Gr o up8
Cu rr e nt N o. = *
S el ec t No . =
ENTER
• Enter the selected number and press the
key.
Changing the settings
Almost all the setting items have default values that are set when the product GRT100 was
shipped. For the default values, see Appendix D and H. To change the settings, do the following:
• Press 2 (= Change setting) to display the "Change setting" screen.
/3 C ha n ge s et ti ng
(Ac t iv e gr ou p = * )
1 = Gr ou p1
5 = Gr ou p5
2 =G ro up2
6 =G ro up6
3 = Gro u p3
7 = Gro u p7
4 = Gr o up4
8 = Gr o up8
• Press the group number to change the settings and display the "Protection" screen.
/4 Pro te ct ion
(G roup *)
sfor mer
1= Tran
2 = Trip
para mete r
Settings are required for transformer parameter and protection functions.
Setting the transformer parameters
Enter the VT&CT ratio as follows:
• Press 1 (= Transformer parameter) on the "Protection" screen to display the "Transformer
parameter" screen.
/5 T ra n sfor m er par am eter
1= VT & CT r at io
(G ro u p * )
• Press 1 (VT&CT ratio) to display the "VT&CT ratio" screen.
⎯ 106 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/6 V T &
1 /7
C T
r ati o
1C T
2C T
3C T
(
(
(
1 - 2 0 00 0 ):
1 - 2 0 00 0 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
2 000
1 000
400
1n CT (
2n CT (
3n CT (
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
1 - 2 0 000 ):
100
100
100
400
VT
(
ENTER
ENTER
• Enter the VT ratio and press the
• Enter the CT ratio and press the
CAUTION
key.
key.
Do not set the CT primary rated current. Set the CT ratio.
(CT ratio) = (CT primary rated current [A]) / (Relay rated current [A])
END
• Press the
key to return the display to the "Transformer parameter" screen.
Setting the protection function
To set the protection schemes, scheme switches and protection elements, do the following.
Protection elements are measuring elements and timers.
Note: Depending on the selected protection scheme and scheme switch setting, some of the scheme
switches and protection elements are not used and so need not be set. The protection function
setting menu of the GRT100 does not display unnecessary setting items. Therefore, start by
setting the protection scheme, then set the scheme switch, then the protection elements.
As a result of the above, note that some of the setting items described below may not appear in
the actual setting.
• Press 2 (= Trip) on the "Protection" screen to display the "Trip" screen.
/5 Tri p
(G roup *)
Ph as e m atch in g
1 =
2 =
3 =
Sc he m e sw itch
Prot e ct ion el emen t
Setting the phase matching
• Press 1 (= Phase matching) to display the "Phase matching" screen.
• Select 1 (= Alpha) or 2 (= Beta) to set the phase matching method.
/6 P h a s e m a t c h i n g
1 = Al pha
2 =B eta
Cu rr e nt N o. = 2
S el ec t No. =
Note: If the "Alpha" is selected, the phase matching method corresponds to that of GRT100-xxxC
model. If the "Beta", it corresponds to that of GRT100-xxxA and -xxxB models.
END
• Press the
key to return the display to the "Trip" screen.
Setting the scheme switch
• Press 2 (= Scheme switch) to display the "Scheme switch" screen.
⎯ 107 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/6 Sch e me swi t ch
1/ ***
PM D
O R
0
DI FT
1R EF
2R EF
1=3P
1=1I
1=1I
2 =1P
2= 2I 0
1
1
1
3=3 I0
3=3I 0
3=3I 0
0
2= 2I 0
3R EF
1=1I 0
0=Of
2= 2I 0
1= On
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
:
1
1
1
:
1
1
RE F_D EF
M1 OCI
M2 OCI
M3 OCI
M1 EFI
M2 EFI
M3 EFI
L/ O
f
1=Lo n g 2 =Std 3=Ver y 4 =E xt
1=Lo g 2=Std 3=Ver y 4 =E xt
n
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
y 4 =E xt
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3=Ver
n
=
=
=
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
1=Lo g 2 =Std 3 Ver
n
0=Of
0=Of
0=Of
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
1= On
f
f
f
2F -LO CK
5F -LO CK
DI F1
0=Of f
0=Of
DI F2
DI F3
f
0=Of f
:
M. T4- 1
M. T4- 2
M. T4- 3
:
SV CNT
CT SEN
0=Of
0=Of
0=Of
1= On
1= On
1= On
f
f
f
0=AL M &BL K 1= ALM
0=Of 1= On
f
Note: The menu of DIFTPMD depends on the phase matching. The above screen is α-method
(Alpha). In the case of β-method (Beta), DIFTPMD is 1=3POR, 2=2PAND, 3=1P. Refer to
Section 2.2.1.
If the "On" is selected in the menu of REF_DEF, the REF characteristic corresponds to that of
GRT100-xxxC model. If the "Off", it corresponds to that of GRT100-xxxA and -xxxB models.
ENTER
• Enter the number corresponding to the switch status to be set and press the
key for
each switch.
The setting of REF depends on the type of the transformer. The setting method is shown in
Appendix L.
• After setting all switches, press the
key to return to the "Trip" screen.
END
Setting the protection elements
• Press 3 (= Protection element) on the "Trip" screen to display the "Protection element" screen.
/6 P ro t ec ti on e le men t
(Gr ou p = * )
3 = OC
6 = FRQ
1 = DI FT
4 = TH R
2 =R EF
5 =V /F
<DIFT>
• Press 1 (= DIFT) to display the "DIFT" screen. The measuring elements used in the current
differential protection are set using this screen.
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the "Protection element" menu.
⎯ 108 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/7 D IFT
1/ 15
pu
ik
p1
p2
(
(
(
0. 10 -
10 -
1 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 10
1 0
1 0 0
2 0 0
) :
) :
%
%
1 00
10 -
kp
(
1. 00 - 2
1 . 00
pu
0 . 0 0 ) :
5 0 . 0 0 ) :
5 0 . 0 0 ) :
5 0 . 0 0 ) :
2 ) :
t
kc 1 (
0. 05 -
0. 05 -
0. 05 -
1 -
1 . 0 0
2
3
kct
kct
(
(
1 . 5 0
2 . 0 0
yd _p (
yd _s (
1
1
0
1
0
2 ) :
1 -
1 1 ) :
ve c_ (
s
1 -
) :
2
yd _t (
1 -
1 1 ) :
ve c_ (
1 -
t
%
%
k2 f
k5 f
kh
(
(
(
5 0
1 0 0
):
):
10
50
10 -
10 -
2. 00 -
pu
2 0 . 0 0 ) :
2 . 00
<REF>
• Press 2 (= REF) to display the "REF" screen. The measuring elements and timers used in the
restricted earth fault protection are set using this screen.
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the "Protection element" menu.
/7 R EF
1/ 21
1ik
(
0. 05 -
1. 00 -
pu
0 . 5 0 ) :
0 . 0 5
1 . 0 0
1k ct 1 (
5 0 . 0 0 ) :
) :
50 . 0 0
1
. 00
ct 2
ct 3
1.
-
1k
1k
(
00
50 . 0 0 ) :
1 0 0 ) :
1 . 00
5 0
1.
00 -
50 -
(
(
(
(
1p 2
1k p
2i k
%
pu
pu
0. 50
-
2 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 5 0 ) :
1 . 0 0
0 . 5 0
1 . 0 0
1 . 0 0
1 . 00
5 0
0. 05 -
1. 00 -
1. 00 -
2k ct 1(
2k ct 2(
0 . 0 0 ) :
5
50 . 0 0 ) :
50 . 0 0 ) :
ct 3
1.
-
2k
(
(
(
(
00
) :
10 0
2p 2
2k p
3i k
50 -
%
pu
pu
0. 50
0. 05
-
-
2 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 5 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0
0 . 5 0
1 . 0 0
1 . 0 0
3k ct 1(
3k ct 2(
1. 00 -
1. 00 - 5
5
) :
1
50 . 0 0
. 00
5 0
ct 3
-
3k
(
(
(
1. 00
3p 2
3k p
0 0 ) :
1
50 -
%
pu
0. 50 -
2 . 0 0 ) :
10 .
1 . 0 0
0 . 0
0 . 0
0 . 0
0 0 ) :
) :
1
1
1
-
s
s
s
T1 RE F(
RE F
0. 00
1
0 .
0 0
T2
(
0. 0 -
0
10 .
0 0 ) :
-
T3 RE F(
0. 00
<OC>
• Press 3 (OC) to display the "OC" screen. The overcurrent elements and timers are set using this
screen.
⎯ 109 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the "Protection element" menu.
1 / 2 4
/7 O C
1 O C
2 O C
3 O C
(
(
(
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
p u
p u
p u
T 1 O C
T 2 O C
T 3 O C
1 O C I
2 O C I
3 O C I
(
(
(
(
(
(
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0
0 . 0 0
0 . 0 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 5 0
0 . 5 0
0 . 5 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 0 0
0 . 0 0
0 . 0 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 1 0
0 . 5 0
0 . 5 0
0 . 5 0
s
s
s
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 0 5 -
0 . 0 5 -
0 . 0 5 -
5 . 0 0 ) :
5 . 0 0 ) :
5 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
p u
p u
p u
T 1 O C I (
T 2 O C I (
T 3 O C I (
1 E F
2 E F
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 1 0 - 2 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 - 1 0 . 0 0 ) :
p u
p u
p u
s
3 E F
T 1 E F
T 2 E F
T 3 E F
1 E F I
2 E F I
3 E F I
s
s
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 1 0 -
0 . 0 5 -
0 . 0 5 -
0 . 0 5 -
5 . 0 0 ) :
5 . 0 0 ) :
5 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
1 . 0 0 ) :
p u
p u
p u
T 1 E F I (
T 2 E F I (
T 3 E F I (
<THR>
• Press 4 (= THR) to display the "THR" screen. The measuring elements and the timer used in
the thermal overload protection are set using this screen.
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the "Protection element" menu.
/7 T HR
1/ 5
(
(
(
0 . 5 - 5
m in
0 0 . 0 ) :
4 . 0 0 ) :
2 . 5 0 ) :
0 . 5
0 . 10
0 . 50
τ
k
0 .
10 -
pu
IB
0 . 50 -
Ip
TA
(
(
0. 00 -
0 -
pu
1 . 0 0 ) :
1 0 ) :
0
. 50
0
min
<V/F>
• Press 5 (= V/F) to display the “V/F” screen. The measuring elements and timers used in the
overexcitation protection are set using this screen.
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the “Protection element” menu.
⎯ 110 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/7 V /F
1 /
V
9
V
A
L
( 10 0 . 0 - 12 .
0 0 ) :
1 . 3 0 ) :
1 . 3 0 ) :
1 0
0 . 0
pu
(
(
1 . 10
1 . 20
1 .
03
-
pu
1 . 05 -
H
(
(
(
(
1. 10 -
1 -
1 -
pu
s
s
s
s
1 . 4 0 ) :
6 0 0 ) :
6 0 0 ) :
3 6 0 0 ) :
6 0 0 ) :
6 0 0 ) :
1 . 30
L T
H T
R T
T V F H (
T V F A (
1
1
60
1
60 -
1 -
1 -
s
1
<FRQ>
• Press 6 (= FRQ) to display the “FRQ” screen. The measuring elements and timers used in the
frequency protection are set using this screen.
ENTER
• Enter the numerical value and press the
key for each element.
END
• After setting all elements, press the
key to return to the “Protection element” menu.
/7 F R Q
1/ 6
81 -1 ( 45 . 00 - 55 . 0 0 ):
81 -2 ( 55 . 0 0 ) :
) :
Hz
Hz
V
4 5 . 00
4 5 . 00
40
45 .
00
-
1 0 0
UV
(
40 -
T
T
( 0. 00 - 6
( 0. 00 - 6
s
s
s
F R Q L
F R Q H
0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 ) :
0 . 0 0 ) :
0
0
0
. 00
. 00
. 00
T F R Q A ( 0. 00 - 6
Setting group copy
To copy the settings of one group and overwrite them to another group, do the following:
• Press 3 (= Copy group) on the "Protection" screen to display the "Copy group A to B" screen.
/3 C op y gr ou p A t o B
(Ac t iv e gr ou p = * )
A
B
(
(
1 -
1 -
8 ) :
8 ) :
• Enter the group number to be copied in line A and press the ENTER key.
• Enter the group number to be overwritten by the copy in line B and press the ENTER key.
4.2.6.8 Binary Input
The logic level of binary input signals can be inverted by setting before entering the scheme logic.
Inversion is used when the input contact cannot meet the conditions described in Table 3.2.2.
• Press 7 (= Binary input) on the "Setting (change)" sub-menu to display the "Binary input"
screen.
⎯ 111 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/2 B in ary i np ut
B ISW 1
1 = No rm
2 =I nv
1 /15
1
1
1
B ISW 2
B ISW 3
B IS W 4
B IS W 5
:
1
1
:
1
1
B I S W 14
B I S W 15
B I S W 16
1
ENTER
• Enter 1 (= Normal) or 2 (= Inverted) and press the
key for each binary input.
4.2.6.9 Binary Output
All the binary outputs of the GRT100 except the tripping command, and the relay failure signal are
user-configurable. It is possible to assign one signal or up to six ANDing or ORing signals to one
output relay. Available signals are listed in Appendix B.
It is also possible to attach a drop-off delay time of 0.2 seconds to these signals. The drop-off delay
time is disabled by the scheme switch [BOTD].
Appendix D shows the factory default settings.
To configure the binary output signals, do the following:
Selection of output module
• Press 8 (= Binary output) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "Binary output"
screen. The available output module(s) will be shown.
/2 B ina ry out pu t
1 = IO# 2
2 = IO# 3
• Press the number corresponding to the selected output module to display the "Binary output"
screen.
/3 B inar y ou tput
Se lect BO
(IO2)
(
1 - 1 3)
S ele c t No . =
Note: The setting is required for all the binary outputs. If any of the binary outputs are not to be used,
enter 0 for the logic gates #1 to #6 when assign signals.
Selecting the output relay
ENTER
• Enter the output relay number and press the
key to display the "Setting" screen.
/4 S et t in g
(BO1
I O2 )
of
1= Lo gi c g at e ty pe & de lay ti me r
2 = In pu t t o lo gi c ga t e
⎯ 112 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting the logic gate type and timer
• Press 1 to display the "Logic gate type and delay timer" screen.
/5 L og i c ga te t yp e & d ela y t im er
1 / 2
Lo gi c
BO TD
1 =O R
2 = AN D
1 = On
1
1
0 =O ff
ENTER
• Enter 1 or 2 to use an OR gate or AND gate and press the
key.
ENTER
• Enter 0 or 1 to add 0.2s drop-off delay time to the output relay or not and press the
key.
END
• Press the
key to return to the "Setting" screen.
Assigning signals
• Press 2 on the "Setting" screen to display the "Input to logic gate" screen.
/5 I np u t to l og ic g a te
1 / 6
In #1 (
In #2 (
In #3 (
0 -
0 -
0 -
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
21
4
67
In #4 (
In #5 (
In #6 (
0 -
0 -
0 -
0
0
0
3
07 1 :
)
307 1 ) :
• Assign signals to gates (In #1 to #6) by entering the number corresponding to each signal
referring to Appendix B.
Note: If signals are not assigned to all the gates #1 to #6, enter 0 for the unassigned gate(s).
Repeat this process for the outputs to be configured.
4.2.6.10 LEDs
Four LEDs of the GRT100 are user-configurable. Each is driven via a logic gate which can be
programmed for OR gate or AND gate operation. Further, each LED has a programmable reset
characteristic, settable for instantaneous drop-off, or for latching operation. The signals listed in
Appendix B can be assigned to each LED as follows.
Selection of LED
•
Press 9 (= LED) on the "Setting (change)" screen to display the "LED" screen.
/2 L ED
Se le ct LE D
(
1 -
4)
S ele c t No . =
• Enter the LED number and press the ENTER key to display the "Setting" screen.
/3 S et t in g
(LED 1 )
1= Lo gi c g at e ty pe & re set
2 = In pu t t o lo gi c ga t e
⎯ 113 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Setting the logic gate type and reset
• Press 1 to display the "Logic gate type and reset" screen.
/4 L ogi c g at e ty p e & r e se t
1 / 2
L o g i c
R e s e t
1 = O R
2 = A N D
1
1
0 = I n s t 1 = La t c h
• Enter 1 or 2 to use an OR gate or AND gate and press the ENTER key.
• Enter 0 or 1 to select “Instantaneous reset” or “Latch reset” and press the ENTER key.
END
• Press the
key to return to the "Setting" screen.
Note: To release the latch state, refer to Section 4.2.1.
Assigning signals
• Press 2 on the "Setting" screen to display the "Input to logic gate" screen.
/4 I np u t to l og ic g a te
1 / 4
In #1 (
In #2 (
In #3 (
0 -
0 -
0 -
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
2 1
4
6 7
In #4 (
0 -
307 1 ) :
0
•
Assign signals to gates (In #1- #4) by entering the number corresponding to each signal
referring to Appendix B.
Note: If signals are not assigned to all the gates #1-#4, enter 0 to the unassigned gate(s).
Repeat this process for other LEDs to be configured.
4.2.7 Testing
The sub-menu "Test" provides such functions as setting of testing switches, forced operation of
binary outputs, time measurement of the variable setting timer and logic signal observation.
The password must be entered in order to enter the test screens because the "Test" menu has
password security protection. (See Section 4.2.6.2.)
4.2.7.1 Setting the switches
The automatic monitor function (A.M.F.) can be disabled by setting the switch [A.M.F] to "OFF".
Disabling the A.M.F. prevents tripping from being blocked even in the event of a failure in the
items being monitored by this function. It also prevents failures from being displayed on the
"ALARM" LED and LCD described in Section 4.2.1. No events related to A.M.F. are recorded,
either.
Disabling A.M.F. is useful for blocking the output of unnecessary alarms during testing.
Note: Set the switch [A.M.F] to "Off" before applying the test inputs, when the A.M.F is disabled.
The switch [Reset] is used to test the THR and V/F elements. When the switch [Reset] is set to "1",
the time counting of inverse time characteristic can be forcibly reset.
While the switch [A.M.F] is set to "0" or [Reset] is set to "1", the red "TESTING" LED is lit for
⎯ 114 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
alarm purposes.
Caution: Be sure to restore these switches after the tests are completed.
Disabling automatic monitoring
• Press 5 (= Test) on the top "MENU" screen to display the "Test" screen.
/1 Tes t
Bina r y outp ut
Logi c c ircu it
1= Swit ch
3= T imer
2 =
4 =
• Press 1 (= Switch) to display the "Switch" screen.
/2 S wi t ch
1 / 3
A. M. F.
Rese t
IE CTST
0 =O ff
0 =O ff
0 =Off
1 = On
1 = On
1 =On
1
0
1
ENTER
• Enter 0 for A.M.F to disable the A.M.F. and press the
• Enter 1(=On) for IECTST to transmit ‘test mode’ to the control system by IEC60870-5-103
ENTER
key.
communication when testing the local relay, and press the
END
key.
• Press the
key to return to the "Test" screen.
Resetting the time counting of THR and V/F elements
ENTER
• Enter 1 for Reset to reset the time counting forcibly and press the
key.
END
• Press the
key to return to the "Test" screen.
4.2.7.2 Binary Output Relay
It is possible to forcibly operate all binary output relays for checking connections with the external
devices. Forced operation can be performed on one or more binary outputs at a time for each
module.
• Press 2 (= Binary output) on the "Test" screen to display the "Binary output" screen.
/ 2 B i n a r y o u t p u t
1 = I O # 1
2 = I O # 2
3 = I O # 3
The LCD displays the output modules mounted depending on the model.
• Enter the selected number corresponding to each module to be operated. Then the LCD
displays the name of the module, the name of the output relay, the name of the terminal block
and the terminal number to which the relay contact is connected.
⎯ 115 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/3 B O
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
(0 = Di s ab le 1 =E na bl e)
1 /14
B O1
B O2
B O3
1
1
1
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
B O4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
B O5
B O6
B O7
B O8
B O9
B O10
B O11
B O12
F AI L
B O13
ENTER
• Enter 1 and press the
key.
END
• After completing the entries, press the
key. Then the LCD displays the screen shown
below.
/3 B O
Keep pre ss i ng 1 to o per at e .
Pres s C AN CE L to c anc el .
• Keep pressing
key to operate the output relays forcibly.
1
• Release the press of
key to reset the operation.
1
4.2.7.3 Timer
The pick-up or drop-off delay time of the variable timer used in the scheme logic can be measured
with monitoring jacks A and B. Monitoring jacks A and B are used to observe the input signal and
output signal to the timer respectively.
• Press 3 (= Timer) on the "Test" screen to display the "Timer" screen.
/2 T i m e r
Time r(
1 / 1
1 -
1 0 0 ) :
1
ENTER
• Enter the number corresponding to the timer to be observed and press the
key. The
timers and related numbers are listed in Appendix C.
END
• Press the
key to display the following screen.
/2 T im e r
Pr es s E NT ER t o op er a te .
Pr es s C AN CE L to c an c el .
ENTER
• Press the
key to operate the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns on, and timer is
⎯ 116 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
initiated and the following display appears. The input and output signals of the timer can be
observed at monitoring jacks A and B respectively. The LEDs above monitoring jacks A or B
are also lit if the input or output signal exists.
/2 T im e r
Op er at i ng .. .
Pr es s E ND t o re se t.
Pr es s C AN CE L to c an c el .
END
• Press the
key to reset the input signal to the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns off.
CANCEL
• Press the
key to test other timers. Repeat the above testing.
4.2.7.4 Logic Circuit
It is possible to observe the binary signal level on the signals listed in Appendix B with monitoring
jacks A and B.
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
/2 Log i c circ ui t
1 / 2
T e r m A (
Te rm B(
0 -
0 -
30 7 1 ) :
071 ) :
1
4 8
3
ENTER
• Enter a signal number to be observed at monitoring jack A and press the
key.
ENTER
• Enter the other signal number to be observed at monitoring jack B and press the
key.
After completing the setting, the signals can be observed by the binary logic level at monitoring
jacks A and B or by the LEDs above the jacks.
On screens other than the above screen, observation with the monitoring jacks is disabled.
⎯ 117 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.3 Personal Computer Interface
The relay can be operated from a personal computer using an RS-232C port on the front panel.
On the personal computer, the following analysis and display of the fault voltage and current are
available in addition to the items available on the LCD screen.
• Display of voltage and current waveform:
• Symmetrical component analysis:
• Harmonic analysis:
Oscillograph, vector display
On arbitrary time span
On arbitrary time span
On arbitrary time span
• Frequency analysis:
For the details, see the separate instruction manual "PC INTERFACE RSM100".
4.4 Communication Interface
The relay can be provided with the following communication interfaces:
- RSM100 (Relay Setting and Monitoring)
- IEC 60870-5-103
- IEC 61850
4.4.1 RSM (Relay Setting and Monitoring System)
The Relay Setting and Monitoring (RSM) system is a system that retrieves and analyses the data
on power system quantities, fault and event records and views or changes settings in individual
relays via a telecommunication network using a remote PC.
For the details, see the separate instruction manual "PC INTERFACE RSM100".
Figure 4.4.1.1 shows the typical configuration of the RSM system via a protocol converter
G1PR2. The relays are connected through twisted pair cables, and the maximum 256 relays can be
connected since the G1PR2 can provide up to 8 ports. The total length of twisted pair wires should
not exceed 1200 m. Relays are mutually connected using an RS485 port on the relay rear panel and
connected to a PC RS232C port via G1PR2. Terminal resistor (150 ohms) is connected the last
relay. The transmission rate used is 64 kbits/s.
Figure 4.4.1.2 shows the configuration of the RSM system with Ethernet LAN (option). The relays
are connected to HUB through UTP cable using RJ-45 connector at the rear of the relay. The relay
recognizes the transmission speed automatically.
In case of the optional fiber optic interface (option), the relays are connected through graded-index
multi-mode 50/125μm or 62.5/125μm type optical fiber using ST connector at the rear of the
relay.
⎯ 118 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Twisted paired
cable
G1PR2
Figure 4.4.1.1 Relay Setting and Monitoring System (1)
UTP cable
(10Base-T or
100Base TX)
214B-13-10
100/110/115/120V
Other
relays
HUB.
Relay
PC
Figure 4.4.1.2 Relay Setting and Monitoring System (2)
4.4.2 IEC 60870-5-103 Interface
The relay can support the IEC60870-5-103 communication protocol. This protocol is mainly used
when the relay communicates with substation automation system and is used to transfer the
following measurand, status data and general command from the relay to the control system.
• Measurand data:
• Status data:
current, voltage, frequency
events, fault indications, etc.
The IEC60870-5-103 function in the relay can be customized with the original software “IEC103
configurator”. It runs on a personal computer (PC) connected to the relay, and can help setting of
Time-tagged messages, General command, Metering, etc. For details of the setting method, refer
to “IEC103 configurator” manual. For the default setting of IEC60870-5-103, see Appendix N.
The protocol can be used through the RS485 port on the relay rear panel and can be also used
through the optional fibre optical interface.
The relay supports two baud-rates 9.6kbps and 19.2kbps.
The data transfer from the relay can be blocked by the setting.
For the settings, see the Section 4.2.6.4.
⎯ 119 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.4.3 IEC 61850 interface
The relay can also communicate with substation automation system via Ethernet communication
networks using IEC 61850 protocols.
Figure 4.4.3.1 Substation Automation System using Ethernet-based IEC 61850 protocol
4.5 Clock Function
The clock function (Calendar clock) is used for time-tagging for the following purposes:
• Event records
• Disturbance records
• Fault records
• Metering
• Automatic supervision
• Display of the system quantities on the digest screen
• Display of the fault records on the digest screen
• Display of the automatic monitoring results on the digest screen
The calendar clock can run locally or be synchronized with the external IRIG-B time standard
signal, RSM or IEC clock. This can be selected by setting.
If it is necessary to synchronize with the IRIG-B time standard signal, it is possible to transform
GMT to the local time by setting.
When the relays are connected to the RSM system as shown in Figure 4.4.1.1, the calendar clock
of each relay is synchronized with the RSM clock. If the RSM clock is synchronized with the
external time standard (GPS clock etc.), then all the relay clocks are synchronized with the
external time standard.
⎯ 120 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
5. Installation
5.1 Receipt of Relays
When relays are received, carry out the acceptance inspection immediately. In particular, check
for damage during transportation, and if any is found, contact the vendor.
Check that the following accessories are attached.
• 3 pins for the monitoring jack, packed in a plastic bag.
• An optional attachment kit required in rack-mounting. (See Appendix F.)
1 large bracket with 5 round head screws, spring washers and washers (M4×10)
1 small bracket with 3 countersunk head screws (M4×6)
2 bars with 4 countersunk head screws (M3×8)
Always store the relays in a clean, dry environment.
5.2 Relay Mounting
Either a rack or flush mounting relay is delivered as designated by the customer. The GRT100
models are housed into type A case. Appendix F shows the case outline.
If the customer requires a rack-mounting relay, support metal fittings necessary to mount it in the
19-inch rack are also supplied with the relay.
When mounting the relay in the rack, detach the original brackets fixed on both sides of the relay
and seals on the top and bottom of the relay. Attach the larger bracket and smaller bracket on the
left and right side of the relay respectively and the two bars on the top and bottom of the relay.
How to mount the attachment kit, see Appendix F.
Dimension of the attachment kit EP-101 is also shown in Appendix F.
5.3 Electrostatic Discharge
CAUTION
Do not take out any modules outside the relay case since electronic components on the modules
are very sensitive to electrostatic discharge. If it is absolutely essential to take the modules out of
the case, do not touch the electronic components and terminals with your bare hands.
Additionally, always put the module in a conductive anti-static bag when storing it.
5.4 Handling Precautions
A person's normal movements can easily generate electrostatic potential of several thousand volts.
Discharge of these voltages into semiconductor devices when handling electronic circuits can
cause serious damage, which often may not be immediately apparent but the reliability of the
circuit will have been reduced.
The electronic circuits are completely safe from electrostatic discharge when housed in the case.
Do not expose them to risk of damage by withdrawing modules unnecessarily.
Each module incorporates the highest practicable protection for its semiconductor devices.
However, if it becomes necessary to withdraw a module, precautions should be taken to preserve
the high reliability and long life for which the equipment has been designed and manufactured.
⎯ 121 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
CAUTION
• Before removing a module, ensure that you are at the same electrostatic potential as the
equipment by touching the case.
• Handle the module by its front plate, frame or edges of the printed circuit board. Avoid
touching the electronic components, printed circuit board or connectors.
• Do not pass the module to another person without first ensuring you are both at the same
electrostatic potential. Shaking hands achieves equipotential.
• Place the module on an anti-static surface, or on a conducting surface which is at the same
potential as yourself.
• Do not place modules in polystyrene trays.
It is strongly recommended that detailed investigations on electronic circuitry should be carried
out in a Special Handling Area such as described in the IEC 60747.
5.5 External Connections
External connections are shown in Appendix G.
Note: In wire connections of terminal block for type A case, the following connections are
recommended because a communication port is located between terminal blocks.
Top View
Relay
Terminal
block
Wire
Wire
Communication port
(LAN port)
Figure 5.5.1
Example of Wire Connection
⎯ 122 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6. Commissioning and Maintenance
6.1 Outline of Commissioning Tests
The GRT100 is fully numerical and the hardware is continuously monitored.
Commissioning tests can be kept to a minimum and need only include hardware tests and
conjunctive tests. The function tests are at the user’s discretion.
In these tests, user interfaces on the front panel of the relay or local PC can be fully applied.
Test personnel must be familiar with general relay testing practices and safety precautions to avoid
personal injuries or equipment damage.
Hardware tests
These tests are performed for the following hardware to ensure that there is no hardware defect.
Defects of hardware circuits other than the following can be detected by monitoring which circuits
function when the DC power is supplied.
User interfaces
Binary input circuits and output circuits
AC input circuits
Function tests
These tests are performed for the following functions that are fully software-based. Tests of the
protection schemes and fault locator require a dynamic test set.
Measuring elements
Timers
Metering and recording
Conjunctive tests
The tests are performed after the relay is connected with the primary equipment and other external
equipment.
The following tests are included in these tests:
On load test: phase sequence check and polarity check
Tripping circuit test
⎯ 123 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.2 Cautions
6.2.1 Safety Precautions
CAUTION
• The relay rack is provided with a grounding terminal.
Before starting the work, always make sure the relay rack is grounded.
• When connecting the cable to the back of the relay, firmly fix it to the terminal block and attach
the cover provided on top of it.
• Before checking the interior of the relay, be sure to turn off the power.
Failure to observe any of the precautions above may cause electric shock or malfunction.
6.2.2 Cautions on Tests
CAUTION
• While the power is on, do not connect/disconnect the flat cable on the front of the printed
circuit board (PCB).
• While the power is on, do not mount/dismount the PCB.
• Before turning on the power, check the following:
-Make sure the polarity and voltage of the power supply are correct.
-Make sure the CT circuit is not open.
-Make sure the VT circuit is not short-circuited.
• Be careful that the transformer module is not damaged due to an overcurrent or overvoltage.
• If settings are changed for testing, remember to reset them to the original settings.
Failure to observe any of the precautions above may cause damage or malfunction of the relay.
Before mounting/dismounting the PCB, take antistatic measures such as wearing an earthed
wristband.
⎯ 124 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.3 Preparations
Test equipment
The following test equipment is required for the commissioning tests.
1 Single-phase voltage source
2 Single-phase current sources
1 Variable-frequency source
1 Combined fundamental and 2nd-harmonic adjustable current supply
1 Combined fundamental and 5th-harmonic adjustable current supply
1 DC power supply
1 DC voltmeter
1 AC voltmeter
1 Phase angle meter
2 AC ammeters
1 Frequency meter
1 Time counter, precision timer
1 PC (not essential)
Relay settings
Before starting the tests, it must be specified whether the tests will use the user’s settings or the
default settings.
For the default settings, see the following appendixes:
Appendix D Binary Output Default Setting List
Appendix H Relay Setting Sheet
Visual inspection
After unpacking the product, check for any damage to the relay case. If there is any damage, the
internal module might also have been affected. Contact the vendor.
Relay ratings
Check that the items described on the nameplate on the front of the relay conform to the user’s
specification. The items are: relay type and model, AC voltage, current and frequency ratings, and
auxiliary DC supply voltage rating.
Local PC
When using a local PC, connect it with the relay via the RS-232C port on the front of the relay.
RSM100 software is required to run the PC.
For the details, see the separate instruction manual "PC INTERFACE RSM100".
⎯ 125 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.4 Hardware Tests
The tests can be performed without external wiring, but DC power supply and AC voltage and
current source are required.
6.4.1 User Interfaces
This test ensures that the LCD, LEDs and keys function correctly.
LCD display
• Apply the rated DC voltage and check that the LCD is off.
Note: If there is a failure, the LCD displays the "Auto-supervision" screen when the DC voltage is
applied.
RESET
• Press the
key for 1 second and check that black dots appear on the whole screen.
LED display
• Apply the rated DC voltage and check that the "IN SERVICE" LED is lit in green.
RESET
• Press the
key for 1 second and check that seven LEDs under the "IN SERVICE"
LED and two LEDs for monitoring jacks A and B are lit in red.
VIEW and RESET keys
• Press the VIEW key when the LCD is off and check that the "Metering" screen is displayed
on the LCD.
RESET
• Press the
key and check that the LCD turns off.
Keypad
• Press any key on the keypad when the LCD is off and check that the LCD displays the
END
"MENU" screen. Press the
key to turn off the LCD.
• Repeat this for all keys.
⎯ 126 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.4.2 Binary Input Circuit
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.4.1.
GRT100
GRT100
-B4
TB4
TB4
-A4
-B4
-A4
BI1
BI1
BI2
:
:
-B5
-A5
BI2
:
:
:
:
:
:
-B10
-A10
-A10
-B11
BI12
BI13
TB3
-A14
-B14
TB3
-A14
-B14
-A15
BI14
BI15
BI14
BI15
-A15
-B15
BI16
BI16
-B15
TB4
TB4
+
−
+
−
-A16
-A17
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
DC
power
supply
E
E
(a) For Model 203, 204
(a) For Model 101,102, 201, 202
Figure 6.4.1 Testing Binary Input Circuit
• Display the "Binary input & output" screen from the "Status" sub-menu.
/2 B in a ry i np ut & o u tp ut
3/ 5
In pu t ( IO #1)
[0 0 0 0 00 00 0 000
]
]
]
In pu t ( IO #2 )
[0 0 0
[0 00
)
Ou tp ut ( IO# 1 -t ri p
Ou tp ut ( IO# 2 )
Ou tp ut ( IO# 3 )
[0 00 00 0 0 00 000 00 ]
[0 00 00 0 0 00 0
]
• Apply the rated DC voltage to terminal A4, B4, ..., A6 of terminal block TB4, and A14, B14
and A15 of terminal block TB3.
Check that the status display corresponding to the input signal changes from 0 to 1. (For details
of the binary input status display, see Section 4.2.4.2.)
The user will be able to perform this test for one terminal to another or for all the terminals at once.
⎯ 127 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.4.3 Binary Output Circuit
This test can be performed by using the "Test" sub-menu and forcibly operating the relay drivers
and output relays. Operation of the output contacts is monitored at the output terminal. The output
contact and corresponding terminal number are shown in Appendix G.
• Press 2 (= Binary output) on the "Test" screen to display the "Binary output" screen. The LCD
displays the output modules mounted, depending on the model.
/2 B ina ry out pu t
1 = IO# 2
2 = IO# 3
• Enter the selected number corresponding to each module to be operated. Then the LCD
displays the name of the module, the name of the output relay, the name of the terminal block
and the terminal number to which the relay contact is connected.
/3 B O
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
(0 = Di s ab le 1 =E na bl e)
1 /14
B O1
B O2
B O3
1
1
1
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
IO# 2
B O4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
B O5
B O6
B O7
B O8
B O9
B O10
B O11
B O12
F AI L
B O13
ENTER
• Enter 1 and press the
key.
END
• After completing the entries, press the
key. Then the LCD displays the screen shown
below. If 1 is entered for all the output relays, the following forcible operation can be
performed collectively.
/3 B O
K e ep
p r ess ing 1 t o op er a t .
e
to ca nce l
P r es s
.
C AN CE L
• Keep pressing the
key to operate the output relays forcibly.
1
• Check that the output contacts operate at the terminal.
• Release pressing the
key to reset the operation.
1
⎯ 128 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.4.4 AC Input Circuits
This test can be performed by applying the checking voltages and currents to the AC input circuits
and verifying that the values applied coincide with the values displayed on the LCD screen.
The testing circuit for Model 100 series is shown in Figure 6.4.2. A single-phase voltage source
and two single-phase current sources are required. (Test Model 200 series by same testing method
of Model 100 series.)
GRT100 – 100 series
V
TB1
-27
-28
Single-phase
voltage
V
source
TB1
-1
-2
-3
Single-phase
current
source
A
I
a
I
I
b
-4
-5
-6
c
-7
I
N
-8
-9
I
a
-10
-11
-12
-13
-14
-15
-16
I
b
I
c
I
N
TB4
-A16
-A17
+
−
DC
power
supply
E
Figure 6.4.2 Testing AC Input Circuit (Model 100s)
• Check that the metering data is set to be expressed as secondary values (Display value = 2) on
the "Metering" screen.
"Setting (view)" sub-menu → "Status" setting screen → "Metering" screen
If the setting is Primary (Display value = 1), change the setting in the "Setting (change)"
sub-menu. Remember to reset it to the initial setting after the test is finished.
• Open the "Metering" screen in the "Status" sub-menu.
"Status" sub-menu → "Metering" screen
• Apply the rated AC voltages and currents and check that the displayed values are within ± 5%
of the input values.
⎯ 129 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5 Function Test
6.5.1 Measuring Element
Measuring element characteristics are realized by the software, so it is possible to verify the
overall characteristics by checking representative points.
Operation of the element under test is observed by the binary output signal at monitoring jacks A
or B or by the LED indications above the jacks. In any case, the signal number corresponding to
each element output must be set on the "Logic circuit" screen of the "Test" sub-menu.
/2 L og i c ci rc ui t
1 / 2
Te rm A(
Te rm B(
0 -
0 -
307 1 ) :
307 1 ) :
1
48
When a signal number is entered for the TermA line, the signal is observed at monitoring jack A
and when entered for the TermB line, observed at monitoring jack B.
Note: The voltage level at the monitoring jacks is +15V ±3V for logic level "1" and less than 0.1V
for logic level "0".
CAUTION
• Use the testing equipment with more than 1kΩ of internal impedance when observing the
output signal at the monitoring jacks.
• Do not apply an external voltage to the monitoring jacks.
In case of a three-phase element, it is enough to test for a representative phase. A-phase element is
selected hereafter.
6.5.1.1 Current differential element DIF
The current differential element is checked on the following items
• Operating current value
• Percentage restraining characteristic
• Operating time
Note: Set all the CT ratio matching settings (kct1 to kct3) to “1” and phase angle matching settings
(d1 to d3) to “0” in the testing described in 6.5.1.1 to 6.5.1.4, because the operating value
depends on the settings.
Operating current value
Minimum operating current value is checked by simulating a one-end infeed. Figure 6.5.1 shows a
testing circuit simulating an infeed from a primary winding.
⎯ 130 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GRT100
TB1
+
Single-phase
current
-1
-2
A
I
a
source
−
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.1 Operating Current Value Test Circuit (Model 100s, 200s)
The output signal numbers of the DIF elements are as follows:
Element
DIF-A
Signal number
44
45
46
DIF-B
DIF-C
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number 44 to observe the DIF-A operation at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply a test current to A-phase current terminals and change the magnitude of the current
applied and measure the value at which the element DIF-A operates.
Check that the measured value is within 7% of the theoretical operating value.
Theoretical operating value = (CT secondary rated current) × (ik setting)
Percentage restraining characteristics
The percentage restraining characteristic is tested on the outflow current (Iout) and infeed current
(Iin) plane as shown in Figure 6.5.2. The characteristic shown in Figure 6.5.2 is equivalent to the
one on the differential current (Id) and restraining current (Ir) plane shown in Figure 2.11.1.
⎯ 131 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
I
out
DF2
DF1
I
ik
0
in
2+p1
2
2−p1
4
kp +
ik
Figure 6.5.2 Current Differential Element (Iout - Iin Plane)
Figure 6.5.3 shows a testing circuit simulating an infeed from a primary winding and outflow from
a secondary winding.
GRT100
Infeed current (Iin)
TB1
+
Single-phase
current
-1
-2
A
Iin
source
−
φ
Outflow current
A
(Iout
)
Monitoring
jack
+
-9
A
0V
Single-phase
current
Iout
source
−
-10
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.3 Percentage Restraining Characteristic Test of DIF (Model 100s, 200s)
⎯ 132 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number 44 to observe the DIF-A output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply an infeed current to terminal TB1-1 and -2.
When the infeed current applied is larger than the setting of ik (pu) and smaller than
kp(2+p1)/2 + ik(2-p1)/4 (pu), characteristic DF1 is checked.
When the infeed current applied is larger than kp(2+ p1)/2 + ik(2- p1)/4 (pu), characteristic
DF2 is checked.
Note: When the default settings are applied, the critical infeed current which
determines DF1 checking or DF2 checking is 1.56×(CT secondary rated
current).
• Apply an outflow current of the same magnitude and counterphase with the infeed current
to terminal TB1-9 and 10.
• Decrease the out flow current in magnitude and measure the values at which the element
operates.
• Check that the measured values are within 7% of the theoretical values.
For characteristic DF1, the theoretical outflow current is given by the following equation:
Iout = (2−p1)(Iin−ik)/(2+p1) (pu)
where, p1 = slope setting of DF1
ik = minimum operating current setting
When the default settings are applied, Iout = [(Iin−0.3) / 3]× (CT secondary rated current).
For characteristic DF2, the theoretical outflow current is given by the following equation.
Iout = [(2−p2)Iin −(2−p1)ik + 2(p2− p1)kp]/(2+ p2) (pu)
where, p2 = slope setting of DF2
kp = break point of DF1 and DF2
When the default settings are applied, Iout = 0.43× (CT secondary rated current).
Operating time
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.4.
⎯ 133 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GRT100
TB1
-1
-2
A
Single-phase
current
source
I
a
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
Start
Time
counter
Stop
OV
Figure 6.5.4 Operating Time Test (Model 100s, 200s)
• Set a test current to 3 times of DIF operating current (= CT secondary rated current × ik
setting).
• Apply the test current and measure the operating time.
• Check that the operating time is 40 ms or less.
⎯ 134 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.2 2F element
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.5.
GRT100
+
−
Current
source
TB1
I
1
-1
-2
I
a
50 or 60Hz
+
−
Current
source
I
2
A
100 or 120Hz
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.5 Testing 2F Element (Model 100s, 200s)
The output signal number of the 2F element is as follows:
Element
Signal number
2F
122
• Set the second harmonic restraint setting k2f to 15%(= default setting).
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number to observe the 2F output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Set the fundamental frequency current I to 3 times of ik setting. Change the magnitude of
1
the second harmonic current I and measure the value at which the element operates.
2
• Calculate the percentage of the second harmonic by I /I when the element operates.
2 1
Check that the percentage is within 7% of the k2f setting.
⎯ 135 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.3 5F element
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.6.
GRT100
+
−
Current
source
TB1
I
1
-1
-2
I
a
50 or 60Hz
+
−
Current
source
I
2
A
Monitoring
jack
250 or 300Hz
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.6 Testing 5F Element (Model 100s, 200s)
The output signal number of the 5F element is as follows:
Element
Signal number
5F
123
• Set the fifth harmonic restraint setting k5f to 30%.(= default setting)
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number to observe the 5F output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Set the fundamental frequency current I to 3 times of ik setting. Change the magnitude of
1
the fifth harmonic current I and measure the value at which the element operates.
5
• Calculate the percentage of the fifth harmonic by I /I when the element operates. Check
5 1
that the percentage is within 7% of the k5f setting.
⎯ 136 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.4 High-set overcurrent element HOC
Operating current value
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.1.
The output signal numbers of the HOC elements are as follows:
Element
HOC-A
HOC-B
HOC-C
Signal number
41
42
43
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number 41 to observe the HOC-A output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply a test current to A-phase current terminals and change the magnitude of the current
applied and measure the value at which the element operates.
Check that the measured value is within 7% of the following value.
Operating value = (CT secondary rated current) × (kh setting)
Operating time
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.4.
• Set a test current to 2 times of HOC operating current (= CT secondary rated current × kh
setting)
• Apply the test current and measure the operating time.
• Check that the operating time is 25 ms or less.
⎯ 137 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.5 Restricted earth fault element REF
The restricted earth fault element is checked on the following items.
• Operating current value
• Percentage restraining characteristic
Note: Set all the CT ratio matching settings (1kct1 - 1kct3 to 3kct1 - 3kct3) to "1", because the
operating value depends on the settings.
Operation current value
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.7.
GRT100
TB1
-7
-8
+
Single-phase
current
A
I
N
source
−
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.7 Operating Current Value Test of REF_DIF element (Model 100s, 200s)
The test current input terminal number and output signal number of the REF_DIF element is as
follows:
Element
Input terminal
number
Output signal
number
1REF_DIF TB1-7 and –8
2REF_DIF TB1-15 and –16
3REF_DIF TB1-23 and –24
29
30
31
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter the signal number 29 to observe the 1REF_DIF output at monitoring jack A and press
ENTER
the
key.
• Apply a test current to TB1-7 and -8 and change the magnitude of the current applied and
measure the value at which the element operates.
Check that the measured value is within 15% of the theoretical operating value.
Theoretical operating value = (CT secondary rated current) × (1ik setting)
⎯ 138 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Percentage restraining characteristics
The percentage restraining characteristic is tested on the outflow current (lout) and infeed current
(lin) plane as shown in Figure 6.5.8. The characteristic shown in Figure 6.5.8 is equivalent to the
one on the differential current (ld) and restraining current (lr) plane shown in Figure 2.11.2.
I
out
DF2
DF1
Operating zone
[kp p2 + (1- p1)ik]/(p2 – p1)
・
I
ik
0
in
Figure 6.5.8 REF_DIF Element (I
- I Plane)
out in
Figure 6.5.9 shows a testing circuit simulating infeed from a neutral circuit and outflow from a
primary winding.
GRT100
TB1
+
Single-phase
current
-1
-2
A
Iin
source
−
φ
A
Monitoring
jack
+
-7
-8
A
0V
Single-phase
current
Iout
source
−
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.9 Testing Restricted Earth Fault Element (Model 100s, 200s)
• Enter a signal number 29 to observe the 1REF_DIF output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
⎯ 139 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• Apply an infeed current to terminal TB1-1 and -2.
When the infeed current applied is larger than the setting of ik (pu) and smaller than [kp⋅p2 +
(1−p1)ik]/(p2 − p1) (pu), characteristic DF1 is checked.
When the infeed current applied is larger than [kp⋅p2 + (1−p1)ik]/(p2 − p1) (pu), characteristic
DF2 is checked.
Note: When the default settings are applied, the critical infeed current which
determines DF1 checking or DF2 checking is 1.6×(CT secondary rated
current).
• Apply an outflow current of the same magnitude and counterphase with the infeed current, to
terminal TB1-7 and -8.
• Decrease the outflow current in magnitude and measure the values at which the element
operates.
• Check that the measured values are within 15% of the theoretical values.
For characteristic DF1, the theoretical outflow current is given by the following equation.
Iout = (1−p1)(Iin−ik) (pu)
where,
p1 = slope setting of DF1 (= 0.1 fixed)
ik = minimum operating current setting
When the default settings are applied, Iout = 0.9× (Iin – 0.5) × (CT secondary rated current). For
characteristic DF2, the theoretical outflow current is given by the following equation
I
out = (1−p2) Iin + p2×kp (pu)
where,
p2 = slope setting of DF2
kp = restraining current section setting of DF2
When the default settings are applied, Iout = 1.0 × (CT secondary rated current).
⎯ 140 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.6 Definite time overcurrent elements OC, EF
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.10.
GRT100
TB1
-1
-2
-7
-8
A
I
a
Single-phase
current
source
I
N
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
Figure 6.5.10 Testing OC and EF (Model 100s, 200s)
Element
Signal number
47, 53, 59
1OC, 2OC, 3OC
1EF, 2EF, 3EF
72, 75, 78
The testing procedure is as follows:
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
• Enter a signal number to observe the OC or EF output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply a test current and change the magnitude of the current applied and measure the value at
which the element operates.
Check that the measured value is within ±5% of the theoretical operating value.
Theoretical operating value = (CT secondary rated current) × (OC or EF setting)
⎯ 141 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.7 Inverse time overcurrent elements OCI, EFI
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.11.
GRT100
TB1
-1
-2
-7
-8
A
I
a
Single-phase
current
source
I
N
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
E
DC
power
supply
−
Start
Time
counter
Stop
OV
Figure 6.5.11 Testing OCI and EFI (Model 100s, 200s)
One of the four inverse time characteristics can be set, and the output signal numbers are as
follows:
Element
Signal number
50, 56, 62
1OCI, 2OCI, 3OCI
1EFI, 2EFI, 3EFI
73, 76, 79
Fix the time characteristic to test by setting the OCI or EFI on the "OC" screen.
"Setting (change)" sub-menu → "Protection" screen → "Trip" screen → "Protection element"
screen → "OC" screen
The testing procedure is as follows:
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit" screen.
• Enter a signal number to observe the OCI or EFI output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply a test current and measure the operating time. The magnitude of the test current should
be between 1.2 × I to 20 × I , where I = (CT secondary rated current) × (OCI or EFI current
s
s
s
setting).
• Calculate the theoretical operating time using the characteristic equations shown in Section
2.11.4. Check that the measured operating time is within the error mentioned below.
Accuracy: Standard, Very and Long-time inverse: IEC 60255-3 class 5
Extremely inverse: IEC 60255-3 class 7.5
⎯ 142 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.8 Thermal overload element THR
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.12.
GRT100
TB1
+
Single-phase
current
-1
-2
A
I
a
−
source
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
Start
Time
counter
Stop
OV
Figure 6.5.12 Testing THR (Model 100s, 200s)
The output signal of testing element is assigned to the monitoring jack A.
The output signal numbers of the elements are as follows:
Element
THR-S
THR-A
Signal No.
83
87
To test easily the thermal overload element, the scheme switch [THMRST] in the "Switch" screen
on the "Test" menu is used.
• Set the scheme switch [THMRST] to "ON".
•
Enter the signal number to observe the operation at the monitoring jack A as shown in Section
6.5.1.
•
Apply a test current and measure the operating time. The magnitude of the test current should
be between 1.2 × I to 10 × I , where I is the current setting.
s
s
s
CAUTION
After the setting of a test current, apply the test current after checking that the THM% has
become 0 on the "Metering" screen.
•
Calculate the theoretical operating time using the characteristic equations shown in Section
2.10.6. Check that the measured operating time is within 5%.
⎯ 143 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.9 Frequency element FRQ
The frequency element is checked on the following items
• Operating frequency
• Undervoltage block
Operating frequency test
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.13.
GRT100
V
V
f
TB1
+
-27
-28
Variable
frequency
source
−
A
Monitoring
jack
TB4
0V
+
−
-A16
-A17
E
DC
power
supply
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.13 Testing Frequency Element (Model 100s, 200s)
The output signal numbers of the FRQ elements are as follows:
Element
Signal number
Remarks
81-1
89
91
90
92
Underfrequency tripping
Overfrequency tripping
Underfrequency alarm
Overfrequency alarm
81-2
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number to observe the FRQ output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply rated voltage and change the magnitude of the frequency applied and measure the
value at which the element operates. Check that the measured value is within ±0.03Hz of
the setting.
Undervoltage block test
• Apply rated voltage and change the magnitude of frequency to operate the element.
• Keep the frequency that the element is operating, and change the magnitude of the voltage
applied from the rated voltage to less than UV setting voltage. And then, check that the
element resets.
⎯ 144 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.1.10 Overexcitation element V/F
The overexcitation element is checked on the following items
• Operating value of definite time tripping and alarm characteristic
• Operating time of inverse time tripping characteristic
The output signal numbers of the V/F elements are as follows:
Element
Signal number
Remarks
V/F
80
81
82
Definite time tripping
Inverse time tripping
Definite time alarm
Operating value test for definite time tripping and alarm
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.14.
GRT100
V
TB1
+
-27
-28
Single-phase
V
voltage
source
−
A
Monitoring
jack
0V
TB4
+
-A16
-A17
DC
power
supply
−
E
+
−
DC
voltmeter
Figure 6.5.14 Operating Value Test of V/F (Model 100s, 200s)
• Set V (rated voltage setting) to 100V.
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number 80 or 82 to observe the V/F output at monitoring jack A and press the
ENTER
key.
• Apply a test voltage at rated frequency and increase the magnitude of the voltage applied
and measure the value at which an alarm signal or a trip signal is output.
Check that the measured values are within 2% of (V setting) × (A setting) for an alarm
signal and (V setting) × (H setting) for a trip signal.
⎯ 145 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Operating time characteristic test
The testing circuit is shown in Figure 6.5.15.
GRT100
V
V
TB1
TB4
Single-phase
voltage
-27
-28
source
A
+
-A16
-A17
Monitoring
jack
DC
power
0V
supply
−
E
Start
Time
counter
Stop
OV
Figure 6.5.15 Operating Time Characteristic Test of V/F (Model 100s, 200s)
The testing procedure is as follows:
• Press 4 (= Logic circuit) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Logic circuit"
screen.
• Enter a signal number 81 to observe the inverse time tripping output at monitoring jack A
ENTER
and press the
key.
Note: Set the swich [Reset] to “Off”→ “On”→ “Off” to initialize a time count. See Section 4.2.7.1.
• Apply a test voltage at rated frequency and measure the operating time. The magnitude of
the test voltage should be between (V setting) × (L setting) and (V setting) × (H setting).
• Calculate the theoretical operating time using the characteristic equations shown in Section
2.11.8 where V is the test voltage. Check that the measured operating time is from +15% to
−10% of the calculated value.
6.5.2 Timer Test
The pick-up delay time of the variable timer can be measured by connecting the monitoring jacks
A and B to a time counter as shown in Figure 6.5.15. Jacks A and B are used to observe the input
signal and output signal of the timer, respectively.
GRT100
TB4
+
−
-A16
DC
power
supply
A
Monitoring
jack
-A17
E
B
0V
Start
Stop
0V
Time
counter
Figure 6.5.16 Testing Variable Timer (Model 100s, 200s)
⎯ 146 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• Press 3 (= Timer) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Timer" screen.
• Enter the number corresponding to the timer to be observed. The timers and assigned
numbers are listed in Appendix C.
END
• Press the
key to display the following screen.
/2 T i mer
P r es s E NT ER t o op er a t .
e
P r es s
to c a nce l .
C AN CE L
ENTER
• Press the
key to start measuring the time. The "TESTING" LED turns on, and
timer is initiated and the following display appears. The input and output signals of the
timer can be observed at monitoring jacks A and B respectively.
Check that the measured time is within ± 10ms of the setting time.
During the test, the following display appears on the LCD and the LEDs above the jacks are
also lit if the input or output signal exists.
/2 T i mer
O pe ra ti n g . . . . . .
P re ss E N D to r es et .
P r es s
to c a nce l .
C AN CE L
END
• Press the
key to reset the input signal to the timer. The "TESTING" LED turns off.
CANCEL
• Press the
key to test other timers. Repeat the above testing.
⎯ 147 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.5.3 Protection Scheme
In the protection scheme tests, a dynamic test set is required to simulate power system pre-fault,
fault and post-fault conditions.
Tripping is observed with the tripping command output relays TRIP-1 to -5.
Check that the indications and recordings are correct.
6.5.4 Metering and Recording
The metering function can be checked while testing the AC input circuit. See Section 6.4.4.
Fault recording can be checked while testing the protection schemes. Open the "Fault records"
screen and check that the descriptions are correct for the applied fault.
Recording events are listed in Table 3.4.1. The top 8 events are external events and others are
internal events. Event recording on the external events can be checked by changing the status of
binary input signals. Change the status in the same way as the binary input circuit test (see Section
6.4.2) and check that the description displayed on the "Event Records" screen is correct.
Note: Whether to record or not can be set for each event. Change the status of the binary input signal
after confirming that the related event is set to record. (The default setting enables all the events
to be recorded.)
Some of the internal events can be checked in the protection scheme tests.
Disturbance recording can be checked while testing the protection schemes. The LCD display
only shows the date and time when a disturbance is recorded. Open the "Disturbance records"
screen and check that the descriptions are correct.
Details can be displayed on the PC. Check that the descriptions on the PC are correct. For details
on how to obtain disturbance records on the PC, see the RSM100 Manual.
⎯ 148 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.6 Conjunctive Tests
6.6.1 On Load Test
With the relay connected to the line which is carrying a load current, it is possible to check the
polarity of the voltage transformer and current transformer and the phase rotation with the
metering displays on the LCD screen.
• Open the following "Metering" screen from the "Status" sub-menu.
/ 2 M e t e r i n g
1 6 / O c t / 1 9 9 7
1 8 : 1 3 3 / 2 0
I a 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I a 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I b 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I b 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I c 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I c 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 1 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 1 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 2 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 2 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 0 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I 0 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I n 1 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ° I n 2 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I a 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I b 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I c 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 1 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 2 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I 0 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I n 3 ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ k A ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
V
∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ k V ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ °
I d a ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d b ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 1 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 2 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d 0 3 ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
I d c ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ ∗ p u
T H M ∗ ∗ ∗ . ∗ %
Frequency
∗ ∗ . ∗ H z
Note: The magnitude of voltage and current can be set in values on the primary side or on the
secondary side by the setting. (The default setting is the primary side.)
Phase angles are expressed taking that of the voltage input as the reference angle.
• Check that the phase rotation is correct.
• Verify the phase relation between voltage and current with a known load current direction.
6.6.2 Tripping Circuit Test
The tripping circuit including the circuit breaker is checked by forcibly operating the output relay
and monitoring the breaker that is tripped. Forcible operation of the output relay is performed on
the "Binary output" screen of the "Test" sub-menu as described in Section 6.4.3.
Tripping circuit
• Set the breaker to be closed.
• Press 2 (= Binary output) on the "Test" sub-menu screen to display the "Binary output" screen.
The LCD displays the output modules mounted.
• Enter 1 to select the IO1 module, then the LCD displays the screen shown below.
⎯ 149 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
/3 B O
IO# 1
IO# 1
IO# 1
(0 = Di s ab le 1 =E na bl e)
1 / 5
T P-1
T P-2
1
1
1
3
T P-
1
IO#
T P-4
0
0
5
IO# 1
T P-
TP-1 to 5 are output relays with one normally open contact. Models 203 and 204 are not provided
with TP-4 and TP-5.
ENTER
• Enter 1 for TP-1 and press the
END
key.
• Press the
key. Then the LCD displays the screen shown below.
/3 B O
K e ep p res s i ng 1 t o oper a t e .
to ca nce l
P r es s
.
C AN CE L
1
• Keep pressing the
key to operate the output relay TP-1 and check that the No. 1 breaker is
tripped.
1
• Release pressing the
key to reset the operation.
• Repeat the above for other output relays TP-2 to TP-5.
⎯ 150 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
6.7 Maintenance
6.7.1 Regular Testing
The relay is almost completely self-supervised. The circuits which cannot be supervised are binary
input and output circuits and human interfaces.
Therefore regular testing can be minimized to checking the unsupervised circuits. The test
procedures are the same as described in Sections 6.4.1, 6.4.2 and 6.4.3.
6.7.2 Failure Tracing and Repair
Failures will be detected by automatic supervision or regular testing.
When a failure is detected by supervision, a remote alarm is issued with the binary output signal of
FAIL and the failure is indicated on the front panel with LED indicators or LCD display. It is also
recorded in the event record.
Failures detected by supervision are traced by checking the "Auto-supervision "screen on the
LCD.
If any messages are shown on the LCD, the failed module or failed external circuits can be located
by referring to Table 6.7.1.
This table shows the relationship between messages displayed on the LCD and the estimated
failure location. Locations marked with (1) have a higher probability than locations marked with
(2).
As shown in the table, some of the messages cannot identify the fault location definitely but
suggest plural possible failure locations. In these cases, the failure location is identified by
replacing the suggested failed modules with spare modules one by one until the "Alarm" LED is
turned off.
The replacement or investigation should be performed first for the module or circuit with higher
probability in the table.
If there is a failure and the LCD is not working such as a screen is frozen or not displayed, the
failure location is either SPM or HMI module.
⎯ 151 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table 6.7.1 LCD Message and Failure Location
Message
Failure location
VCT
SPM
IO1 or
IO8
IO2
IO3
HMI
AC
LAN
PLC,
cable cable/ IEC61850
network
data
Checksum err
ROM data err
ROM-RAM err
SRAM err
CPU err
×
×
×
×
×
Invalid err
NMI err
×
×
BU-RAM err
EEPROM err
A/D err
×
×
×
Sampling err
CT1 err
×
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
CT2 err
CT3 err
DIO err
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
RSM err
× (2)
LCD err
×
DC supply off
RTC err
×
×
×
PCI err
LAN err
×
GOOSE stop
Ping err
× (2)
× (2)
× (1)
×(1)
PLC stop
MAP stop
×
×
No-working of
LCD
× (2)
× (1)
The location marked with (1) has a higher probability than the location marked with (2).
⎯ 152 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
If no message is shown on the LCD, this means that the failure location is either in the DC power
supply circuit or in the microprocessors mounted on the SPM module. Then check the "ALARM"
LED. If it is off, the failure is in the DC power supply circuit. If it is lit, open the relay front panel
and check the LEDs mounted on the SPM module. If the LED is off, the failure is in the DC power
supply circuit. If the LED is lit, the failure is in the microprocessors.
In the former case, check if the correct DC voltage is applied to the relay.
If so, replace the IO1 or IO8 module mounting the DC/DC converter and confirm that the
"ALARM" LED is turned off.
In the latter case, replace the SPM module containing the processors and confirm that the
"ALARM" LED is turned off.
When a failure is detected during regular testing, it will not be difficult to identify the failed
module to be replaced.
Note: When a failure or an abnormality is detected during the regular test, confirm the following
first:
-
-
-
Test circuit connections are correct.
Modules are securely inserted in position.
Correct DC power voltage with correct polarity is applied and connected to the correct
terminals.
-
-
Correct AC inputs are applied and connected to the correct terminals.
Test procedures comply with those stated in the manual.
6.7.3 Replacing Failed Modules
If the failure is identified to be in the relay module and the user has spare modules, the user can
recover the protection by replacing the failed modules.
Repair at the site should be limited to module replacement. Maintenance at the component level is
not recommended.
Check that the replacement module has an identical module name (VCT, SPM, IO1, IO2, etc.) and
hardware type-form as the removed module. Furthermore, the SPM module should have the same
software name.
The module name is indicated on the bottom front of the relay case. The hardware type-form is
indicated on the module in the following format:
Module name
Hardware type-form
G1PC2-††††
G1SP∗-††††
G1IO1-††††
G1IO2-††††
G1IO3-††††
G1IO8-††††
--
VCT
SPM
IO1
IO2
IO3
IO8
HMI
⎯ 153 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
The software name is indicated on the memory device on the module with letters such as
GSPTM1-∗∗∗, etc.
CAUTION
When handling a module, take anti-static measures such as wearing an earthed
wrist band and placing modules on an earthed conductive mat. Otherwise, many
of the electronic components could suffer damage.
CAUTION
After replacing the SPM module, check all of the settings including the data
related to the PLC, IEC103 and IEC61850, etc. are restored the original
settings.
The initial replacement procedure is as follows:
• Switch off the DC power supply.
WARNING
Hazardous voltage may remain in the DC circuit just after switching off the
DC power supply. It takes approximately 30 seconds for the voltage to
discharge.
• Disconnect the trip outputs.
• Short circuit all AC current inputs and disconnect all AC voltage inputs.
• Unscrew the relay front cover.
Replacing the Human Machine Interface (HMI) Module (Front Panel)
• Open the front panel of the relay by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of the
front panel.
• Unplug the ribbon cable on the front panel by pushing the catch outside.
• Remove the two retaining screws and one earthing screw on the relay case side, then detach the
front panel from the relay case.
• Attach the replacement module in the reverse procedure.
Replacing the Transformer (VCT) Module
CAUTION
Before pulling out the transformer module, pull out all other modules. For the
method of pulling out other module, see the section "Replacing other module".
• Open the right-side front panel (HMI module) by unscrewing the two binding screws located
on the left side of the panel.
• Open the left-side front panel by unscrewing the two binding screws located on the right side
of the panel.
• Detach the module holding bar by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of the
bar.
• Unplug the ribbon cable on the SPM module by nipping the catch.
• Remove the metal cover by unscrewing the binding screw located at the top and bottom of the
cover.
• Pull out the module.
• Insert the replacement module in the reverse procedure.
Replacing other modules
• Open the right-side front panel (HMI module) by unscrewing the two binding screws
located on the left side of the panel.
⎯ 154 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• Open the left-side front panel by unscrewing the two binding screws located on the right side
of the panel.
• Detach the module holding bar by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of the
bar.
• Unplug the ribbon cable running among the modules by nipping the catch (in case of black
connector) and by pushing the catch outside (in case of gray connector) on the connector.
• Pull out the module by pulling up or down the top and bottom levers.
• Insert the replacement module in the reverse procedure.
• After replacing the SPM module, input the user setting values again.
For failed module tracing and its replacement, see Appendix Q.
6.7.4 Resumption of Service
After replacing the failed module or repairing failed external circuits, take the following
procedures for the relay to restore the service.
• Switch on the DC power supply and confirm that the "IN SERVICE" green LED is lit and the
"ALARM" red LED is not lit.
Note: Supply DC power after checking that all the modules are in their original positions and the
ribbon cables are plugged in.
• Supply the AC inputs and reconnect the trip outputs.
6.7.5 Storage
The spare relay or module should be stored in a dry and clean room. Based on IEC Standard
60255-6 the storage temperature should be −25°C to +70°C, but the temperature of 0°C to +40°C
is recommended for long-term storage.
⎯ 155 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
7. Putting Relay into Service
The following procedure must be adhered to when putting the relay into service after finishing
commissioning or maintenance tests.
• Check that all external connections are correct.
• Check the setting of all measuring elements, timers, scheme switches, recordings and clock are
correct.
In particular, when settings are changed temporarily for testing, be sure to restore them.
• Clear any unnecessary records on faults, events and disturbances which are recorded during
the tests.
• Press the
key and check that no failure message is displayed on the
VIEW
"Auto-supervision" screen.
• Check that the green "IN SERVICE" LED is lit and no other LEDs are lit on the front panel.
⎯ 156 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix A
Block Diagram
⎯ 157 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Scheme Logic No.1
DIFT
S
R
Q
HOC
DIF
DIFT
(#87)
&
Selection
F/F
≥ 1
≥ 1
switches for
each element
1
1
2f lock
&
(ON)
&
5f lock
+
1
−
(OFF)
RESET
&
TRIP-1
TRIP OUTPUT
+
-
TP1
(ON)
CONTACT No.1
1OC
L/O
t
0
1OC (#150)
1OCI(#151)
2OC (#250)
2OCI(#251)
3OC (#350)
3OCI(#351)
1REF(#187N)
1EF (#150N)
1EFI(#151N)
2REF(#287N)
2EF (#250N)
2EFI(#251N)
3REF(#387N)
3EF (#350N)
3EFI(#351N)
(OFF)
0.00-10.00s
1OCI
2OC
TRIP OUTPUT
TP2
CONTACT No.2
TRIP OUTPUT
t
0
TP3
CONTACT No.3
0.00-10.00s
2OCI
3OC
TRIP OUTPUT
TP4
CONTACT No.4
≥ 1
TRIP OUTPUT
t
0
TP5
CONTACT No.5
0.00-10.00s
Scheme Logic No.2
3OCI
TRIP-2
DIFT
1OC
1OCI
2OC
2OCI
3OC
3OCI
1REF
1REF
1EF
Scheme Logic No.3
TRIP-3
Same as
No.1
circuit
DIFT
t
0
1OC
1OCI
2OC
2OCI
3OC
3OCI
1REF
0.00-10.00s
1EFI
Same as
No.1
circuit
2REF
2EF
Scheme Logic No.4
1EF
TRIP-4
DIFT
1EFI
2REF
2EF
t
0
1OC
1OCI
2OC
2OCI
3OC
3OCI
1REF
0.00-10.00s
2EFI
1EF
Scheme Logic No.5
2EFI
3REF
3EF
Same as
No.1
circuit
TRIP-5
1EFI
2REF
2EF
DIFT
3REF
3EF
1OC
1OCI
2OC
2OCI
3OC
3OCI
1REF
3EFI
2EFI
3REF
3EF
t
0
V/F
THR
FRQ
MT-1
Same as
No.1
circuit
1EF
0.00-10.00s
3EFI
V/F
1EFI
2REF
2EF
3EFI
V/F
THR
FRQ
MT-1
L
V/F
(#59/81)
H
MT-2
MT-3
MT-4
≥ 1
2EFI
3REF
3EF
1EF
t
0
1EFI
2REF
2EF
0.00-10.00s
THR
FRQ
S
THR
(#49)
MT-2
MT-3
MT-4
≥ 1
3EFI
A
2EFI
3REF
3EF
V/F
THR
FRQ
MT-1
t
0
L
H
FRQ
(#81)
0.00-10.00s
≥ 1
3EFI
t
0
V/F
THR
FRQ
MT-1
MT-2
MT-3
MT-4
0.00-10.00s
EXT_MEC.TP1
EXT_MEC.TP2
EXT_MEC.TP3
EXT_MEC.TP4
MT-2
MT-3
MT-4
Ext.Mechanical Trip 1
Ext.Mechanical Trip 2
Ext.Mechanical Trip 3
Ext.Mechanical Trip4
: Binary input/output
: Relay Element
Note: Models 203 and 204 are not provided with TRIP-4 and TRIP-5.
Block Diagram of Transformer Differential Relay GRT100
⎯ 158 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix B
Signal List
⎯ 159 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
0
CONSTANT_0
CONSTANT_1
constant 0
constant 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38 DIF_NBLK-A
39 DIF_NBLK-B
40 DIF_NBLK-C
41 DIFT_HOC-A
42 DIFT_HOC-B
43 DIFT_HOC-C
44 DIFT_DIF-A
45 DIFT_DIF-B
46 DIFT_DIF-C
47 1OC-A
Differential element(2f/5f lock is not included)
ditto
ditto
Differential relay
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
OC relay
48 1OC-B
ditto
ditto
49 1OC-C
50 1OCI-A
Inverse time OC relay
51 1OCI-B
ditto
ditto
OC relay
ditto
ditto
52 1OCI-C
53 2OC-A
54 2OC-B
55 2OC-C
56 2OCI-A
Inverse time OC relay
57 2OCI-B
ditto
ditto
OC relay
ditto
ditto
58 2OCI-C
59 3OC-A
60 3OC-B
61 3OC-C
62 3OCI-A
Inverse time OC relay
63 3OCI-B
ditto
ditto
OC relay
ditto
ditto
64 3OCI-C
65 4OC-A
66 4OC-B
67 4OC-C
68 4OCI-A
Inverse time OC relay
ditto
ditto
69 4OCI-B
70 4OCI-C
⎯ 160 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
71 1REF
72 1EF
73 1EFI
74 2REF
75 2EF
76 2EFI
77 3REF
78 3EF
79 3EFI
80 V/F-H
81 V/F-T
82 V/F-A
83 THR-S
84
Restricted earth fault relay
Earth fault relay
Inverse time earth fault relay
Restricted earth fault relay
Earth fault relay
Inverse time earth fault relay
Restricted earth fault relay
Earth fault relay
Inverse time earth fault relay
Overexcitation relay
ditto
ditto
Thermal overload relay
85
86
87 THR-A
88
Thermal overload relay
89 FRQ-L1
90 FRQ-L2
91 FRQ-H1
92 FRQ-H2
93 CTF
Frequency relay
ditto
ditto
ditto
CT failure detection
94 CTF_ALARM
95 2F-A
96 2F-B
97 2F-C
98 5F-A
99 5F-B
100 5F-C
101 CT_SAT-A
102 CT_SAT-B
103 CT_SAT-C
104
CT failure alarm
2nd harmonic inrush current detection
ditto
ditto
fifth harmonic components detection
ditto
ditto
CT saturation
ditto
ditto
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119 FRQBLK
120
UV block signal for FRQ
121 DIF_TRIP
122 2F_LOCK
123 5F_LOCK
124 DIF-T1
125 DIF-T2
126 DIF-T3
127 DIF-T4
128 DIF-T5
129 T1OC
130 1OC-1
131 1OC-2
132 1OC-3
133 1OC-4
134 1OC-5
135 1OCI-1
136 1OCI-2
137 1OCI-3
138 1OCI-4
139 1OCI-5
140 T2OC
DIF relay trip
2F detect
5F detect
DIF relay trip 1
DIF relay trip 2
DIF relay trip 3
DIF relay trip 4
DIF relay trip 5
1OC relay timer
1OC relay trip 1
1OC relay trip 2
1OC relay trip 3
1OC relay trip 4
1OC relay trip 5
1OCI relay trip 1
1OCI relay trip 2
1OCI relay trip 3
1OCI relay trip 4
1OCI relay trip 5
2OC relay timer
⎯ 161 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
141 2OC-1
142 2OC-2
143 2OC-3
144 2OC-4
145 2OC-5
146 2OCI-1
147 2OCI-2
148 2OCI-3
149 2OCI-4
150 2OCI-5
151 T3OC
152 3OC-1
153 3OC-2
154 3OC-3
155 3OC-4
156 3OC-5
157 3OCI-1
158 3OCI-2
159 3OCI-3
160 3OCI-4
161 3OCI-5
162 T4OC
163 4OC-1
164 4OC-2
165 4OC-3
166 4OC-4
167 4OC-5
168 4OCI-1
169 4OCI-2
170 4OCI-3
171 4OCI-4
172 4OCI-5
173 T1REF
174 T1EF
175 1REF-1
176 1REF-2
177 1REF-3
178 1REF-4
179 1REF-5
180 1EF-1
181 1EF-2
182 1EF-3
183 1EF-4
184 1EF-5
185 1EFI-1
186 1EFI-2
187 1EFI-3
188 1EFI-4
189 1EFI-5
190 T2REF
191 T2EF
2OC relay trip 1
2OC relay trip 2
2OC relay trip 3
2OC relay trip 4
2OC relay trip 5
2OCI relay trip 1
2OCI relay trip 2
2OCI relay trip 3
2OCI relay trip 4
2OCI relay trip 5
3OC relay timer
3OC relay trip 1
3OC relay trip 2
3OC relay trip 3
3OC relay trip 4
3OC relay trip 5
3OCI relay trip 1
3OCI relay trip 2
3OCI relay trip 3
3OCI relay trip 4
3OCI relay trip 5
4OC relay timer
4OC relay trip 1
4OC relay trip 2
4OC relay trip 3
4OC relay trip 4
4OC relay trip 5
4OCI relay trip 1
4OCI relay trip 2
4OCI relay trip 3
4OCI relay trip 4
4OCI relay trip 5
1REF relay timer
1EF relay timer
1REF relay trip 1
1REF relay trip 2
1REF relay trip 3
1REF relay trip 4
1REF relay trip 5
1EF relay trip 1
1EF relay trip 2
1EF relay trip 3
1EF relay trip 4
1EF relay trip 5
1EFI relay trip 1
1EFI relay trip 2
1EFI relay trip 3
1EFI relay trip 4
1EFI relay trip 5
2REF relay timer
2EF relay timer
2REF relay trip 1
2REF relay trip 2
2REF relay trip 3
2REF relay trip 4
2REF relay trip 5
2EF relay trip 1
2EF relay trip 2
2EF relay trip 3
2EF relay trip 4
2EF relay trip 5
2EFI relay trip 1
2EFI relay trip 2
2EFI relay trip 3
2EFI relay trip 4
2EFI relay trip 5
3REF relay timer
3EF relay timer
3REF relay trip 1
3REF relay trip 2
192 2REF-1
193 2REF-2
194 2REF-3
195 2REF-4
196 2REF-5
197 2EF-1
198 2EF-2
199 2EF-3
200 2EF-4
201 2EF-5
202 2EFI-1
203 2EFI-2
204 2EFI-3
205 2EFI-4
206 2EFI-5
207 T3REF
208 T3EF
209 3REF-1
210 3REF-2
⎯ 162 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
211 3REF-3
212 3REF-4
213 3REF-5
214 3EF-1
215 3EF-2
216 3EF-3
217 3EF-4
218 3EF-5
219 3EFI-1
220 3EFI-2
221 3EFI-3
222 3EFI-4
223 3EFI-5
224 DIF-T
225 1OCI
226 2OCI
227 3OCI
228 4OCI
229 V/F_TRIP
230 FRQ
231
3REF relay trip 3
3REF relay trip 4
3REF relay trip 5
3EF relay trip 1
3EF relay trip 2
3EF relay trip 3
3EF relay trip 4
3EF relay trip 5
3EFI relay trip 1
3EFI relay trip 2
3EFI relay trip 3
3EFI relay trip 4
3EFI relay trip 5
DIFT relay trip
1OCI relay trip
2OCI relay trip
3OCI relay trip
4OCI relay trip
V/F trip
FRQ trip
232
233
234
235 TV/F-H
236 TV/F-A
237 V/F-1
238 V/F-2
239 V/F-3
240 V/F-4
241 V/F-5
V/F-H relay timer
V/F-A relay timer
V/F relay trip 1
V/F relay trip 2
V/F relay trip 3
V/F relay trip 4
V/F relay trip 5
V/F relay alarm
THR relay trip 1
THR relay trip 2
THR relay trip 3
THR relay trip 4
THR relay trip 5
THR relay alarm
FRQ-L relay timer
FRQ-H relay timer
FRQ-A relay timer
FRQ relay trip 1
FRQ relay trip 2
FRQ relay trip 3
FRQ relay trip 4
FRQ relay trip 5
FRQ relay alarm
Mechanical trip 1
ditto
242 V/F-ALARM
243 THR-1
244 THR-2
245 THR-3
246 THR-4
247 THR-5
248 THR-ALARM
249 TFRQ-L
250 TFRQ-H
251 TFRQ-A
252 FRQ-1
253 FRQ-2
254 FRQ-3
255 FRQ-4
256 FRQ-5
257 FRQ-A
258 MEC.TRIP1-1
259 MEC.TRIP1-2
260 MEC.TRIP1-3
261 MEC.TRIP1-4
262 MEC.TRIP1-5
263 MEC.TRIP2-1
264 MEC.TRIP2-2
265 MEC.TRIP2-3
266 MEC.TRIP2-4
267 MEC.TRIP2-5
268 MEC.TRIP3-1
269 MEC.TRIP3-2
270 MEC.TRIP3-3
271 MEC.TRIP3-4
272 MEC.TRIP3-5
273 MEC.TRIP4-1
274 MEC.TRIP4-2
275 MEC.TRIP4-3
276 MEC.TRIP4-4
277 MEC.TRIP4-5
278 WIND.1_TP-1
279 WIND.2_TP-1
280 WIND.3_TP-1
ditto
ditto
ditto
Mechanical trip 2
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Mechanical trip 3
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Mechanical trip 4
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Element for trip 1
ditto
ditto
⎯ 163 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
281 WIND.4_TP-1
282 MEC.TRIP-1
283 ELEMENT_OR-1
284 TRIP-1
285 WIND.1_TP-2
286 WIND.2_TP-2
287 WIND.3_TP-2
288 WIND.4_TP-2
289 MEC.TRIP-2
290 ELEMENT_OR-2
291 TRIP-2
292 WIND.1_TP-3
293 WIND.2_TP-3
294 WIND.3_TP-3
295 WIND.4_TP-3
296 MEC.TRIP-3
297 ELEMENT_OR-3
298 TRIP-3
299 WIND.1_TP-4
300 WIND.2_TP-4
301 WIND.3_TP-4
302 WIND.4_TP-4
303 MEC.TRIP-4
304 ELEMENT_OR-4
305 TRIP-4
ditto
ditto
ditto
Trip O/P-1
Element for trip 2
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Trip O/P-2
Element for trip 3
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Trip O/P-3
Element for trip 4
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Trip O/P-4
306 WIND.1_TP-5
307 WIND.2_TP-5
308 WIND.3_TP-5
309 WIND.4_TP-5
310 MEC.TRIP-5
311 ELEMENT_OR-5
312 TRIP-5
Element for trip 5
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Trip O/P-5
313 TRIP
Trip signal shot
314 TRIP-DETOR
315 TP1
Trip O/P OR
Trip command without off-delay timer
Trip command without off-delay timer
Trip command without off-delay timer
Trip command without off-delay timer
Trip command without off-delay timer
316 TP2
317 TP3
318 TP4
319 TP5
320
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
330 DIFT-DIF_TP
331 DIFT-HOC_TP
332 1REF_TRIP
333 2REF_TRIP
334 3REF_TRIP
335 1OC_TRIP
336 2OC_TRIP
337 3OC_TRIP
338 4OC_TRIP
339 1OCI_TRIP
340 2OCI_TRIP
341 3OCI_TRIP
342 4OCI_TRIP
343 1EF_TRIP
344 2EF_TRIP
345 3EF_TRIP
346 1EFI_TRIP
347 2EFI_TRIP
348 3EFI_TRIP
349 FRQ_TRIP
350 V/F_TP
DIFT-DIF trip signal
DIFT-HOC trip signal
1REF trip signal
2REF trip signal
3REF trip signal
1OC trip signal
2OC trip signal
3OC trip signal
4OC trip signal
1OCI trip signal
2OCI trip signal
3OCI trip signal
4OCI trip signal
1EF trip signal
2EF trip signal
3EF trip signal
1EFI trip signal
2EFI trip signal
3EFI trip signal
FRQ trip signal
V/F trip signal
⎯ 164 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
351 THR_TRIP
352 DIFT_TRIP
Thermal trip signal
DIFT trip signal
353 FRQ-UF_TRIP
Under-FRQ trip signal
Over-FRQ trip signal
Under-FRQ alarm signal
Over-FRQ alarm signal
Mechanical trip 1
354 FRQ-OF_TRIP
355 FRQ-UF_ALARM
356 FRQ-OF_ALARM
357 MEC.TRIP1
358 MEC.TRIP2
Mechanical trip 2
359 MEC.TRIP3
Mechanical trip 3
360 MEC.TRIP4
Mechanical trip 4
361 MEC.TRIP
Mechanical trip
362 V/F-L_TRIP
V/F low level trip signal
V/F high level trip signal
363 V/F-H_TRIP
364
365
366
367
368
369
370 1OC
371 2OC
372 3OC
373 4OC
374 DIFT_HOC
375
OC relay
ditto
ditto
ditto
Differential relay
376
377
378
379
380
381
382
383
384
385
386
387
388
389
390
391
392
393
394
395
396
397
398
399
400
401
402
403
404
405
406
407
408
409
410
411
412
413
414
:
:
:
508
509
510
⎯ 165 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
511
512
513 BI1_COMMAND
Binary input signal BI1
Binary input signal BI2
Binary input signal BI3
Binary input signal BI4
Binary input signal BI5
Binary input signal BI6
Binary input signal BI7
Binary input signal BI8
Binary input signal BI9
Binary input signal BI10
Binary input signal BI11
Binary input signal BI12
Binary input signal BI13
Binary input signal BI14
Binary input signal BI15
Binary input signal BI16
514 BI2_COMMAND
515 BI3_COMMAND
516 BI4_COMMAND
517 BI5_COMMAND
518 BI6_COMMAND
519 BI7_COMMAND
520 BI8_COMMAND
521 BI9_COMMAND
522 BI10_COMMAND
523 BI11_COMMAND
524 BI12_COMMAND
525 BI13_COMMAND
526 BI14_COMMAND
527 BI15_COMMAND
528 BI16_COMMAND
529
530
531
532
533
534
535
536
537
538
539
540
541
542
543
544
545
546
547
548
549
550
551
552
553
554
555
556
557
558
559
560
561
562
563
564
565
566
567
568
569
570
571
572
573
574
575
:
:
1238
1239
1240
⎯ 166 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1241 IEC_MDBLK
1242 IEC_TESTMODE
1243 GROUP1_ACTIVE
1244 GROUP2_ACTIVE
1245 GROUP3_ACTIVE
1246 GROUP4_ACTIVE
1247 GROUP5_ACTIVE
1248 GROUP6_ACTIVE
1249 GROUP7_ACTIVE
1250 GROUP8_ACTIVE
1251 RLY_FAIL
1252 RLY_OP_BLK
1253 A.M.F._OFF
1254
monitor direction blocked
IEC60870-5-103 testmode
group1 active
group2 active
group3 active
group4 active
group5 active
group6 active
group7 active
group8 active
RELAY FAILURE
RELAY OUTPUT BLOCK
SV BLOCK
1255
1256
1257
1258 RELAY_FAIL-A
1259
RELAY FAILURE (only alarm)
Trip signal hold
1260
1261 TRIP-H
1262
1263 CT1_ERR_UF
1264 CT2_ERR_UF
1265 CT3_ERR_UF
1266 CT4_ERR_UF
1267 CT1_ERR
1268 CT2_ERR
1269 CT3_ERR
1270 CT4_ERR
1271 CT_ERR
1272
CT error(unfiltered)
ditto
ditto
ditto
CT failure
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279 GEN_PICKUP
1280 GEN_TRIP
1281
General start/pick-up
General trip
1282
1283
1284 BI1_COM_UF
1285 BI2_COM_UF
1286 BI3_COM_UF
1287 BI4_COM_UF
1288 BI5_COM_UF
1289 BI6_COM_UF
1290 BI7_COM_UF
1291 BI8_COM_UF
1292 BI9_COM_UF
1293 BI10_COM_UF
1294 BI11_COM_UF
1295 BI12_COM_UF
1296 BI13_COM_UF
1297 BI14_COM_UF
1298 BI15_COM_UF
1299 BI16_COM_UF
1300
Binary input signal BI1 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI2 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI3 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI4 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI5 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI6 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI7 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI8 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI9 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI10 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI11 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI12 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI13 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI14 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI15 (unfiltered)
Binary input signal BI16 (unfiltered)
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
⎯ 167 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328 GOOSE_IN_Q1
1329 GOOSE_IN_Q2
1330 GOOSE_IN_Q3
1331 GOOSE_IN_Q4
1332 GOOSE_IN_Q5
1333 GOOSE_IN_Q6
1334 GOOSE_IN_Q7
1335 GOOSE_IN_Q8
1336 GOOSE_IN_Q9
1337 GOOSE_IN_Q10
1338 GOOSE_IN_Q11
1339 GOOSE_IN_Q12
1340 GOOSE_IN_Q13
1341 GOOSE_IN_Q14
1342 GOOSE_IN_Q15
1343 GOOSE_IN_Q16
1344 GOOSE_IN_Q17
1345 GOOSE_IN_Q18
1346 GOOSE_IN_Q19
1347 GOOSE_IN_Q20
1348 GOOSE_IN_Q21
1349 GOOSE_IN_Q22
1350 GOOSE_IN_Q23
1351 GOOSE_IN_Q24
1352 GOOSE_IN_Q25
1353 GOOSE_IN_Q26
1354 GOOSE_IN_Q27
1355 GOOSE_IN_Q28
1356 GOOSE_IN_Q29
1357 GOOSE_IN_Q30
1358 GOOSE_IN_Q31
1359 GOOSE_IN_Q32
1360 GOOSE_IN_1
1361 GOOSE_IN_2
1362 GOOSE_IN_3
1363 GOOSE_IN_4
1364 GOOSE_IN_5
1365 GOOSE_IN_6
1366 GOOSE_IN_7
1367 GOOSE_IN_8
1368 GOOSE_IN_9
1369 GOOSE_IN_10
1370 GOOSE_IN_11
1371 GOOSE_IN_12
1372 GOOSE_IN_13
1373 GOOSE_IN_14
1374 GOOSE_IN_15
1375 GOOSE_IN_16
1376 GOOSE_IN_17
1377 GOOSE_IN_18
1378 GOOSE_IN_19
1379 GOOSE_IN_20
1380 GOOSE_IN_21
Goose Input Quality #1
Goose Input Quality #2
Goose Input Quality #3
Goose Input Quality #4
Goose Input Quality #5
Goose Input Quality #6
Goose Input Quality #7
Goose Input Quality #8
Goose Input Quality #9
Goose Input Quality #10
Goose Input Quality #11
Goose Input Quality #12
Goose Input Quality #13
Goose Input Quality #14
Goose Input Quality #15
Goose Input Quality #16
Goose Input Quality #17
Goose Input Quality #18
Goose Input Quality #19
Goose Input Quality #20
Goose Input Quality #21
Goose Input Quality #22
Goose Input Quality #23
Goose Input Quality #24
Goose Input Quality #25
Goose Input Quality #26
Goose Input Quality #27
Goose Input Quality #28
Goose Input Quality #29
Goose Input Quality #30
Goose Input Quality #31
Goose Input Quality #32
Goose Input #1
Goose Input #2
Goose Input #3
Goose Input #4
Goose Input #5
Goose Input #6
Goose Input #7
Goose Input #8
Goose Input #9
Goose Input #10
Goose Input #11
Goose Input #12
Goose Input #13
Goose Input #14
Goose Input #15
Goose Input #16
Goose Input #17
Goose Input #18
Goose Input #19
Goose Input #20
Goose Input #21
⎯ 168 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1381 GOOSE_IN_22
1382 GOOSE_IN_23
1383 GOOSE_IN_24
1384 GOOSE_IN_25
1385 GOOSE_IN_26
1386 GOOSE_IN_27
1387 GOOSE_IN_28
1388 GOOSE_IN_29
1389 GOOSE_IN_30
1390 GOOSE_IN_31
1391 GOOSE_IN_32
1392
Goose Input #22
Goose Input #23
Goose Input #24
Goose Input #25
Goose Input #26
Goose Input #27
Goose Input #28
Goose Input #29
Goose Input #30
Goose Input #31
Goose Input #32
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401 LOCAL_OP_ACT
1402 REMOTE_OP_ACT
1403 NORM_LED_ON
1404 ALM_LED_ON
1405 TRIP_LED_ON
1406 TEST_LED_ON
1407
local operation active
remote operation active
IN-SERVICE LED ON
ALARM LED ON
TRIP LED ON
TEST LED ON
1408
1409 LED_RESET
1410
1411
1412
TRIP LED RESET
1413 PROT_COM_ON
1414 PRG_LED1_ON
1415 PRG_LED2_ON
1416 PRG_LED3_ON
1417 PRG_LED4_ON
1418
IEC103 communication command
PROGRAMMABLE LED1 ON
PROGRAMMABLE LED2 ON
PROGRAMMABLE LED3 ON
PROGRAMMABLE LED4 ON
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434 F.Record_DONE
1435 F.Record_CLR
1436 E.Record_CLR
1437 D.Record_CLR
1438 Data_Lost
1439
fault record sotred
Fault record clear
Event record clear
Disturbance record clear
Data clear by BU-RAM memory monitoring error
1440
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445 PLC_data_CHG
1446 IEC103_data_CHG
1447 IEC850_data_CHG
1448 Sys.set_change
1449 Rly.set_change
1450 Grp.set_change
PLC data change
IEC-103 data change
IEC-850 data change
System setting change
Relay setting change
Group setting change
⎯ 169 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456 KEY-VIEW
VIEW key status (1:pressed)
RESET key status (2:pressed)
ENTER key status (3:pressed)
END key status (4:pressed)
CANCEL key status (5:pressed)
1457 KEY-RESET
1458 KEY-ENTER
1459 KEY-END
1460 KEY-CANCEL
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465 DC_supply_err
1466 RTC_err
1467 PCI_err
1468 GOOSE_stop
1469 Ping_err
1470 PLC_err
1471 61850_err
1472 SUM_err
1473 ROM_RAM_err
1474 SRAM_err
1475 BU_RAM_err
1476
DC supply error
RTC stopped
PCI bus error
GOOSE stopped
Ping no anwer
PLC stopeed
61850 stopped
Program ROM checksum error
Rom - Ram mismatch error
SRAM memory monitoring error
BU-RAM memory monitoring error
1477 EEPROM_err
1478
EEPROM memory monitoring error
1479 A/D_err
1480 CPU_err
1481 Invalid
1482 NMI
1483 Sampling_err
1484 DIO_err
1485 LAN_err
1486 LCD_err
1487 ROM_data_err
1488
A/D accuracy checking error
Program error
Invalid error
NMI
Sampling error
DIO card connection error
LAN error
LCD panel connection error
8M Romdata error
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
:
:
1533
1534
1535
⎯ 170 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1536 EXT_MEC.TP1
1537 EXT_MEC.TP2
1538 EXT_MEC.TP3
1539 EXT_MEC.TP4
1540 IND.RESET
1541
External mechanical trip commnad 1
External mechanical trip commnad 2
External mechanical trip commnad 3
External mechanical trip commnad 4
Indication reset command
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552 EVENT1
1553 EVENT2
1554 EVENT3
1555
External event command 1
External event command 2
External event command 3
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568 PROT_BLOCK
1569 DIF_BLOCK
1570 1REF_BLOCK
1571 1OC_BLOCK
1572 1OCI_BLOCK
1573 1EF_BLOCK
1574 1EFI_BLOCK
1575 2REF_BLOCK
1576 2OC_BLOCK
1577 2OCI_BLOCK
1578 2EF_BLOCK
1579 2EFI_BLOCK
1580 3REF_BLOCK
1581 3OC_BLOCK
1582 3OCI_BLOCK
1583 3EF_BLOCK
1584 3EFI_BLOCK
1585 4OC_BLOCK
1586 4OCI_BLOCK
1587 FRQ_BLOCK
1588 FRQ-A_BLOCK
1589 V/F_BLOCK
1590 V/F-A_BLOCK
1591 THR_BLOCK
1592 THR-A_BLOCK
1593 MEC.TP1_BLOCK
1594 MEC.TP2_BLOCK
1595 MEC.TP3_BLOCK
1596 MEC.TP4_BLOCK
1597
Protection block command
DIF trip block command
1REF trip block command
1OC trip block command
1OCI trip block command
1EF trip block command
1EFI trip block command
2REF trip block command
2OC trip block command
2OCI trip block command
2EF trip block command
2EFI trip block command
3REF trip block command
3OC trip block command
3OCI trip block command
3EF trip block command
3EFI trip block command
4OC trip block command
4OCI trip block command
FRQ trip block command
FRQ-A trip block command
V/F trip block command
V/F-A trip block command
THR trip block command
THR-A trip block command
MEC.TP1 trip block command
MEC.TP2 trip block command
MEC.TP3 trip block command
MEC.TP4 trip block command
1598
1599
1600 TP1_DELAY
1601 TP2_DELAY
1602 TP3_DELAY
1603 TP4_DELAY
1604 TP5_DELAY
1605
Trip command off-delay timer setting
Trip command off-delay timer setting
Trip command off-delay timer setting
Trip command off-delay timer setting
Trip command off-delay timer setting
⎯ 171 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616 DIF-A_BLOCK
1617 DIF-B_BLOCK
1618 DIF-C_BLOCK
1619
DIF-A trip blocking command
DIF-B trip blocking command
DIF-C trip blocking command
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
:
:
1788
1789
1790
⎯ 172 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
1791
1792 IO#1-TP1
1793 IO#1-TP2
1794 IO#1-TP3
1795 IO#1-TP4
1796 IO#1-TP5
1797
Binary output signal of TP1
Binary output signal of TP2
Binary output signal of TP3
Binary output signal of TP4
Binary output signal of TP5
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
:
:
2618
2619
2620
⎯ 173 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
2621
2622
2623
2624 F.RECORD1
Fault record stored command 1
Fault record stored command 2
Fault record stored command 3
Fault record stored command 4
2625 F.RECORD2
2626 F.RECORD3
2627 F.RECORD4
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632 D.RECORD1
Disturbance record stored command 1
Disturbance record stored command 2
Disturbance record stored command 3
Disturbance record stored command 4
2633 D.RECORD2
2634 D.RECORD3
2635 D.RECORD4
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640 SET.GROUP1
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group1)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group2)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group3)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group4)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group5)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group6)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group7)
Active setting group changed commamd (Change to group8)
2641 SET.GROUP2
2642 SET.GROUP3
2643 SET.GROUP4
2644 SET.GROUP5
2645 SET.GROUP6
2646 SET.GROUP7
2647 SET.GROUP8
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656 CON_TPMD1
User configurable trip mode in fault record
2657 CON_TPMD2
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
2658 CON_TPMD3
2659 CON_TPMD4
2660 CON_TPMD5
2661 CON_TPMD6
2662 CON_TPMD7
2663 CON_TPMD8
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686 PROT_COM_RECV
Protection inactivate command received
TRIP LED RESET command received
2687
2688 TPLED_RST_RCV
:
2810
⎯ 174 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
2816 TEMP001
2817 TEMP002
2818 TEMP003
2819 TEMP004
2820 TEMP005
2821 TEMP006
2822 TEMP007
2823 TEMP008
2824 TEMP009
2825 TEMP010
2826 TEMP011
2827 TEMP012
2828 TEMP013
2829 TEMP014
2830 TEMP015
2831 TEMP016
2832 TEMP017
2833 TEMP018
2834 TEMP019
2835 TEMP020
2836 TEMP021
2837 TEMP022
2838 TEMP023
2839 TEMP024
2840 TEMP025
2841 TEMP026
2842 TEMP027
2843 TEMP028
2844 TEMP029
2845 TEMP030
2846 TEMP031
2847 TEMP032
2848 TEMP033
2849 TEMP034
2850 TEMP035
2851 TEMP036
2852 TEMP037
2853 TEMP038
2854 TEMP039
2855 TEMP040
2856 TEMP041
2857 TEMP042
2858 TEMP043
2859 TEMP044
2860 TEMP045
2861 TEMP046
2862 TEMP047
2863 TEMP048
2864 TEMP049
2865 TEMP050
2866 TEMP051
2867 TEMP052
2868 TEMP053
2869 TEMP054
2870 TEMP055
2871 TEMP056
2872 TEMP057
2873 TEMP058
2874 TEMP059
2875 TEMP060
2876 TEMP061
2877 TEMP062
2878 TEMP063
2879 TEMP064
2880 TEMP065
⎯ 175 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
2881 TEMP066
2882 TEMP067
2883 TEMP068
2884 TEMP069
2885 TEMP070
2886 TEMP071
2887 TEMP072
2888 TEMP073
2889 TEMP074
2890 TEMP075
2891 TEMP076
2892 TEMP077
2893 TEMP078
2894 TEMP079
2895 TEMP080
2896 TEMP081
2897 TEMP082
2898 TEMP083
2899 TEMP084
2900 TEMP085
2901 TEMP086
2902 TEMP087
2903 TEMP088
2904 TEMP089
2905 TEMP090
2906 TEMP091
2907 TEMP092
2908 TEMP093
2909 TEMP094
2910 TEMP095
2911 TEMP096
2912 TEMP097
2913 TEMP098
2914 TEMP099
2915 TEMP100
2916 TEMP101
2917 TEMP102
2918 TEMP103
2919 TEMP104
2920 TEMP105
2921 TEMP106
2922 TEMP107
2923 TEMP108
2924 TEMP109
2925 TEMP110
2926 TEMP111
2927 TEMP112
2928 TEMP113
2929 TEMP114
2930 TEMP115
2931 TEMP116
2932 TEMP117
2933 TEMP118
2934 TEMP119
2935 TEMP120
2936 TEMP121
2937 TEMP122
2938 TEMP123
2939 TEMP124
2940 TEMP125
2941 TEMP126
2942 TEMP127
2943 TEMP128
2944 TEMP129
2945 TEMP130
2946 TEMP131
2947 TEMP132
2948 TEMP133
2949 TEMP134
2950 TEMP135
⎯ 176 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
2951 TEMP136
2952 TEMP137
2953 TEMP138
2954 TEMP139
2955 TEMP140
2956 TEMP141
2957 TEMP142
2958 TEMP143
2959 TEMP144
2960 TEMP145
2961 TEMP146
2962 TEMP147
2963 TEMP148
2964 TEMP149
2965 TEMP150
2966 TEMP151
2967 TEMP152
2968 TEMP153
2969 TEMP154
2970 TEMP155
2971 TEMP156
2972 TEMP157
2973 TEMP158
2974 TEMP159
2975 TEMP160
2976 TEMP161
2977 TEMP162
2978 TEMP163
2979 TEMP164
2980 TEMP165
2981 TEMP166
2982 TEMP167
2983 TEMP168
2984 TEMP169
2985 TEMP170
2986 TEMP171
2987 TEMP172
2988 TEMP173
2989 TEMP174
2990 TEMP175
2991 TEMP176
2992 TEMP177
2993 TEMP178
2994 TEMP179
2995 TEMP180
2996 TEMP181
2997 TEMP182
2998 TEMP183
2999 TEMP184
3000 TEMP185
3001 TEMP186
3002 TEMP187
3003 TEMP188
3004 TEMP189
3005 TEMP190
3006 TEMP191
3007 TEMP192
3008 TEMP193
3009 TEMP194
3010 TEMP195
3011 TEMP196
3012 TEMP197
3013 TEMP198
3014 TEMP199
3015 TEMP200
3016 TEMP201
3017 TEMP202
3018 TEMP203
3019 TEMP204
3020 TEMP205
⎯ 177 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal list
No.
Signal Name
Contents
3021 TEMP206
3022 TEMP207
3023 TEMP208
3024 TEMP209
3025 TEMP210
3026 TEMP211
3027 TEMP212
3028 TEMP213
3029 TEMP214
3030 TEMP215
3031 TEMP216
3032 TEMP217
3033 TEMP218
3034 TEMP219
3035 TEMP220
3036 TEMP221
3037 TEMP222
3038 TEMP223
3039 TEMP224
3040 TEMP225
3041 TEMP226
3042 TEMP227
3043 TEMP228
3044 TEMP229
3045 TEMP230
3046 TEMP231
3047 TEMP232
3048 TEMP233
3049 TEMP234
3050 TEMP235
3051 TEMP236
3052 TEMP237
3053 TEMP238
3054 TEMP239
3055 TEMP240
3056 TEMP241
3057 TEMP242
3058 TEMP243
3059 TEMP244
3060 TEMP245
3061 TEMP246
3062 TEMP247
3063 TEMP248
3064 TEMP249
3065 TEMP250
3066 TEMP251
3067 TEMP252
3068 TEMP253
3069 TEMP254
3070 TEMP255
3071 TEMP256
⎯ 178 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix C
Variable Timer List
⎯ 179 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Variable Timer List
Timer
Timer No.
Contents
T1OC
T2OC
T3OC
(T4OC)
T1REF
T1EF
1
1OC TRIP TIMER
2OC TRIP TIMER
3OC TRIP TIMER
(4OC TRIP TIMER)
1REF TRIP TIMER
1EF TRIP TIMER
2REF TRIP TIMER
2EF TRIP TIMER
3REF TRIP TIMER
3EF TRIP TIMER
V/F-H TRIP TIMER
V/F-A ALARM TIMER
FRQ-L TRIP TIMER
FRQ-H TRIP TIMER
FRQ-A ALARM TIMER
2
3
4
5
6
T2REF
T2EF
7
8
T3REF
T3EF
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
TVFH
TVFA
TFRQL
TFRQH
TFRQA
⎯ 180 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix D
Binary Output Default Setting List
⎯ 181 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Binary Output Default Setting List
Relay
Model
Module
Name
BO No.
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Logic
Signal No.
Timer
(OR: 1, AND:
2)
(OFF: 0, ON: 1)
GRT100
-101
IO2
IO2
IO3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
DIFT
TRIP First
284
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP Second
291
DIFT relay operating
224
1OC, 1OCI
2OC, 2OCI
1REF, 1EF, 1EFI
2REF, 2EF, 2EFI
FRQ
1OC or 1OCI relay operating
2OC or 2OCI relay operating
1REF, 1EF or 1EFI relay operating
2REF, 2EF or 2EFI relay operating
FRQ relay operating
129, 225
140, 226
173, 174, 73
190, 191, 76
230
V/F
V/F-L, H relay operating
229
V/F-A
V/F-A relay operating
242
THR
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
83
248
THR-A
EXT_MEC.TP1, 2, 3, 4
External mechanical relay trip
1536, 1537, 1538, 1539
GRT100
-102
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
DIFT
TRIP First
284
291
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP Second
DIFT relay operating
1OC or 1OCI relay operating
2OC or 2OCI relay operating
1REF relay operating
2REF relay operating
1EF or 1EFI relay operating
2EF or 2EFI relay operating
FRQ relay operating
V/F-T relay operating
V/F-H relay operating
V/F-A relay operating
224
1OC, 1OCI
2OC, 2OCI
1REF
129, 225
140, 226
173
2REF
190
1EF, 1EFI
2EF, 2EFI
FRQ
174, 73
191, 76
230
V/F-T
81
V/F-H
235
V/F-A
242
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
THR
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
TRIP First
83
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
THR-A
248
TRIP-1
284
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
291
TRIP-1
TRIP First
284
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
291
EXT_MEC. TP1
EXT_MEC. TP2
EXT_MEC. TP3
EXT_MEC. TP4
External mechanical relay trip 1
External mechanical relay trip 2
External mechanical relay trip 3
External mechanical relay trip 4
1536
1537
1538
1539
⎯ 182 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Relay
Model
Module
Name
BO No.
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Logic
Signal No.
Timer
(OR: 1, AND:
2)
(OFF: 0, ON: 1)
GRT100
-201
IO2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
TRIP-1
TRIP First
284
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
TRIP Third
291
TRIP-3
298
224
DIFT
DIFT relay operating
1OC, 1OCI, 1REF, 1EF,
1OC, 1OCI, 1REF, 1EF or 1EFI relay
operating
129, 225, 173, 174, 73
1EFI
BO6
BO7
2OC, 2OCI, 2REF, 2EF,
2OC, 2OCI, 2REF, 2EF or 2EFI relay
operating
140, 226, 190, 191, 76
151, 227, 207, 208, 79
1
1
1
1
2EFI
3OC, 3OCI, 3REF, 3EF,
3OC, 3OCI, 3REF, 3EF or 3EFI relay
operating
3EFI
BO8
FRQ
FRQ relay operating
230
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
BO9
V/F
V/F-L, H relay operating
V/F-A relay operating
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
External mechanical relay trip
229
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
V/F-A
242
THR
83
248
THR-A
EXT_MEC. TP1, 2, 3, 4
1536, 1537, 1538, 1539
GRT100
-202
IO2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TRIP-1
TRIP First
284
291
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
TRIP-3
TRIP Third
298
DIFT
DIFT relay operating
1OC or 1OCI relay operating
2OC or 2OCI relay operating
3OC or 3OCI relay operating
1REF relay operating
2REF relay operating
3REF relay operating
1EF or 1EFI relay operating
2EF or 2EFI relay operating
3EF or 3EFI relay operating
224
1OC, 1OCI
2OC, 2OCI
3OC, 3OCI
1REF
129, 225
140, 226
151, 227
173
2REF
190
3REF
207
1EF, 1EFI
2EF, 2EFI
3EF, 2EFI
174, 73
191, 76
208, 79
IO3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
FRQ
FRQ relay operating
230
81
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
V/F-T
V/F-T relay operating
V/F-H
V/F-H relay operating
235
242
83
V/F-A
V/F-A relay operating
THR
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
THR-A
248
1536
1537
1538
1539
EXT_MEC. TP1
EXT_MEC. TP2
EXT_MEC. TP3
EXT_MEC. TP4
External mechanical relay trip 1
External mechanical relay trip 2
External mechanical relay trip 3
External mechanical relay trip 4
⎯ 183 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Relay
Model
Module
Name
BO No.
Signal Name
Contents
Setting
Logic
Signal No.
Timer
(OR: 1, AND:
2)
(OFF: 0, ON: 1)
GRT100
-203
IO2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
TRIP-1
TRIP First
284
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
TRIP Third
291
TRIP-3
298
224
DIFT
DIFT relay operating
1OC, 1OCI, 1REF, 1EF,
1OC, 1OCI, 1REF, 1EF or 1EFI relay
operating
129, 225, 173, 174, 73
1EFI
BO6
BO7
2OC, 2OCI, 2REF, 2EF,
2OC, 2OCI, 2REF, 2EF or 2EFI relay
operating
140, 226, 190, 191, 76
151, 227, 207, 208, 79
1
1
1
1
2EFI
3OC, 3OCI, 3REF, 3EF,
3OC, 3OCI, 3REF, 3EF or 3EFI relay
operating
3EFI
BO8
FRQ
FRQ relay operating
230
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
BO9
V/F
V/F-L, H relay operating
V/F-A relay operating
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
External mechanical relay trip
229
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
V/F-A
242
THR
83
248
THR-A
EXT_MEC. TP1, 2, 3, 4
1536, 1537, 1538, 1539
GRT100
-204
IO2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
TRIP-1
TRIP First
284
291
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRIP-2
TRIP Second
TRIP-3
TRIP Third
298
DIFT
DIFT relay operating
1OC or 1OCI relay operating
2OC or 2OCI relay operating
3OC or 3OCI relay operating
1REF relay operating
2REF relay operating
3REF relay operating
1EF or 1EFI relay operating
2EF or 2EFI relay operating
3EF or 3EFI relay operating
224
1OC, 1OCI
2OC, 2OCI
3OC, 3OCI
1REF
129, 225
140, 226
151, 227
173
2REF
190
3REF
207
1EF, 1EFI
2EF, 2EFI
3EF, 2EFI
174, 73
191, 76
208, 79
IO3
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
FRQ
FRQ relay operating
230
81
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
V/F-T
V/F-T relay operating
V/F-H
V/F-H relay operating
235
242
83
V/F-A
V/F-A relay operating
THR
THR-L, H relay operating
THR-A relay operating
THR-A
248
1536
1537
1538
1539
EXT_MEC. TP1
EXT_MEC. TP2
EXT_MEC. TP3
EXT_MEC. TP4
External mechanical relay trip 1
External mechanical relay trip 2
External mechanical relay trip 3
External mechanical relay trip 4
⎯ 184 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix E
Details of Relay Menu and
LCD & Button Operation
⎯ 185 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MENU
1=Record
2=Status
3=Setting(view)
5=Test
4=Setting(change)
/1 Record
1=Fault record
3=Disturbance record
2=Event record
2=Clear
/2 Fault record
1=Display
/3 Fault record
2/8
/4 Fault record #2
3/33
#1 16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
#2 12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622
#3 30/Jan/1997 15:06:11.835
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
Phase BC
DIFT
Trip ABC
/2 Fault record
Clear all fault records?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/2 Event record
1=Display
/3 Event record
16/Oct/1998 23:18:04.294 Trip
16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913 Trip
2/48
Off
On
2=Clear
12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622 Rly.set change
/2 Event record
Clear all event records?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/2 Disturbance record
1=Display 2=Clear
/3 Disturbance record
1/ 11
#1 16/Oct/1998 23:18:03.913
#2 12/Feb/1998 03:51:37.622
#3 30/Jan/1997 15:06:11.835
/2 Disturbance record
Clear all disturbance records?
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
/1 Status
1=Metering
3=Relay element
5=Clock adjustment
/2 Metering 12/Feb/1998 22:56 3/13
Ia1 ***.*kA ***.* Ia2 **.**kA ***.*
Ib1 ***.*kA ***.* Ib2 **.**kA ***.*
Ic1 ***.*kA ***.* Ic2 **.**kA ***.*
2=Binary I/O
4=Time sync source
/2 Binary input & output
3/ 5
Input (IO#1)
Input (IO#2)
Output(IO#1-trip)[000 00
[000 000 000 000 000]
[000
]
]
/2 Relay element
3/ 9
DIFT
REF
OC
[000 000 000 000
[000
[000 000 000 00
]
]
]
/2 Time synchronization source
*IRIG: Active
3/ 4
RSM: Inactive
IEC: Inactive
/2 12/Feb/1998 22:56:19 [local] 1/5
Minute ( 0 - 59) : 56 _
Hour ( 0 - 23) : 22
Day
( 1 - 31) : 12
a-1
⎯ 186 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
a-1
/1 Setting(view)
1=Version 2=Description 3=Comm.
4=Record 5=Status
6=Protection
7=Binary input 8=Binary output 9=LED
/2 Relay version
Relay type:
Serial No.:
3/ 8
********************
********************
Main software: ********************
/2 Description
Plant name:
Description:
********************
********************
/2 Communication
/3 Address/Parameter
3/***
1=Address/Parameter
2=Switch
HDLC (
SYADJ(
IP1-2(
1
)
IEC (
0 ms ) IP1-1(
IP1-3(
1
0
0
)
)
)
0
)
/3 Switch
PRTCL1 1=HDLC 2=1EC103
3/***
2
232C
1=9.6 2=19.2 3=38.4 4=57.6 4
IECBR
1=9.6 2=19.2
2
/2 Record
1=Fault record
2=Disturbance record
/3 Fault record
1/1
2= Event record
Phase mode
1=Operating 2=Fault 1
/3 Event record
1=Signal no.
2=Event name
/4 Signal no.
BITRN( 128
3/65
)
)
)
EV1 ( 3071
)
)
)
EV2 (
EV4 (
0
1
EV3 (
EV5 (
1
2
/4 Event name
3/128
Event name1 [Event record name1 ]
Event name2
Event name3
[
[
]
]
/3 Disturbance record
1=Record time & starter
2=Scheme switch
/4 Record time & starter
3/ 4
Time ( 3.0 s ) 1OCPS( 0.10 pu )
2OCPS( 0.10 pu ) 3OCPS( 0.10 pu )
1OCPG( 0.10 pu ) 2OCPG( 0.10 pu )
3=Binary signal
4=Signal name
/4 Scheme switch
TRIP1
TRIP2
1/16
0=Off 1=On
0=Off 1=On
0=Off 1=On
0
0
0
TRIP3
/4 Binary signal
3/16
SIG1 ( 128
)
)
)
SIG2 ( 3071
)
)
)
SIG3 (
SIG5 (
0
1
SIG4 (
SIG6 (
1
2
/2 Status
1=Metering
2=Time Synchronization
3=Time zone
/3 Metering
Display value 1=Primary 2=Secondary 1
1/ 1
/4 Signal name
Signal name1 [Signal name1
3/32
]
]
]
Signal name2
Signal name3
[
[
/3 Time synchronization
0=Off 1=IRIG 2=RSM 3=IEC 4=SNTP
Current No.= 2
/3 Time zone
1/ 1
GMT ( * * hrs ) GMTm ( * * min )
a-1, b-1
⎯ 187 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
a-1 b-1
/2 Protection
(Active group= *)
1=Group1 2=Group2 3=Group3 4=Group4
5=Group5 6=Group6 7=Group7 8=Group8
/3 Protection
1=Transformer parameter
2=Trip
(Group 1)
/4 Transformer parameter
1= VT & CT ratio
(Group 1)
(Group 1)
/5 VT & CT ratio
1CT ( 2000
3CT ( 1500
3/ 4
)
)
)
2CT ( 1500
1nCT ( 1000
3nCT ( 2000
)
)
)
2nCT (
500
/4 Trip
/5 Phase matching
1=Alpha 2=Beta
1=Phase matching
2=Scheme switch
3=Protection element
Current No.=2
Select No. = _
/5 Scheme switch
3/∗∗∗
DIFTPMD 1=3POR 2=1P
1
1REF
2REF
1=1IO 2=2IO 3=3IO
1=1IO 2=2IO 3=3IO
1
1
/5 Protection element
(Group 1)
/6 DIFT
ik ( 0.10 pu ) p1
p2 50 % ) kp ( 1.00 pu )
3/ 7
10 % )
1=DIFT
4=THR
2=REF
5=V/F
3=OC
(
6=FRQ
(
kct1 ( 0.50
) kct2 ( 0.50
)
/6 REF
3/11
1ik ( 0.50 pu ) 1kct1( 1.00
1kct2( 1.00 ) 1kct3( 1.00
)
)
1p2 (
10 % ) 1kp ( 1.00pu )
/6 OC
3/12
1OC ( 0.10 pu ) 2OC ( 0.10 pu )
3OC ( 0.10 pu ) T1OC ( 10.00 s )
T2OC ( 10.00 s ) T3OC ( 10.00 s )
/3 Protection
1=Transformer parameter
2=Trip
(Group 2)
/6 THR
3/ 3
τ
(
0.5 min) k
IB ( 1.00 pu ) lp ( 0.10 pu )
TA 0 min)
( 0.10
)
(
/3 Protection
1=Transformer parameter
2=Trip
(Group 8)
/6 V/F
3/ 5
( 1.10 pu )
( 1.30 pu )
( 3 s )
V
L
( 100.0 V ) A
( 1.20 pu ) H
LT
(
1 s ) HT
/6 FRQ
81-1 ( 45.00 Hz ) 81-2 ( 55.00 Hz )
UV 40 V ) TFRQL( 1.00 s )
TFRQH( 1.00 s ) TFRQA( 1.00 s )
3/ 3
/2 Binary input
3/16
BISW 1 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 2 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 3 1=Norm 2=Inv
1
1
1
(
/2 Binary output
/3 Binary output
(IO#2) 3/13
1=IO#2
2=IO#3
BO1 ( 1, 100, 0, 0, 0, 0)AND,
BO2 ( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0) OR,
BO3 ( 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,
/3 Binary output
(IO#3) 3/10
BO1 ( 1, 100, 0, 0, 0, 0)AND,
BO2 ( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0) OR,
BO3 ( 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6) OR,
/2 LED
LED1
LED2
3/ 4
0) AND,I
0) OR,I
0) OR,L
(
(
(
1, 309,
0, 0,
15, 16, 17,
0,
0,
LED3
a-1
⎯ 188 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
a-1
: Password trap
Password
Input password [_ ]
/1 Setting(change)
1=Password 2=Description 3=Comm.
4=Record 5=Status
6=Protection
7=Binary input 8=Binary output 9=LED
: Confirmation trap
/2 *************
Change settings?
/2 Password
Input new password
Retype new password
[ _ ]
ENTER=Yes CANCEL=No
[
]
/2 Description
/3 Plant name [ _
]
1=Plant name 2=Description
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ()[]@_← →
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz{}*/+-<=>← →
0123456789!”#$%&’:;,.^
← →
/3 Description [ _
]
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ()[]@_← →
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz{}*/+-<=>← →
0123456789!”#$%&’:;,.^
← →
/2 Communication
1=Address/Parameter
2=Switch
/3 Address/Parameter
1/***
HDLC (
IEC (
1-
32):
1 _
2
0- 254):
SYADJ( -9999- 9999):
0
ms
/3 Switch
PRTCL1 1=HDLC 2=1EC103
1/***
2 _
232C
1=9.6 2=19.2 3=38.4 4=57.6 4
IECBR 1=9.6 2=19.2
2
/3 Fault record
Phase mode 1=Operating 2=Fault 1 _
1/1
/2 Record
1=Fault record
2=Event record
2=Disturbance record
/3 Event record
1/129
BITRN(
EV1 (
EV2 (
0- 128):
0- 3071):
0- 3071):
128 _
0
1
/3 Disturbance record
1=Record time & starter
2=Scheme switch
/4 Record time & starter
Time ( 0.1- 3.0):
1OCPS( 0.10- 20.00):
2OCPS( 0.10- 20.00):
1/ 7
s
pu
pu
2.0 _
0.10
0.10
3=Binary signal
/4 Scheme switch
1/16
1 _
1
TRIP1
TRIP2
TRIP3
0=Off 1=On
0=Off 1=On
0=Off 1=On
1
/4 Binary signal
1/32
SIG1 (
SIG2 (
SIG3 (
0- 3071):
0- 3071):
0- 3071):
1 _
2
3
/2 Status
/3 Metering
1/ 1
1=Metering
Display value 1=Primary 2=Secondary 1_
2=Time Synchronization
3=Time zone
/3 Time synchronization
0=Off 1=IRIG 2=RSM 3=IEC 4=SNTP
Current No.=0
Select No. = _
/3 Time zone
1/ 2
GMT ( -12- +12):
GMTm ( -59- +59):
+9 _ hrs
+0
min
a-1
b-2
⎯ 189 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
a-1
b-2
/2 Protection
1=Change active group
2=Change setting
3=Copy group
/3Change active group(Active group= *)
1=Group1 2=Group2 3=Group3 4=Group4
5=Group5 6=Group6 7=Group7 8=Group8
Current No.= *
Select No.= _
/3 Change setting (Active group= *)
1=Group1 2=Group2 3=Group3 4=Group4
5=Group5 6=Group6 7=Group7 8=Group8
/4 Protection
1=Transformer parameter
2=Trip
(Group 1)
/5 Transformer parameter
1=VT & CT ratio
(Group 1)
(Group 1)
/6 VT & CT ratio
1/ 7
1CT (
2CT (
3CT (
1- 20000):
1- 20000):
1- 20000):
2000 _
1000
400
/5 Trip
/6 Phase matching
1=Alpha 2=Beta
1=Phase matching
2=Scheme switch
3=Protection element
Current No.=2
Select No. = _
/6 Scheme switch
DIFTPMD 1=3POR 2=1P
1/∗∗∗
1 _
1
1REF
2REF
1=1IO 2=2IO 3=3IO
1=1IO 2=2IO 3=3IO
1
/6 Protection element
(Group= 1)
3=OC
6=FRQ
/7 DIFT
ik ( 0.10- 1.00): 0.10 _
1/13
pu
%
1=DIFT
4=THR
2=REF
5=V/F
p1 (
p2 (
10- 100):
10- 200): 100
10
%
/7 REF
1/21
1ik ( 0.05- 0.50): 0.05 _ pu
1kct1( 1.00- 50.00): 1.00
1kct2( 1.00- 50.00): 1.00
/7 OC
1/24
1OC ( 0.10- 20.00): 0.10 _ pu
2OC ( 0.10- 20.00): 0.10
3OC ( 0.10- 20.00): 0.10
pu
pu
/7 THR
1/ 5
0.5 _ min
τ
(
0.5- 500.0):
k
IB
(
(
0.10- 4.00): 0.10
0.50- 2.50): 0.50
pu
/7 V/F
1/ 9
V
pu
/4 Protection
1=Transformer parameter
2=Trip
(Group 2)
V
A
L
( 100.0- 120.0): 100.0_
(
(
1.03- 1.30): 1.10
1.05- 1.30): 1.20
pu
/7 FRQ
1/ 6
Hz
Hz
81-1 ( 45.00- 55.00): 45.00_
81-2 ( 45.00- 55.00): 45.00
/4 Protection
(Group 8)
1=Transformer parameters
2=Trip
UV
(
40- 100):
40
V
/3 Copy groupA to B (Active group= 1)
A
B
(
(
1-
1-
8):
8):
_
a-1 b-2 c-1
⎯ 190 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
a-1 b-2
/2 Binary input
1/16
1 _
1
BISW 1 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 2 1=Norm 2=Inv
BISW 3 1=Norm 2=Inv
1
/2 Binary output
/3 Binary output
Select BO
(IO#2)
1=IO#2
2=IO#3
( 1- 13)
Select No.= _
/4 Setting
(BO 1 of IO#2)
/5 Logic gate type & delay timer 1/ 2
1=Logic gate type & delay timer
2=Input to logic gate
Logic 1=OR 2=AND
BOTD 0=Off 1=On
1 _
1
/5 Input to logic gate
3/ 6
21 _
/4 Setting
1=Logic gate type & delay timer
2=Input to logic gate
(BO 12 of IO#2)
In #1 (
In #2 (
In #3 (
0 - 3071):
0 - 3071):
0 - 3071):
4
67
/3 Binary output
(IO#3)
Select BO
( 1- 10)
Select No.= _
/2 LED
Select LED
/3 Setting
1=Logic gate type & reset
2=Input to logic gate
(LED*)
/4 Logic gate type & reset
Logic 1=OR 2=AND
Reset 0=Inst 1=Latch
1/ 2
1 _
1
( 1- 4)
Select No.= _
/1 Test
1=Switch
3=Timer
/2 Switch
A.M.F. 0=Off 1=On
Reset 0=Off 1=On
1/ 3
1 _
0
/4 Input to logic gate
1/ 4
2=Binary output
4=Logic circuit
In #1(
In #2(
In #3(
0- 3071):
0- 3071):
0- 3071):
21 _
4
67
IECTST 0=Off 1=On
0
/2 Binary output
1=IO#1 2=IO#2 3=IO#3
/3 BO
(0=Disable 1=Enable) 1/ 5
/3 BO
IO#1 TP-1:
IO#1 TP-2:
IO#1 TP-3:
1 _
1
1
Keep pressing 1 to operate.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/3 BO
(0=Disable 1=Enable) 1/ 10
IO#3 BO1:
IO#3 BO2:
IO#3 BO3:
1 _
1
1
/2 Timer
1/ 1
/2 Timer
Timer(
1 - 100):
1 _
Press ENTER to operate.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/2 Timer
Operating . . .
Press END to reset.
Press CANCEL to cancel.
/2 Logic circuit
1/ 2
1 _
48
TermA(
TermB(
0 - 3071):
0 - 3071):
⎯ 191 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
LCD AND BUTTON OPERATION INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
MODE
1. PRESS ARROW KEY TO MOVE TO EACH DISPLAYED
ITEMS
NORMAL
(DISPLAY OFF)
2. PRESS "END" KEY TO BACK TO PREVIOUS SCREEN
1=RECORD
PRESS ANY
BUTTON
MENU
( DISPLAY ON )
EXCEPT FOR
"VIEW" AND
"RESET"
1=FAULT RECORD
VIEW
2=EVENT RECORD
3=DISTURBANCE RECORD
METERING 1
( DISPLAY ON )
2=STATUS
RESET
VIEW
1=METERING
2=BINARY INPUT&OUTPUT
3=RELAY ELELMENT
AUTO-
MODE 1
TRIP OUTPUT
ISSUED !
METERING 2
( DISPLAY ON )
4=TIME SYNC SOURCE
5=CLOCK ADJUSTMENT
VIEW
RESET
3=SETTING
(VIEW)
TRIP
( LED ON )
1=RELAY VERSION
2=DESCRIPTION
LATEST FAULT *
( DISPLAY ON )
AUTO-
MODE 2
RELAY
FAILED !
3=RSM COMMUNICATION
4=RECORD
5=STATUS
VIEW
RESET
ALARM
( LED ON )
6=PROTECTION
7=BINARY INPUT
8=BINARY OUTPUT
9=LED
AUTO SUPERVISON *
( DISPLAY ON )
*. "LATEST FAULT" AND "AUTO
SUPERVISION" SCREEN IS
DISPLAYED ONLY IF DATA
IS STORED
4=SETTING
(CHANGE) Same as SETTING (VIEW) menu
VIEW
RESET
5=TEST
1=SWITCH
2=BINARY OUTPUT
3=TIMER
4=LOGIC CIRCUIT
⎯ 192 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix F
Case Outline
• Flush Mount Type
• Rack Mount Type
⎯ 193 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
266
28
254
65
276.2
2
Front View
Side view
4-φ5.5
190.5
260
34.75
6.2
223
235.4
Rear view
Panel cut-out
TB3/TB4 TB2
A1 B1
A1 B1
TB2-TB4:
M3.5 Ring
terminal
TB1:
TB1
M3.5 Ring
terminal
1
3
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
14
16
18
11
13
15
17
A10 B10
19
21
23
25
27
29
20
22
24
26
28
A18 B18
30
Terminal block
Case Outline : Flush Mount Type
⎯ 194 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Attachment kit
(top bar)
Attachment kit
(large bracket)
Attachment kit
(small bracket)
Top View
4 HOLES - 6.8x10.3
TRANSFORMER PROTECTION
GRT100
201B-11-10
1A
100/110/115/120V
465.1
483.0
Front View
Case Outline: Rack Mount Type
⎯ 195 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
247.8
19.4
18.8
(a) Large Bracket
(b) Small Bracket
216
(c) Bar for Top and Bottom of Relay
Parts
(a)
(b)
(c)
1 Large bracket, 5 Round head screws with spring washers and washers (M4x10)
1 Small bracket, 3 Countersunk head screws (M4x6)
2 Bars, 4 Countersunk head screws (M3x8)
Dimensions of Attachment Kit EP-101
⎯ 196 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
How to Mount Attachment Kit for Rack-Mounting
Caution: Be careful that the relay modules or terminal blocks, etc., are not damage while mounting.
Tighten screws to the specified torque according to the size of screw.
Step 1.
Remove case cover.
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
Right bracket
Seal
Left bracket
Step 2.
Screw
Remove the left and right brackets by
unscrewing the three screws respectively,
then remove two screws on left side of the
GPS ALARM
relay.
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
And then, remove four seals on the top
and bottom of the relay.
Seal
Step 3
Top bar
Mount the small bracket by screwing three
countersunk head screws(M4x6) and apply
adhesives to the screws to prevent them
from loosening.
Mount the large bracket by five round head
screws(M4x10) with washer and spring
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
washer.
MODE 2A
CF
And then, mount the top and bottom bars by
two countersunk head screws(M3x8)
respectively.
Small bracket
Large bracket
Bottom bar
Step 4
Completed.
GPS ALARM
SYNC. ALARM
MODE 2A
CF
⎯ 197 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 198 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix G
External Connections
⎯ 199 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB3-A2
A1
BO1
BO2
BO3
B1
B2
TB1 -1
2
3
4
5
6
CT
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
BO4
BO5
CB
VT
IO#2
CT
7
8
B5
A6
BO6
CT
B6
BO7
CB
A7
B7
CT
BO8
9
10
A8
B8
11
12
BO9
13
14
15
16
A9
BO10
BO11
BO12
B9
A10
27
28
30
B10
A11
(∗1)
(CASE EARTH)
B11
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
(+)
A13
B13
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
TB4 -A4
FAIL
A12
B12
BI1
BI2
B4
A5
B5
A6
RELAY FAILURE
MECHANICAL
TRIP
BI3
TB3-A18
BI4
COM-A
COM-B
0V
INDICATION RESET
B18
A17
RS485 I/F
BI5
B6
A7
BI6
IO#1
BI7
B17
A16
B7
BI8
A8
B8
A9
BI9
B16
BI10
BI11
BI12
BI13
Ethernet LAN I/F
B9
RJ45
ST
(100Base-TX:option)
A10
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
B11
(-)
TB3-A14
Ethernet LAN I/F
BI14
BI15
BI16
SC
B14
A15
EVENT
(100Base-FX:option)
IO#2
IO module
(-)
B15
IRIG-B
IO#1
IO#2
IO1
IO2
TB4-A1
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
B1
A2
IO#2
CN1
IRIG-B
TB4
TB3
A1
B1
B2
A3
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
≥1
E
TB1
1
2
TB4 -A16
+5Vdc
0V
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
TRIP-5
B3
A12
(+)
DC-DC
DC
SUPPLY
B16
A17
B17
A18
B18
A15
(-)
A18
B18
B12
A13
29
30
IO#2
IO#1
VCT
(∗1)These connections are connected
(∗1)
by short-links before shipment.
B13
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
B15
E
(CASE EARTH)
Typical External Connection of Model 101D
⎯ 200 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB2-A1
B1
TB3-A2
A1
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO1
BO2
BO3
TB1 -1
2
A2
B1
B2
3
B2
4
5
6
CT
A3
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
CB
B3
BO4
BO5
VT
A4
CT
B4
IO#2
A5
7
8
B5
A6
BO6
B5
CT
A6
B6
BO7
CB
B6
A7
B7
CT
9
BO8
A7
10
11
A8
B8
B7
12
13
BO9
A8
14
15
16
A9
B8
BO10
BO11
BO12
B9
A9
27
28
30
A10
B9
B10
A11
(∗1)
(CASE EARTH)
A10
B10
B11
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
(+)
A13
B13
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
IO#3
BO13
TB4 -A4
BI1
BI2
FAIL
A12
B12
B4
A5
B5
A6
RELAY FAILURE
MECHANICAL
TRIP
BI3
TB3-A18
BI4
COM-A
COM-B
0V
INDICATION RESET
BI5
B18
A17
RS485 I/F
B6
A7
BI6
BI7
B7
B17
A16
IO#1
BI8
A8
B8
A9
BI9
B16
BI10
BI11
BI12
BI13
B9
Ethernet LAN I/F
RJ45
(100Base-TX:option)
A10
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
ST
IO module
B11
TB3-A14
(-)
BI14
BI15
BI16
Ethernet LAN I/F
IO#1
IO#2
IO#3
IO1
IO2
IO3
SC
B14
A15
EVENT
(100Base-FX:option)
IO#2
(-)
B15
IRIG-B
TB4-A1
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
B1
A2
IO#2
CN1
TB4
TB3 TB2
B1
A1
A1
B1
IRIG-B
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
B2
A3
≥1
E
TB1
TB4 -A16
1
2
+5Vdc
0V
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
TRIP-5
A10
B10
B3
A12
(+)
B16
DC-DC
DC
SUPPLY
IO#3
A17
B17
A18
B18
A15
B15
(-)
B12
A13
A18
B18
29
30
IO#2
IO#1
(∗1)These connections are connected
by short-links before shipment.
(∗1)
VCT
B13
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
E
(CASE EARTH)
Typical External Connection of Model 102D
⎯ 201 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB1 -1
2
TB3-A2
A1
BO1
3
4
CT
5
BO2
BO3
B1
B2
6
CB
7
8
VT
9
10
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
B5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
A9
11
12
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
13
14
IO#2
CT
CT
CB
15
CT
16
17
18
CB
19
20
21
22
CT
23
24
CT
27
BO10
BO11
BO12
B9
28
30
A10
(∗1)
B10
A11
B11
(CASE EARTH)
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
(+)
A13
B13
[Default Setting]
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
TB4 -A4
BI1
BI2
B4
A5
B5
FAIL
A12
B12
EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP
INDICATION RESET
RELAY FAILURE
BI3
BI4
BI5
A6
TB3-A18
COM-A
COM-B
0V
B6
A7
BI6
BI7
B18
A17
IO#1
B7
RS485 I/F
BI8
A8
B8
A9
B17
A16
BI9
BI10
BI11
BI12
BI13
B16
B9
Ethernet LAN I/F
RJ45
A10
(100Base-TX:option)
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
ST
SC
B11
TB3-A14
(-)
(-)
IO module
BI14
B14
A15
Ethernet LAN I/F
EVENT
IO#1
IO#2
IO1
IO2
BI15
BI16
IO#2
(100Base-FX:option)
B15
IRIG-B
CN1
IRIG-B
TB4
TB3
TB4-A1
A1
B1
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
B1
A2
IO#2
E
TB1
1
2
B2
A3
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
≧1
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
A18
B18
TB4 -A16
B3
A12
29
30
+5Vdc
0V
IO#2
IO#1
B16
A17
VCT
(+)
DC
SUPPLY
DC-DC
B12
A13
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
(-)
B17
A18
(∗1)These connections are connected
by short-bars before shipment.
(∗1)
B18
A15
B15
TRIP-5
B13
E
(CASE EARTH)
Typical External Connection of Model 201D
⎯ 202 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB2-A1
B1
TB3-A2
A1
TB1 -1
2
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO1
3
4
5
CT
BO2
BO3
A2
B1
B2
6
B2
CB
7
8
A3
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
B5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
A9
VT
9
10
B3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
11
12
13
14
A4
IO#2
B4
CT
CT
CB
A5
15
CT
B5
16
17
18
A6
CB
19
20
B6
21
22
CT
A7
23
24
B7
A8
B8
CT
BO10
BO11
BO12
27
B9
A9
A10
28
30
B9
B10
A11
B11
(∗1)
(CASE EARTH)
A10
B10
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
(+)
A13
B13
[Default Setting]
IO#3
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
TB4 -A4
BI1
BI2
FAIL
B4
A5
B5
A12
B12
EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP
INDICATION RESET
RELAY FAILURE
BI3
BI4
BI5
A6
TB3-A18
COM-A
COM-B
0V
B6
A7
B18
A17
RS485 I/F
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
IO#1
B7
B17
A16
A8
B8
A9
BI10
BI11
BI12
BI13
B16
B9
Ethernet LAN I/F
RJ45
A10
(100Base-TX:option)
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
ST
B11
TB3-A14
IO module
(-)
(-)
BI14
IO#1
IO#2
IO#3
IO1
IO2
IO3
B14
A15
Ethernet LAN I/F
EVENT
SC
BI15
BI16
IO#2
(100Base-FX:option)
B15
IRIG-B
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
TB4-A1
CN1
IRIG-B
A1 TB4
TB3 TB2B1
B1
A2
IO#2
E
B2
A3
TB1
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
1
2
B10
≧1
IO#3
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
TB4 -A16
B3
A12
+5Vdc
0V
A18
B16
A17
(+)
DC
SUPPLY
DC-DC
29
30
IO#2
IO#1
VCT
B12
A13
(-)
B17
A18
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
(∗1)These connections are connected
by short-bars before shipment.
(∗1)
B18
A15
B15
TRIP-5
B13
E
(CASE EARTH)
Typical External Connection of Model 202D
⎯ 203 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB1 -1
2
TB3-A2
A1
3
4
5
BO1
CT
BO2
BO3
6
B1
B2
CB
7
8
VT
9
10
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
B5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
A9
11
12
13
14
BO4
BO5
CT
CT
CB
15
CT
16
17
BO6
18
CB
19
20
21
22
BO7
CT
IO#2
23
24
BO8
BO9
CT
27
BO10
BO11
BO12
B9
A10
B10
A11
28
30
(∗1)
(CASE EARTH)
(+)
TB4 -B4
[Default Setting]
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
B11
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
BI5
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
BI10
BI11
BI12
A4
B5
A13
B13
EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP
A5
B6
A6
B7
A7
B8
A8
B9
A9
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
FAIL
A12
B12
RELAY FAILURE
INDICATION RESET
PROTECTION BLOCK
TB3-A18
COM-A
COM-B
0V
B10
IO#1
B18
A17
A10
B11
A11
B12
A12
B13
A13
B14
A14
B15
A15
RS485 I/F
B17
A16
B16
Ethernet LAN I/F
RJ45
(100Base-TX:option)
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
ST
SC
(-)
IO module
TB3 –A14
Ethernet LAN I/F
BI14
BI15
BI16
(100Base-FX:option)
IO#1
IO#2
IO8
IO2
B14
A15
EVENT
IO#2
IRIG-B
(+)
B15
(-)
TB4- A3
B3
CN1
IRIG-B
A1 TB4
TB3
A1
A2
B2
TP-1
IO#1
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
TRIP-3
E
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
TP-2
TP-3
TB1
≧1
1
2
TB4 -A16
(+)
+5Vdc
0V
DC
SUPPLY
B16
A17
(∗)
DC-DC
A18
29
30
IO#2
(-)
IO#1
VCT
(∗)
B17
A18
B18
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
(∗)
(∗)This connection is connected by
short bar before shipment.
E
CASE EARTH
Typical External Connection of Model 203D
⎯ 204 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TB1 -1
2
TB2-A1
B1
TB3-A2
A1
BO1
BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
3
4
CT
5
BO2
BO3
A2
6
B1
B2
CB
7
8
B2
VT
9
A3
10
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
B5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
A9
11
12
B3
BO4
BO5
13
14
A4
CT
CT
CB
B4
15
CT
A5
16
17
BO6
B5
18
CB
19
A6
20
BO7
21
22
IO#2
CT
B6
23
24
A7
BO8
B7
BO9
A8
CT
B8
27
BO10
BO11
BO12
B9
A9
28
30
A10
(∗1)
B9
B10
A11
B11
(CASE EARTH)
A10
B10
(+)
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
TB4 -B4
[Default Setting]
BI1
BI2
BI3
BI4
BI5
BI6
BI7
BI8
BI9
BI10
BI11
BI12
A13
B13
A4
B5
(HIGH SPEED
RELAY)
BO13
EXT. MECHANICAL TRIP
IO#3
A5
B6
A6
B7
A7
B8
A8
B9
A9
FAIL
A12
B12
RELAY FAILURE
INDICATION RESET
PROTECTION BLOCK
TB3-A18
COM-A
COM-B
0V
B18
A17
RS485 I/F
B10
IO#1
A10
B11
A11
B12
A12
B13
A13
B14
A14
B15
A15
B17
A16
B16
Ethernet LAN I/F
RJ45
ST
(100Base-TX:option)
Opt. interface for
IEC103(option)
(-)
Ethernet LAN I/F
SC
IO module
TB3 –A14
(100Base-FX:option)
BI14
BI15
BI16
IO#1
IO#2
IO#3
IO8
IO2
B14
EVENT
IO#2
IRIG-B
(+)
A15
(-)
IO3
TB4- A3
B3
A1
A2
B2
TP-1
CN1
A1 TB4
TB3 TB2B1
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
TRIP-3
IO#1
RELAY FAIL.
DD FAIL.
IRIG-B
≧1
TP-2
TP-3
E
TB4 -A16
(+)
(∗)
TB1
+5Vdc
0V
DC
SUPPLY
1
2
B16
B10
DC-DC
A17
B17
A18
B18
IO#3
(-)
(∗)
A18
29
30
(∗)
IO#2
IO#1
VCT
(∗)This connection is connected by
short bar before shipment.
Terminal Block Arrangement (Rear view)
E
CASE EARTH
Typical External Connection of Model 204D
⎯ 205 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 206 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix H
Relay Setting Sheet
1. Relay Identification
2. Contacts Setting
3. Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
⎯ 207 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Relay Setting Sheets
1. Relay Identification
Date:
Relay type
Serial Number
CT rating
Frequency
VT rating
dc supply voltage
Password
Active setting group
2. Contacts Setting
(1) IO#2 BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
BO11
BO12
BO13
(2) IO#3 BO1
BO2
BO3
BO4
BO5
BO6
BO7
BO8
BO9
BO10
⎯ 208 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3. Relay and Protection Scheme Setting Sheet
Default Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
User
setting
Range
World wide
ENA
3-Winding
№
Name
Units
Contents
2-Winding
101D 102D
3-Winding
201D 202D
5A rating
1A rating
203D
204D
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Active group
1CT
2CT
3CT
1nCT
2nCT
3nCT
VT
1 - 8
Active setting group
CT ratio
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
VT ratio
1
2000
2000
1
2000
2000
2000
2000
400
400
400
Beta
3POR
3POR
--
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
1 - 20000
--
--
2000
400
2000
400
400
Beta
3POR
3POR
Phase matching
DIFTPMD
Alpha - Beta
3POR - 2PAND - 1P
3POR - 1P
1I0 - 2I0
1I0 - 2I0 - 3I0
1I0 - 2I0
Phase angle matching
DIF trip mode
10
11
12
1REF
2REF
Transformer type for REF
ditto
1I0
--
1I0
--
--
1I0
--
1I0
1I0
-
-
1I0
--
1I0
1I0
1I0 - 2I0 - 3I0
1I0 - 2I0 - 3I0
13
14
3REF
ditto
--
-
-
Directional checking
function of REF
REF_DEF
Off - On
Off
Off
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
M1OCI
M2OCI
M3OCI
M1EFI
M2EFI
M3EFI
L/O
2F-LOCK
5F-LOCK
DIF1
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Long - Std - Very - Ext
Off - On
OCI back-up trip
ditto
ditto
EFI back-up trip
ditto
ditto
Trip signal lock out
2F restraint
5F restraint
Current differential trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Restricted earth fault trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
OC trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
OCI trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
EF trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
Std
Std
Std
Std
Std
Std
Std
Std
Off
On
On
On
On
On
--
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
--
--
Std
Std
Std
Std
Off
On
On
On
On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
DIF2
DIF3
DIF4
DIF5
Off
On
Off
Off
On
On
On
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
On
On
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
--
1REF1
1REF2
1REF3
1REF4
1REF5
1OC1
1OC2
1OC3
1OC4
1OC5
1OCI1
1OCI2
1OCI3
1OCI4
1OCI5
1EF1
On
On
On
--
--
On
Off
Off
--
--
On
Off
Off
--
--
On
Off
Off
--
1EF2
1EF3
1EF4
1EF5
ditto
EFI trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
--
1EFI1
1EFI2
1EFI3
1EFI4
1EFI5
2REF1
2REF2
2REF3
2REF4
2REF5
2OC1
2OC2
2OC3
2OC4
2OC5
2OCI1
2OCI2
2OCI3
2OCI4
2OCI5
2EF1
On
Off
Off
--
ditto
--
Restricted earth fault trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
OC trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
OCI trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
EF trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
On
On
On
--
--
Off
On
Off
--
--
Off
On
Off
--
--
Off
On
Off
--
2EF2
2EF3
2EF4
2EF5
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
--
⎯ 209 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Def ault Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
World wide
Range
ENA
3-Winding
203D 204D
User
№
Name
Units
Contents
setting
2-Winding
101D 102D
3-Winding
201D 202D
5A rating
1A rating
74
2EFI1
2EFI2
2EFI3
2EFI4
2EFI5
3REF1
3REF2
3REF3
3REF4
3REF5
3OC1
3OC2
3OC3
3OC4
3OC5
3OCI1
3OCI2
3OCI3
3OCI4
3OCI5
3EF1
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
Of f - On
EFI trip
ditto
Of f
On
Of f
On
Of f
--
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
75
76
ditto
Of f
Of f
Of f
77
ditto
78
ditto
--
79
Restricted earth f ault trip
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
On
On
On
Of f
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
Of f
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
Of f
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
Of f
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
--
80
ditto
81
ditto
82
ditto
83
ditto
--
84
OC trip
Of f
Of f
On
--
85
ditto
86
ditto
87
ditto
88
ditto
--
89
OCI trip
Of f
Of f
On
--
90
ditto
91
ditto
92
ditto
93
ditto
--
94
EF trip
Of f
Of f
On
--
95
3EF2
ditto
96
3EF3
ditto
97
3EF4
ditto
98
3EF5
ditto
--
99
3EFI1
3EFI2
3EFI3
3EFI4
3EFI5
FRQ-UF1
FRQ-UF2
FRQ1
FRQ2
FRQ3
FRQ4
FRQ5
FRQA
V/F1
EFI trip
Of f
Of f
On
--
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
--
FRQ trip
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
--
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
ditto
--
ditto
On
On
On
On
--
V/F trip
V/F2
ditto
V/F3
ditto
V/F4
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
V/F5
ditto
--
V/FA
ditto
On
On
On
On
--
THR1
THR2
THR3
THR4
THR5
THRA
M.T1-1
M.T1-2
M.T1-3
M.T1-4
M.T1-5
M.T2-1
M.T2-2
M.T2-3
M.T2-4
M.T2-5
M.T3-1
M.T3-2
M.T3-3
M.T3-4
M.T3-5
M.T4-1
M.T4-2
M.T4-3
M.T4-4
M.T4-5
SVCNT
THR trip
ditto
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
ditto
--
ditto
On
On
On
On
--
Mechanical trip1
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
Of f
Of f
On
On
On
On
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
ditto
--
Mechanical trip2
On
On
On
--
ditto
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
ditto
--
Mechanical trip3
On
On
On
--
ditto
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
On
On
ditto
--
Mechanical trip4
On
On
On
--
ditto
ditto
ditto
Of f
Of f
ditto
--
ALM&BLK - ALM
Super visor control
DIF output blocked by CT
saturation
ALM&BLK
ALM&BLK
145
CTSEN
Of f - On
Of f
Of f
-
⎯ 210 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Default Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
World wide ENA
3-Winding
203D 204D
User
setting
Range
№
Name
Units
Contents
2-Winding
101D 102D
3-Winding
201D 202D
5A rating
1A rating
Minimum operating
current
% slope of small current
region
% slope of large current
region
Break point of DIF
characteristic
CT ratio
ditto
ditto
Phase angle
ditto
ditto
Primary winding
Secondary winding
Phase angel(Secondary)
Tertiary winding
Phase angle(Tertiary)
2f restraint
146 DIFT
147
ik
0.10 - 1.00
10 - 100
pu
%
0.30
100
200
1.00
0.30
100
200
1.00
p1
p2
kp
148
10 - 200
%
149
1.00 - 20.00
pu
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
kct1
kct2
kct3
d1
d2
d3
yd_p
yd_s
vec_s
yd_t
vec_t
k2f
0.05 - 50.00
0.05 - 50.00
0.05 - 50.00
0 - 11
0 - 11
0 - 11
1 - 2
1 - 2
0 - 11
1 - 2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
%
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0
0
0
2
2
0
2
--
1.00
0
0
0
2
2
0
--
--
2
0
0 - 11
0
10 - 50
10 - 100
2.00 - 20.00
15
30
2.00
15
30
2.00
k5f
kh
%
5f restraint
pu HOC operaing current
Minimum sensitivity for
1REF
164 REF
1ik
0.05 - 0.50
pu
0.50
0.50
165
166
167
168
169
1kct1
1kct2
1kct3
1p2
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
50 - 100
-
-
-
%
CT ratio for 1REF
ditto
ditto
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
100
--
1.00
Percent slope for 1REF
100
1.00
1kp
0.50 - 2.00
pu DF2 sensitivity
1.00
Minimum sensitivity for
2REF
170
2ik
0.05 - 0.50
pu
0.50
0.50
171
172
173
174
175
2kct1
2kct2
2kct3
2p2
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
50 - 100
-
-
-
%
CT ratio for 2REF
ditto
ditto
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
100
--
--
1.00
0.50
Percent slope for 2REF
100
1.00
2kp
0.50 - 2.00
pu DF2 sensitivity
1.00
Minimum sensitivity for
3REF
176
3ik
0.05 - 0.50
pu
0.50
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185 OC
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
3kct1
3kct2
3kct3
3p2
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
1.00 - 50.00
50 - 100
-
-
-
%
CT ratio for 3REF
ditto
ditto
--
--
--
--
--
1.00
1.00
1.00
100
1.00
1.00
1.00
100
Percent slope for 3REF
3kp
0.50 - 2.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.10 - 5.00
0.10 - 5.00
0.10 - 5.00
pu DF2 sensitivity
1.00
1.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
2.00
2.00
2.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
T1REF
T2REF
T3REF
1OC
2OC
3OC
T1OC
T2OC
T3OC
1OCI
2OCI
3OCI
s
s
s
1REF delay trip timer
2REF delay trip timer
3REF delay trip timer
0.00
0.00
--
--
--
--
0.00
2.00
1.00
1.00
pu OC element
pu ditto
pu ditto
2.00
2.00
s
s
s
OC delay trip timer
ditto
ditto
1.00
1.00
pu OCI element
pu ditto
pu ditto
1.00
1.00
OCI delayed tripping
194
T1OCI
0.05 - 1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
-
timer
ditto
ditto
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
T2OCI
T3OCI
1EF
2EF
3EF
T1EF
T2EF
T3EF
1EFI
2EFI
3EFI
0.05 - 1.00
0.05 - 1.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.00 - 10.00
0.10 - 5.00
0.10 - 5.00
0.10 - 5.00
-
-
1.00
1.00
2.00
2.00
2.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
--
--
--
--
1.00
2.00
1.00
1.00
pu EF element
pu ditto
pu ditto
2.00
2.00
s
s
s
EF delay trip timer
ditto
ditto
1.00
1.00
pu EFI element
pu ditto
pu dittp
1.00
1.00
206
T1EFI
0.05 - 1.00
EFI delayed tripping timer
1.00
1.00
1.00
-
207
208
209 THR
210
211
T2EFI
T3EFI
t
k
IB
Ip
TA
0.05 - 1.00
0.05 - 1.00
0.5 - 500.0
0.10 - 4.00
0.50 - 2.50
0.00 - 1.00
0 - 10
-
-
ditto
ditto
1.00
1.00
60.0
1.30
1.00
0.00
10
--
1.00
min Time constant
Constant
pu Basic current
pu Pre-load current
min Time for alarming
60.0
1.30
1.00
0.00
10
-
212
213
⎯ 211 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Def ault Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
World wide
Range
ENA
3-Winding
203D 204D
User
№
Name
Units
Contents
setting
2-Winding
101D 102D
3-Winding
201D 202D
5A rating
1A rating
214
215
216
217
V/F
V
A
L
100.0 - 120.0
1.03 - 1.30
1.05 - 1.30
1.10 - 1.40
V
Voltage
100.0
1.03
1.05
1.40
100.0
1.03
1.05
1.40
pu
pu
pu
Alarm lev el
Low lev el
H
High lev el
Inv erce time delay f or
218
219
LT
1 - 600
1 - 600
s
s
600
1
600
1
high lev el
Inv erce time delay f ir low
HT
RT
lev el
Radiant heat time
220
221
222
60 - 3600
1 - 600
s
s
s
250
10
250
10
TVFH
TVFA
Delay time f or high lev el
1 - 600
Delay time f or alarm level
10
10
Frequency-1 in 50Hz
223 FRQ
81-1
81-2
45.00 - 55.00
54.00 - 66.00
45.00 - 55.00
Hz
Hz
Hz
49.00
59.00
48.00
49.00
59.00
48.00
rating
Frequency-1 in 60Hz
rating
Frequency-2 in 50Hz
224
rating
Frequency-2 in 60Hz
54.00 - 66.00
40 - 100
Hz
v
58.00
40
58.00
40
rating
Voltage
225
226
UV
TRIP delay timer f or low
TFRQL
0.00 - 60.00
s
10.0
10.0
lev el
TRIP delay timer f or high
227
228
TFRQH
TFRQA
0.00 - 60.00
0.00 - 60.00
s
s
10.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
lev el
TRIP delay timer f or alarm
lev el
Binary input
ditto
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
242
243
244
BISW 1
BISW 2
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
Norm - Inv
OR - AND
Inst - Latch
0 - 3071
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
OR
Inst
0
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
Norm
--
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BISW 3
BISW 4
BISW 5
BISW 6
BISW 7
BISW 8
BISW 9
BISW 10
BISW 11
BISW 12
BISW 13
BISW 14
BISW 15
BISW 16
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Norm
Norm
Norm
OR
Inst
281
0
ditto
ditto
245 LED1
246
Logic
Reset
In #1
In #2
In #3
In #4
Logic
Reset
In #1
In #2
In #3
In #4
Logic
Reset
In #1
In #2
In #3
In #4
Logic
Reset
In #1
In #2
In #3
In #4
Conf igurable LEDs
247
248
0 - 3071
0
249
0 - 3071
0
0
250
0 - 3071
0
0
251 LED2
252
OR - AND
Inst - Latch
0 - 3071
OR
Inst
0
OR
Inst
291
0
Conf igurable LEDs
253
254
0 - 3071
0
255
0 - 3071
0
0
256
0 - 3071
0
0
257 LED3
258
OR - AND
Inst - Latch
0 - 3071
OR
Inst
0
OR
Inst
298
0
Conf igurable LEDs
259
260
0 - 3071
0
261
0 - 3071
0
0
262
0 - 3071
0
0
263 LED4
264
OR - AND
Inst - Latch
0 - 3071
OR
Inst
0
OR
Inst
0
Conf igurable LEDs
265
266
0 - 3071
0
0
267
0 - 3071
0
0
268
0 - 3071
0
0
269
270
271
Plant name
Description
Specif ied by user
ditto
Plant name
no-name
no-data
1
no-name
no-data
1
Memorandum f or user
Relay ID No. f or RSM
Station address f or
IEC103
HDLC
1 - 32
272
273
IEC
0 - 254
2
0
2
0
-
SYADJ
-9999 - 9999
ms
Time sync. Compensation
IP Address of CH#1
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
IP1-1
IP1-2
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
192
168
19
192
168
19
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
IP1-3
IP1-4
172
255
255
255
0
172
255
255
255
0
SM1-1
SM1-2
SM1-3
SM1-4
GW1-1
GW1-2
GW1-3
GW1-4
Subnet Mask of CH#1
Subnet Mask of CH#1
Gateway Address of
CH#1
192
168
19
192
168
19
1
1
⎯ 212 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Default Setting of Relay Series(5A rating / 1A rating)
User
setting
Range
World wide
ENA
3-Winding
№
Name
Units
Contents
2-Winding
101D 102D
3-Winding
201D 202D
5A rating
1A rating
203D
204D
286
287
288
289
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
323
IP2-1
IP2-2
IP2-3
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 255
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
s
IP Address of CH#2
192
168
19
173
255
255
255
0
192
168
19
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
60
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
192
168
19
173
255
255
255
0
192
168
19
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
60
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IP2-4
SM2-1
SM2-2
SM2-3
SM2-4
GW2-1
GW2-2
GW2-3
GW2-4
SI1-1
SI1-2
SI1-3
SI1-4
SI2-1
SI2-2
SI2-3
SI2-4
SI3-1
SI3-2
SI3-3
SI3-4
SI4-1
Subnet Mask of CH#2
Gateway Address of
CH#2
SNTP Server1 Address
SNTP Server2 Address
SNTP Server3 Address
SNTP Server4 Address
SI4-2
SI4-3
SI4-4
SNTP operation mode (foecibly synchronising or not)
GOOSE message interval
Ping check addrs port#1
SMODE
GOINT
PG1-1
PG1-2
PG1-3
PG1-4
PG2-1
PG2-2
PG2-3
PG2-4
1 - 60
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
0 - 254
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Ping check addrs port#2
0
0
CH#1 Communication
protocol
RS-232C baud rate
IEC60870-5-103 baud
rate
324
325
326
PRTCL1
232C
HDLC - IEC103
9.6 - 19.2 - 38.4 - 57.6
9.6 - 19.2
HDLC
9.6
HDLC
9.6
-
-
-
IECBR
19.2
19.2
327
328
329
330
331
332
IECBLK
850BLK
850AUT
TSTMOD
GSECHK
PINGCHK
Normal - Blocked
Normal - Blocked
Off - On
-
-
-
-
-
-
Monitor direction blocked
IEC61850 Block
IEC61850 Authorize
IEC61850 Test mode
GOOSE receive check
Ping check
Normal
Normal
Off
Off
Off
Normal
Normal
Off
Off
Off
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off
Off
Phase indication of Fault
recording
Number of bi-trigger
333 Phase mode
Operating - Fault
0 - 128
Operating
100
Operating
100
-
-
334
BITRN
(on/off) events
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
352
353
354
355
356
357
Time
1OCPS
2OCPS
3OCPS
1OCPG
2OCPG
3OCPG
TRIP1
TRIP2
TRIP3
TRIP4
TRIP5
1OCPS
2OCPS
3OCPS
1OCPG
2OCPG
3OCPG
2F
0.1 - 3.0
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.10 - 20.00
0.05 - 20.00
0.05 - 20.00
0.05 - 20.00
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
s
pu
pu
Disturbance record
OC element for
disturbance recorder
1.0
1.00
1.00
1.0
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
On
On
On
--
--
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
pu initiation
--
--
1.00
1.00
On
pu
pu
pu
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1.00
1.00
Disturbance trigger
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
Metering
Time
On
On
Off
Off
Off
On
On
--
--
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
Primary
Off
0
5F
EVENT1
EVENT2
EVENT3
Off - On
Off - On
Off - On
On
On
On
Primary
Off
358 Display value
Primary - Secondary
Off - IRIG - RSM - IEC - SNTP
-12 - +12
359
360
361
Time sync
GMT
GMTm
hrs Time
min Time
0
0
-59 - +59
0
⎯ 213 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Event record default setting
Default setting
Signal name
Model
No.
Name
Range
Unit
Contents
Sig. NO.
type
101D 102D 201D 201D 203D 204D
1
EV1
EV2
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
Event record signal
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
1536
Mec.Trip1
Mec.Trip2
Mec.Trip3
Mec.Trip4
Trip
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
1537
3
EV3
1538
4
EV4
1539
5
EV5
314
6
EV6
1540
Ind.reset
Event1
7
EV7
1552
8
EV8
1553
Event2
9
EV9
1554
Event3
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
EV10
EV11
EV12
EV13
EV14
EV15
EV16
EV17
EV18
EV19
EV20
EV21
EV22
EV23
EV24
EV25
EV26
EV27
EV28
EV29
EV30
EV31
EV32
EV33
EV34
EV35
EV36
EV37
EV38
EV39
EV40
EV41
EV42
EV43
EV44
EV45
EV46
EV47
EV48
EV49
EV50
EV51
EV52
EV53
EV54
EV55
EV56
EV57
EV58
EV59
EV60
EV61
EV62
EV63
EV64
1251
Relayfail
CT1 err
CT2 err
CT3 err
CT4 err
1267
1268
1269
1270
0
-
9
-
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1258
1438
0
Relayfail-A
Data lost
9
9
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
⎯ 214 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Event record default setting
Default setting
Signal name
Model
No.
Name
Range
Unit
Contents
Sig. NO.
type
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
On
101D 102D 201D 201D 203D 204D
65
66
EV65
EV66
EV67
EV68
EV69
EV70
EV71
EV72
EV73
EV74
EV75
EV76
EV77
EV78
EV79
EV80
EV81
EV82
EV83
EV84
EV85
EV86
EV87
EV88
EV89
EV90
EV91
EV92
EV93
EV94
EV95
EV96
EV97
EV98
EV99
EV100
EV101
EV102
EV103
EV104
EV105
EV106
EV107
EV108
EV109
EV110
EV111
EV112
EV113
EV114
EV115
EV116
EV117
EV118
EV119
EV120
EV121
EV122
EV123
EV124
EV125
EV126
EV127
EV128
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0
67
0
68
0
69
0
70
0
71
0
72
0
73
0
74
0
75
0
76
0
77
0
78
0
79
0
80
0
81
0
82
0
83
0
84
0
0
85
86
0
87
0
88
0
89
0
90
0
91
0
92
0
93
0
94
0
95
0
96
0
97
0
98
0
99
0
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
0
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1448
1449
1450
0
SET.GROUP1
SET.GROUP2
SET.GROUP3
SET.GROUP4
SET.GROUP5
SET.GROUP6
SET.GROUP7
SET.GROUP8
Sys. Set change
Rly. Set change
Grp. Set change
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
0
On
0
On
0
On
0
On
0
On
0
On
1445
0
PLC data CHG
On
9
On
1409
1435
0
LED RST
On
9
9
F.record_CLR
On
On
1436
1437
0
E.record_CLR
D.record_CLR
On
9
9
On
On
0
On
On
0
⎯ 215 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Disturbance record default setting
Default setting
Model
No. Name
Range
Unit
Contents
101D
102D
201D
202D
203D
204D
Signal No. Signal name
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
--
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
--
9
9
9
--
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
--
9
9
9
--
9
9
9
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
SIG1
SIG2
SIG3
SIG4
SIG5
SIG6
SIG7
SIG8
SIG9
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
0 - 3071
disturbance record triger
284
291
298
305
312
330
331
122
123
332
333
334
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
361
0
TRIP-1
TRIP-2
TRIP-3
TRIP-4
TRIP-5
DIFT
HOC
2F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
ditto
5F
10 SIG10 0 - 3071
11 SIG11 0 - 3071
12 SIG12 0 - 3071
13 SIG13 0 - 3071
14 SIG14 0 - 3071
15 SIG15 0 - 3071
16 SIG16 0 - 3071
17 SIG17 0 - 3071
18 SIG18 0 - 3071
19 SIG19 0 - 3071
20 SIG20 0 - 3071
21 SIG21 0 - 3071
22 SIG22 0 - 3071
23 SIG23 0 - 3071
24 SIG24 0 - 3071
25 SIG25 0 - 3071
26 SIG26 0 - 3071
27 SIG27 0 - 3071
28 SIG28 0 - 3071
29 SIG29 0 - 3071
30 SIG30 0 - 3071
31 SIG31 0 - 3071
32 SIG32 0 - 3071
1REF
2REF
3REF
1OC
9
9
--
2OC
3OC
4OC
--
9
9
--
1OCI
2OCI
3OCI
4OCI
1EF
--
9
9
2EF
3EF
--
9
9
--
9
9
9
9
1EFI
2EFI
3EFI
FRQ
V/F
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
THR
Mec.tirp
0
⎯ 216 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PLC default setting
Output
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
On One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Signal
Turn
Off
None
30
90 User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1536 EXT_MEC.TP1
1537 EXT_MEC.TP2
1538 EXT_MEC.TP3
1539 EXT_MEC.TP4
1540 IND.RESET
1541
X
X
X
X
X
[513]BI1_COMMAND
[514]BI2_COMMAND
[515]BI3_COMMAND
[516]BI4_COMMAND
[517]BI5_COMMAND
X
X
X
X
X
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552 EVENT1
1553 EVENT2
1554 EVENT3
1555
X
X
X
[526]BI14_COMMAND
[527]BI15_COMMAND
[528]BI16_COMMAND
X
X
X
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568 PROT_BLOCK
1569 DIF_BLOCK
1570 1REF_BLOCK
1571 1OC_BLOCK
1572 1OCI_BLOCK
1573 1EF_BLOCK
1574 1EFI_BLOCK
1575 2REF_BLOCK
1576 2OC_BLOCK
1577 2OCI_BLOCK
1578 2EF_BLOCK
1579 2EFI_BLOCK
1580 3REF_BLOCK
1581 3OC_BLOCK
1582 3OCI_BLOCK
1583 3EF_BLOCK
1584 3EFI_BLOCK
1585 4OC_BLOCK
1586 4OCI_BLOCK
1587 FRQ_BLOCK
1588 FRQ-A_BLOCK
1589 V/F_BLOCK
1590 V/F-A_BLOCK
1591 THR_BLOCK
1592 THR-A_BLOCK
1593 MEC.TP1_BLOCK
1594 MEC.TP2_BLOCK
1595 MEC.TP3_BLOCK
1596 MEC.TP4_BLOCK
1597
[518]BI6_COMMAND
X
1598
1599
⎯ 217 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
Delay Delay Shot
1600 TP1_DELAY
X
X
X
X
X
[315]TP1
[316]TP2
[317]TP3
[318]TP4
[319]TP5
X
X
X
X
X
200
200
200
200
200
ms
ms
ms
ms
ms
1601 TP2_DELAY
1602 TP3_DELAY
1603 TP4_DELAY
1604 TP5_DELAY
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616 DIF-A_BLOCK
1617 DIF-B_BLOCK
1618 DIF-C_BLOCK
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
⎯ 218 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
⎯ 219 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
⎯ 220 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1792 IO#1-TP1
1793 IO#1-TP2
1794 IO#1-TP3
1795 IO#1-TP4
1796 IO#1-TP5
1797
X
X
X
X
X
[284]TRIP-1
[291]TRIP-2
[298]TRIP-3
[305]TRIP-4
[312]TRIP-5
X
X
X
X
X
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
⎯ 221 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1856
1857
1858
1859
1860
1861
1862
1863
1864
1865
1866
1867
1868
1869
1870
1871
1872
1873
1874
1875
1876
1877
1878
1879
1880
1881
1882
1883
1884
1885
1886
1887
1888
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900
1901
1902
1903
1904
1905
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916
1917
1918
1919
⎯ 222 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1920
1921
1922
1923
1924
1925
1926
1927
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
⎯ 223 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
1984
1985
1986
1987
1988
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
⎯ 224 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
⎯ 225 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
2173
2174
2175
⎯ 226 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2176
2177
2178
2179
2180
2181
2182
2183
2184
2185
2186
2187
2188
2189
2190
2191
2192
2193
2194
2195
2196
2197
2198
2199
2200
2201
2202
2203
2204
2205
2206
2207
2208
2209
2210
2211
2212
2213
2214
2215
2216
2217
2218
2219
2220
2221
2222
2223
2224
2225
2226
2227
2228
2229
2230
2231
2232
2233
2234
2235
2236
2237
2238
2239
⎯ 227 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2240
2241
2242
2243
2244
2245
2246
2247
2248
2249
2250
2251
2252
2253
2254
2255
2256
2257
2258
2259
2260
2261
2262
2263
2264
2265
2266
2267
2268
2269
2270
2271
2272
2273
2274
2275
2276
2277
2278
2279
2280
2281
2282
2283
2284
2285
2286
2287
2288
2289
2290
2291
2292
2293
2294
2295
2296
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301
2302
2303
⎯ 228 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2304
2305
2306
2307
2308
2309
2310
2311
2312
2313
2314
2315
2316
2317
2318
2319
2320
2321
2322
2323
2324
2325
2326
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331
2332
2333
2334
2335
2336
2337
2338
2339
2340
2341
2342
2343
2344
2345
2346
2347
2348
2349
2350
2351
2352
2353
2354
2355
2356
2357
2358
2359
2360
2361
2362
2363
2364
2365
2366
2367
⎯ 229 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2368
2369
2370
2371
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376
2377
2378
2379
2380
2381
2382
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391
2392
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414
2415
2416
2417
2418
2419
2420
2421
2422
2423
2424
2425
2426
2427
2428
2429
2430
2431
⎯ 230 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2432
2433
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438
2439
2440
2441
2442
2443
2444
2445
2446
2447
2448
2449
2450
2451
2452
2453
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465
2466
2467
2468
2469
2470
2471
2472
2473
2474
2475
2476
2477
2478
2479
2480
2481
2482
2483
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
⎯ 231 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
2496
2497
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502
2503
2504
2505
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510
2511
2512
2513
2514
2515
2516
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525
2526
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548
2549
⎯ 232 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
⎯ 233 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624 F.RECORD1
2625 F.RECORD2
2626 F.RECORD3
2627 F.RECORD4
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632 D.RECORD1
2633 D.RECORD2
2634 D.RECORD3
2635 D.RECORD4
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640 SET.GROUP1
2641 SET.GROUP2
2642 SET.GROUP3
2643 SET.GROUP4
2644 SET.GROUP5
2645 SET.GROUP6
2646 SET.GROUP7
2647 SET.GROUP8
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656 CON_TPMD1
2657 CON_TPMD2
2658 CON_TPMD3
2659 CON_TPMD4
2660 CON_TPMD5
2661 CON_TPMD6
2662 CON_TPMD7
2663 CON_TPMD8
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
⎯ 234 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
PROT_COM_RECV
2688 TPLED_RST_RCV
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
2733
2734
2735
2736
2737
2738
2739
2740
2741
⎯ 235 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
2742
2743
2744
2745
2746
2747
2748
2749
2750
2751
2752
2753
2754
2755
2756
2757
2758
2759
2760
2761
2762
2763
2764
2765
2766
2767
2768
2769
2770
2771
2772
2773
2774
2775
2776
2777
2778
2779
2780
2781
2782
2783
2784
2785
2786
2787
2788
2789
2790
2791
2792
2793
2794
2795
2796
2797
2798
2799
2800
2801
2802
2803
2804
2805
2806
2807
2808
2809
2810
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
⎯ 236 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2816 TEMP001
2817 TEMP002
2818 TEMP003
2819 TEMP004
2820 TEMP005
2821 TEMP006
2822 TEMP007
2823 TEMP008
2824 TEMP009
2825 TEMP010
2826 TEMP011
2827 TEMP012
2828 TEMP013
2829 TEMP014
2830 TEMP015
2831 TEMP016
2832 TEMP017
2833 TEMP018
2834 TEMP019
2835 TEMP020
2836 TEMP021
2837 TEMP022
2838 TEMP023
2839 TEMP024
2840 TEMP025
2841 TEMP026
2842 TEMP027
2843 TEMP028
2844 TEMP029
2845 TEMP030
2846 TEMP031
2847 TEMP032
2848 TEMP033
2849 TEMP034
2850 TEMP035
2851 TEMP036
2852 TEMP037
2853 TEMP038
2854 TEMP039
2855 TEMP040
2856 TEMP041
2857 TEMP042
2858 TEMP043
2859 TEMP044
2860 TEMP045
2861 TEMP046
2862 TEMP047
2863 TEMP048
2864 TEMP049
2865 TEMP050
2866 TEMP051
2867 TEMP052
2868 TEMP053
2869 TEMP054
2870 TEMP055
2871 TEMP056
2872 TEMP057
2873 TEMP058
2874 TEMP059
2875 TEMP060
2876 TEMP061
2877 TEMP062
2878 TEMP063
2879 TEMP064
2880 TEMP065
⎯ 237 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
Filename: PGRT100DA000
30
90
User
Norm
Time Value
Up
2881 TEMP066
2882 TEMP067
2883 TEMP068
2884 TEMP069
2885 TEMP070
2886 TEMP071
2887 TEMP072
2888 TEMP073
2889 TEMP074
2890 TEMP075
2891 TEMP076
2892 TEMP077
2893 TEMP078
2894 TEMP079
2895 TEMP080
2896 TEMP081
2897 TEMP082
2898 TEMP083
2899 TEMP084
2900 TEMP085
2901 TEMP086
2902 TEMP087
2903 TEMP088
2904 TEMP089
2905 TEMP090
2906 TEMP091
2907 TEMP092
2908 TEMP093
2909 TEMP094
2910 TEMP095
2911 TEMP096
2912 TEMP097
2913 TEMP098
2914 TEMP099
2915 TEMP100
2916 TEMP101
2917 TEMP102
2918 TEMP103
2919 TEMP104
2920 TEMP105
2921 TEMP106
2922 TEMP107
2923 TEMP108
2924 TEMP109
2925 TEMP110
2926 TEMP111
2927 TEMP112
2928 TEMP113
2929 TEMP114
2930 TEMP115
2931 TEMP116
2932 TEMP117
2933 TEMP118
2934 TEMP119
2935 TEMP120
2936 TEMP121
2937 TEMP122
2938 TEMP123
2939 TEMP124
2940 TEMP125
2941 TEMP126
2942 TEMP127
2943 TEMP128
2944 TEMP129
⎯ 238 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back
Up
№
Turn
Release
Signal
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000
Norm
Time Value
2945 TEMP130
2946 TEMP131
2947 TEMP132
2948 TEMP133
2949 TEMP134
2950 TEMP135
2951 TEMP136
2952 TEMP137
2953 TEMP138
2954 TEMP139
2955 TEMP140
2956 TEMP141
2957 TEMP142
2958 TEMP143
2959 TEMP144
2960 TEMP145
2961 TEMP146
2962 TEMP147
2963 TEMP148
2964 TEMP149
2965 TEMP150
2966 TEMP151
2967 TEMP152
2968 TEMP153
2969 TEMP154
2970 TEMP155
2971 TEMP156
2972 TEMP157
2973 TEMP158
2974 TEMP159
2975 TEMP160
2976 TEMP161
2977 TEMP162
2978 TEMP163
2979 TEMP164
2980 TEMP165
2981 TEMP166
2982 TEMP167
2983 TEMP168
2984 TEMP169
2985 TEMP170
2986 TEMP171
2987 TEMP172
2988 TEMP173
2989 TEMP174
2990 TEMP175
2991 TEMP176
2992 TEMP177
2993 TEMP178
2994 TEMP179
2995 TEMP180
2996 TEMP181
2997 TEMP182
2998 TEMP183
2999 TEMP184
3000 TEMP185
3001 TEMP186
3002 TEMP187
3003 TEMP188
3004 TEMP189
3005 TEMP190
3006 TEMP191
3007 TEMP192
3008 TEMP193
⎯ 239 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Output
Signal
Timing
Cycle
Logic expression
Model 100s Model 200s
Delay Time / Flip Flop
Timer
One
Delay Delay Shot
Flip Flop
Back Release
Signal
№
Turn
Off
On
None
30
90
User
Filename: PGRT100DA000 Norm
Time Value
Up
3009 TEMP194
3010 TEMP195
3011 TEMP196
3012 TEMP197
3013 TEMP198
3014 TEMP199
3015 TEMP200
3016 TEMP201
3017 TEMP202
3018 TEMP203
3019 TEMP204
3020 TEMP205
3021 TEMP206
3022 TEMP207
3023 TEMP208
3024 TEMP209
3025 TEMP210
3026 TEMP211
3027 TEMP212
3028 TEMP213
3029 TEMP214
3030 TEMP215
3031 TEMP216
3032 TEMP217
3033 TEMP218
3034 TEMP219
3035 TEMP220
3036 TEMP221
3037 TEMP222
3038 TEMP223
3039 TEMP224
3040 TEMP225
3041 TEMP226
3042 TEMP227
3043 TEMP228
3044 TEMP229
3045 TEMP230
3046 TEMP231
3047 TEMP232
3048 TEMP233
3049 TEMP234
3050 TEMP235
3051 TEMP236
3052 TEMP237
3053 TEMP238
3054 TEMP239
3055 TEMP240
3056 TEMP241
3057 TEMP242
3058 TEMP243
3059 TEMP244
3060 TEMP245
3061 TEMP246
3062 TEMP247
3063 TEMP248
3064 TEMP249
3065 TEMP250
3066 TEMP251
3067 TEMP252
3068 TEMP253
3069 TEMP254
3070 TEMP255
3071 TEMP256
⎯ 240 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix I
Commissioning Test Sheet (sample)
1. Relay identification
2. Preliminary check
3. Hardware test
3.1 User interface check
3.2 Binary input/Binary output circuit check
3.3 AC input circuit check
4. Function test
4.1 Percentage current differential element DIF test
4.2 2F-lock element check
4.3 5F-lock element check
4.4 High-set overcurrent element HOC test
4.5 Restricted earth fault element REF test
4.6 Overcurrent element test
4.7 Thermal overload element THR test
4.8 Frequency element FRQ test
4.9 Overexcitation element V/F test
5. Protection scheme test
6. Metering and recording check
7. Conjunctive test
⎯ 241 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
1. Relay identification
Type
Serial number
System frequency
Date
Model
Station
Circuit
Engineer
Protection scheme
Active settings group number
Witness
2. Preliminary check
Ratings
CT shorting contacts
DC power supply
Power up
Wiring
Relay inoperative
alarm contact
Calendar and clock
3. Hardware check
3.1 User interface check
3.2 Binary input/Binary output circuit check
Binary input circuit
Binary output circuit
3.3 AC input circuit check
⎯ 242 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4. Function test
4.1 Percentage current differential element DIF test
(1) Minimum operating value test
Tap setting
Measured current
(2) Percentage restraining characteristic test
I
Measured current (I )
2
Tap setting
1
× I
k
× I
k
(3) Operating time test
Tap setting
Test current
Measured time
4.2 2F-lock element check
4.3 5F-lock element check
4.4 High-set overcurrent element HOC test
(1) Minimum operating value test
Tap setting
Measured current
(2) Operating time test
Tap setting
Test current
Measured time
4.5 Restricted earth fault element REF test
I
Measured current (I )
n
Tap setting
a
× I
k
× I
k
⎯ 243 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
4.6 Overcurrent element test
(1) OC element
Element
Tap setting
Tap setting
Test current
Measured current
Measured current
OC
(2) EF element
Element
EF
(3) OCI element
Element
Measured operating time
OCI
2 × I
s
20 × I
s
I : Setting value
s
(4) EFI element
Element
Test current
2 × I
Measured operating time
EFI
s
20 × I
s
4.7 Thermal overload element THR test
Element
Test current
Measured operating time
THR
4.8 Frequency element FRQ test
(1) Frequency
Element
FRQ-L1
FRQ-L2
FRQ-H1
FRQ-H2
Setting
Measured frequency
⎯ 244 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
(2) Undervoltage block
Setting
Measured voltage
4.9 Overexcitation element V/F test
(1) Operating value test
Element
Setting
Measured voltage
V/F
(2) Operating time test
Test voltage
Measured operating time
5. Protection scheme test
Scheme
Results
6. Metering and recording check
7. Conjunctive test
Scheme
On load
Results
Tripping circuit
⎯ 245 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 246 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix J
Return Repair Form
⎯ 247 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
RETURN / REPAIR FORM
Please fill in this form and return it to Toshiba Corporation with the GRT100 to be repaired.
TOSHIBA CORPORATION Fuchu Complex
1, Toshiba-cho, Fuchu-shi, Tokyo, Japan
For: Power Systems Protection & Control Department
Quality Assurance Section
Type: GRT100
Model:
GRT100
(Example: Type:
Model: 101D- 10-A0 )
Product No.:
Serial No. :
Date:
1. Why the relay is being returned ?
† mal-operation
† does not operate
† increased error
† investigation
† others
2. Fault records, event records or disturbance records stored in the relay and relay settings are
very helpful information to investigate the incident.
So please inform us the information concerned in the incident with Floppy Disk, or filling up
the Fault Record sheet and Relay Setting sheet attached.
⎯ 248 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Fault Record
Date/Month/Year Time
/
/
/
:
:
.
(Example: 04/ Nov./ 1997
15:09:58.442)
Faulty phase:
Prefault values (CT ratio:
I :
kA/:
A, VT ratio:
I :
a2
kV/:
V)
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kV or V∠
kA or A
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
a1
I
:
I
:
b2
b1
I :
I :
c2
I
I
I
I
c1
I
I
I
I
11:
12:
21:
22:
:
:
:
:
01
n1
02
n2
I :
a3
I
:
b3
I :
c3
I
I
I
I
:
:
:
:
13
23
03
n3
V:
I :
I
I
I
:
:
:
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
da
d01
d02
d03
I
:
kA or A
kA or A
db
I :
dc
Fault values
(CT ratio:
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kV or V∠
kA or A
kA/:
A, VT ratio:
I :
kV/:
V)
I :
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
kA or A∠
°
°
°
°
°
°
°
a1
a2
I
:
I
:
b1
I :
b2
c2
I :
I
I
I
I
c1
I
I
I
I
11:
12:
21:
22:
:
:
:
:
01
n1
02
n2
I :
a3
I
:
b3
I :
c3
I
I
I
I
:
:
:
:
13
23
03
n3
V:
I :
I
I
I
:
:
:
kA or A
kA or A
kA or A
da
d01
d02
d03
I
:
kA or A
kA or A
db
I :
dc
⎯ 249 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
3. What was the message on the LCD display at the time of the incident.
4. Please write the detail of the incident.
5. Date of the incident occurred.
Day/ Month/ Year:
/
/
/
(Example: 10/ July/ 1998)
6. Please write any comments on the GRT100, including the document.
⎯ 250 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Customer
Name:
Company Name:
Address:
Telephone No.:
Facsimile No.:
Signature:
⎯ 251 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 252 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix K
Technical Data
⎯ 253 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
TECHNICAL DATA
Ratings
AC current
AC voltage
Frequency
DC power supply
1A or 5A
100V, 110V, 115V, 120V
50Hz or 60Hz
110Vdc/125Vdc (Operative range: 88 to 150Vdc)
220Vdc/250Vdc (Operative range: 176 to 300Vdc)
48Vdc/54Vdc/60Vdc (Operative range: 38.4 to 72Vdc)
24Vdc/30Vdc (Operative range: 19.2 to 36Vdc)
maximum 12%
AC ripple on DC supply IEC 60255-11
DC supply interruption IEC 60255-11
Permissive duration of DC supply voltage
interruption to maintain normal operation
maximum 50ms at 110Vdc
less than 10s
Restart time
Binary input circuit DC voltage
110Vdc/125Vdc (Operative range: 88 to 150Vdc)
220Vdc/250Vdc (Operative range: 176 to 300Vdc)
48Vdc/54Vdc/60Vdc (Operative range: 38.4 to 72Vdc)
24Vdc/30Vdc (Operative range: 19.2 to 36Vdc)
Overload rating
AC current input
4 times rated continuous
100 times rated for 1s
2 times rated continuous
2.5 times rated for 1s
AC voltage input
Burden
AC current circuit
0.3VA per phase (at rated 5A)
0.4VA at zero sequence circuit (at rated 5A)
0.1VA per phase (at rated 1A)
0.3VA at zero sequence circuit (at rated 1A)
AC voltage circuit
DC power supply
0.1VA (at rated voltage)
less than 15W (quiescent)
less than 25W(operation)
0.5W/input at 110Vdc
Binary input circuit
Current differential protection
Minimum operate current (ik)
Slope 1 (p1)
0.10 to 1.00pu in 0.01pu steps
10 to 100% in 1% steps
10 to 200% in 1% steps
1.00 to 10.00pu in 0.01pu steps
0 to 330° in 30° steps
Slope 2 (p2)
kp
Vector group compensation
CT ratio correction (Winding 1 to 3) (kct1 – kct3)
Inrush setting (2nd harmonic ratio) (k2f)
Overexcitation setting (5th harmonic ratio) (k5f)
Operating time
0.05 to 50.00 in 0.01 steps
10 to 50% in 1% steps
10 to 100% in 1% steps
typical 35ms
High-set differential overcurrent protection
Overcurrent (kh)
2.00 to 20.00pu in 0.01pu steps
typical 20ms
Operating time
⎯ 254 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Restricted earth fault element
Minimum operating current
Slope 1 (p1)
0.05 to 0.50pu in 0.01pu steps
10 %
Slope 2 (p2)
50 to 100% in 1% steps
0.50 to 2.00pu in 0.01pu steps
1.00 to 50.00 in 0.01 steps
typical 35ms
kp
CT ratio correction (kct)
Operating time
Time-overcurrent protection
High-set overcurrent element
Pick up level (OC, EF)
Delay time (TOC, TEF)
Operating time
0.10 to 20.00pu in 0.10pu steps
0.00 to 10.00s in 0.01s steps
typical 30ms (without delay time)
Inverse time overcurrent element
Pick up level (OCI, EFI)
Time multiplier (TOCI, TEFI)
Characteristic
0.10 to 5.00pu in 0.01pu steps
0.05 to 1.00 in 0.01 steps
Three IEC standard 60255-3 (Standard inverse, Very inverse,
Extremely inverse), or Long-time inverse
*Refer to Appendix P.
Thermal overload protection
Thermal time constant (τ)
Constant (k)
0.5 to 500.0min in 0.1min steps
0.10 to 4.00 in 0.01 steps
Basic current (IB)
0.50 t0 2.50pu in 0.01pu steps
0.00 to 1.00pu in 0.01 steps
0 to 10min in 1min steps
Special load current before overload (Ip)
Time for alarming (TA)
Frequency protection
Overfrequency
50.00 to 55.00Hz in 0.01Hz steps (50Hz relay)
60.00 to 66.00Hz in 0.01Hz steps (60Hz relay)
45.00 to 50.00Hz in 0.01Hz steps (50Hz relay)
54.00 to 60.00Hz in 0.01Hz steps (60Hz relay)
0.00 to 60.00s in 0.01s steps
Underfrequency
Delay time
Start time
less than 100ms
Undervoltage blocking
Overexitation protection
Pickup voltage
40 to 100V in 1V steps
100.0 to 120.0V in 0.1V steps
1.03 to 1.30pu in 0.01pu steps
Alarm level (A)
High level (H)
1.10 to 1.40pu in 0.01pu steps
1.05 to 1.30pu in 0.01pu steps
1 to 600s in 1s steps
Low level (L)
LT (Definite time)
HT (Definite time)
TVFH (Definite time)
TVFA (Definite time)
Start time
1 to 600s in 1s steps
1 to 600s in 1s steps
1 to 600s in 1s steps
less than 130ms
RT (Definite time)
60 to 3600s in 1s steps
⎯ 255 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Accuracy
Current differential element: pick-up
reset
±5%
±5%
±5%
Time-overcurrent protection: pick-up
Inverse time overcurrent characteristics:
Standard inverse, Very and long-time inverse
Extremely inverse
IEC60255-3 class 5
IEC60255-3 class 7.5
Thermal overload protection: pick-up
Frequency protection: pick-up
Overexitation protection
Disturbance record initiation
Overcurrent element
±10%
±0.03Hz
±2% of pick-up voltage (frequency range ±2%)
0.10 to 20.00pu in 0.01pu steps
0.05 to 20.00pu in 0.01pu steps
0.3s (fixed)
Earth fault
Pre-fault time
Post-fault time
0.1 to 3.0s in 0.1s steps
Communication port
Front communication port (local PC)
Connection
Point to point
Cable type
Multi-core (straight)
15m (max.)
Cable length
Connector
RS232C 9-pin D-subminiature connector female
Rear communication port (remote PC)
RS485 I/F:
Transmission data rate for RSM system
Connection
64kbps
Multidrop mode (max. 32 relays)
Screw terminals
Connector
Cable and length
Twisted pair cable, max. 1200m
2kVac for 1min.
Isolation
Fibre optic I/F:
ST connector, graded-index multi-mode 50/125μm or
62.5/125μm type optical fibres
Ethernet LAN I/F:
100BASE-TX: RJ-45 connector
100BASE-FX: SC connector
IRIG-B port
Connection
BNC connector
Cable type
50 ohm coaxial cable
Binary inputs
Operating voltage
Typical 74Vdc(min. 70Vdc) for 110V/125Vdc rating
Typical 138Vdc(min. 125Vdc) for 220V/250Vdc rating
Typical 31Vdc(min. 28Vdc) for 48V/54V/60Vdc rating
Typical 16Vdc(min.15Vdc) for 24V/30Vdc rating
⎯ 256 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Contact ratings
Trip contacts
Make and carry
5A continuously,
30A, 290Vdc for 0.5s (L/R=10ms)
0.15A, 290Vdc (L/R=40ms)
Break
Auxiliary contacts
Make and carry
4A continuously,
10A, 220Vdc for 0.5s (L/R≧5ms)
0.1A, 220Vdc (L/R=40ms)
Break
Durability
Make and carry
Break
10,000 operations minimum
100,000 operations minimum
Mechanical design
Weight
12kg
Case color
Installation
2.5Y7.5/1(approximation to Munsell value)
Flush mounting or rack mounting
⎯ 257 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
CT requirement
The GRT100 does not require the use of dedicated CTs nor the use of CTs with an identical ratio.
The GRT100 can share the CTs with other protections and the different ratios are adjusted by
setting.
The general CT requirements are set for the through-fault stability which comes up when any CTs
saturate under very large through-fault currents. To ensure correct operation of the GRT100 for
such through-fault currents, the factor Ks of each CT is required to satisfy the following
conditions:
Ks ≧1 when Tc ≦150ms
or
Ks ≧5 when Tc ≦200ms
where,
Ks = ratio of CT knee point voltage to CT secondary probable voltage under the maximum
through-fault current
= Vk / {(RCT + RL + RB + RO )(IFmax / CT ratio)}
Tc = d.c. time constant of primary circuit
Vk = knee point voltage of CT
RCT = resistance of CT secondary winding
RL = loop resistance of cable between CT and relay
RB = ohmic load of GRT100 (i.e. 0.1 ohm for 1A rating and 0.012 ohm for 5A rating)
RO = ohmic load of other series-connected relays (if any)
IFmax = maximum through-fault current
For example, if the following parameters are given:
Vk = 800 V, CT ratio = 1,200/1, RCT = 5.0 ohm, RL = 3.0 ohm, RB = 0.1 ohm,
RO = 0 ohm (i.e. no series-connected relays) and IFmax = 40kA
then the factor Ks is calculated as:
Ks = 800/{(5.0 + 3.0 + 0.1)×(40,000/1,200) }
= 800/270
= 3.0
This shows that the GRT100 operates correctly for all the faults under the condition that the d.c.
time constant of the primary circuit is less than 200ms.
⎯ 258 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
ENVIRONMENTAL PERFORMANCE CLAIMS
Test
Standards
Details
Atmospheric Environment
Temperature
IEC60068-2-1/2
Operating range: -10°C to +55°C.
Storage / Transit: -25°C to +70°C.
56 days at 40°C and 93% relative humidity.
IP51 (Rear: IP20)
Humidity
IEC60068-2-78
IEC60529
Enclosure Protection
Mechanical Environment
Vibration
IEC60255-21-1
Response - Class 1
Endurance - Class 1
Shock and Bump
IEC60255-21-2
Shock Response Class 1
Shock Withstand Class 1
Bump Class 1
Seismic
IEC60255-21-3
IEC60255-5
Class 1
Electrical Environment
Dielectric Withstand
2kVrms for 1 minute between all terminals and earth.
2kVrms for 1 minute between independent circuits.
1kVrms for 1 minute across normally open contacts.
High Voltage Impulse
IEC60255-5
Three positive and three negative impulses of 5kV(peak),
1.2/50μs, 0.5J between all terminals and between all terminals
and earth.
Electromagnetic Environment
High Frequency
Disturbance / Damped IEC61000-4-12 /
IEC60255-22-1 Class 3,
1MHz 2.5kV applied to all ports in common mode.
1MHz 1.0kV applied to all ports in differential mode.
Oscillatory Wave
EN61000-4-12
Electrostatic
Discharge
IEC60255-22-2 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-2 / EN61000-4-2
6kV contact discharge, 8kV air discharge.
Radiated RF
Electromagnetic
Disturbance
IEC60255-22-3 Class 3,
Field strength 10V/m for frequency sweeps of 80MHz to 1GHz and
IEC61000-4-3 / EN61000-4-3 1.7GHz to 2.2GHz. Additional spot tests at 80, 160, 450, 900 and
1890MHz.
Fast Transient
Disturbance
IEC60255-22-4,
IEC61000-4-4 / EN61000-4-4
4kV, 2.5kHz, 5/50ns applied to all inputs.
Surge Immunity
IEC60255-22-5,
IEC61000-4-5 / EN61000-4-5
1.2/50μs surge in common/differential modes:
HV ports: 2kV/1kV (peak)
PSU and I/O ports: 2kV/1kV (peak)
RS485 port: 1kV (peak)
Conducted RF
Electromagnetic
Disturbance
IEC60255-22-6 Class 3,
IEC61000-4-6 / EN61000-4-6 Additional spot tests at 27 and 68MHz.
10Vrms applied over frequency range 150kHz to 100MHz.
Power Frequency
Disturbance
IEC60255-22-7,
IEC61000-4-16 /
EN61000-4-16
300V 50Hz for 10s applied to ports in common mode.
150V 50Hz for 10s applied to ports in differential mode.
Not applicable to AC inputs.
Conducted and
IEC60255-25,
Conducted emissions:
Radiated Emissions
EN55022 Class A,
0.15 to 0.50MHz: <79dB (peak) or <66dB (mean)
IEC61000-6-4 / EN61000-6-4 0.50 to 30MHz: <73dB (peak) or <60dB (mean)
Radiated emissions (at 30m):
30 to 230MHz: <30dB
230 to 1000MHz: <37dB
⎯ 259 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Test
Standards
Details
European Commission Directives
89/336/EEC
Compliance with the European Commission Electromagnetic
Compatibility Directive is demonstrated according to EN
61000-6-2 and EN 61000-6-4.
73/23/EEC
Compliance with the European Commission Low Voltage Directive
is demonstrated according to EN 50178 and EN 60255-5.
⎯ 260 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix L
Setting of REF Element
⎯ 261 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Type of transformer
Scheme switch setting
[1REF] = 1I0
[2REF] = 1I0
2ct-1
1ct-1
HV
LV
1nCT
2nCT
1REF
In1
2REF
In2
[1REF] = 2I0
1ct-1
HV
2REF1 = OFF
2REF2 = OFF
2REF3 = OFF
2REF4 = OFF
2REF5 = OFF
1REF
1nCT
LV
In1
3REF1 = OFF
3REF2 = OFF
3REF3 = OFF
3REF4 = OFF
3REF5 = OFF
1ct-2
1ct-1
HV
LV
1REF = 1I0
1nCT
In1
1REF
⎯ 262 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Type of transformer
HV
Scheme switch setting
2REF = 1I0
LV
I02
2ct-1
1REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I2a
I2b
I2c
2nCT
I2N
2REF
1REF = 1I0
2REF = 1I0
3REF = 1I0
1ct-1
HV
MV
2ct-1
I1a
I1b
I1c
I2a
I2b
I2c
1nCT
2nCT
LV
1REF
2REF
I2N
I1N
I3a, I3b, I3c
3REF
3nCT
3ct-1
HV
I3N
1REF = 1I0
2REF = 1I0
1ct-1
MV
2ct-1
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I2a
I2b
I2c
I1a
I1b
I1c
1nCT
2nCT
LV
1REF
2REF
I2N
I1N
⎯ 263 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Type of transformer
Scheme switch setting
1ct-1
HV
MV
1REF = 1I0
3REF = 1I0
I1a
I1b
I1c
1nCT
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
LV
1REF
I1N
3nCT
I3N
3REF
3ct-1
I3a, I3b, I3c
2ct-1
2REF = 1I0
3REF = 1I0
HV
MV
I2a
I2b
I2c
2nCT
1REF1 to 5 = OFF
I2N
LV
3nCT
2REF
I3N
I3a, I3b, I3c
HV
3REF
3ct-1
1REF = 1I0
1ct-1
MV
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I1a
I1b
I1c
1nCT
LV
1REF
I1N
2REF = 1I0
HV
MV
2ct-1
1REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I2a
I2b
I2c
2nCT
LV
2REF
I2N
⎯ 264 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Type of transformer
Scheme switch setting
HV
MV
3REF = 1I0
1REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
LV
3ct-1
3nCT
I3N
3REF
I3a, I3b, I3c
1REF = 2I0
3REF = 1I0
HV
LV
I3a, I3b, I3c
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
I1a
I1b
I1c
I3N
I1N
LV
3REF
1REF
I2a, I2b, I2c
1REF = 2I0
1ct-1
HV
LV
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I1a
I1b
I1c
MV
1nCT
I1N
1REF
1ct-2
I2a, I2b, I2c
1REF = 1I0
2REF = 2I0
2ct-1
MV
HV
I1a, I1b, I1c
1ct-1
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
1nCT
I1N
I2a
I2b
I2c
LV
1REF
2nCT
I2N
2REF
2ct-2
I3a, I3b, I3c
⎯ 265 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Type of transformer
Scheme switch setting
2REF = 2I0
2ct-1
MV
HV
1REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I2a
I2b
I2c
LV
2nCT
I2N
2REF
2ct-2
I3a, I3b, I3c
1REF = 3I0
I1a, I1b, I1c
1ct-1
I2a, I2b, I2c
1ct-2
HV
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
MV
1nCT
I1N
1REF
1ct-3
I3a, I3b, I3c
1REF = 3I0
1ct-1
HV
2REF1 to 5 = OFF
3REF1 to 5 = OFF
I1a
I1b
I1c
MV
1nCT
I1N
1REF
I3a
I3b
I3c
I2a
I2b
I2c
1ct-2
1ct-3
⎯ 266 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix M
Symbols Used in Scheme Logic
⎯ 267 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Symbols used in the scheme logic and their meanings are as follows:
Signal names
Marked with
Marked with
Marked with [
Marked with "
Unmarked
: Measuring element output signal
: Binary signal input from or output to the external equipment
] : Scheme switch
" : Scheme switch position
: Internal scheme logic signal
AND gates
A
B
C
A
1
B
1
C
1
Output
1
0
&
&
&
Output
Output
Output
Other cases
A
B
C
A
1
B
1
C
0
Output
1
0
Other cases
A
B
C
A
1
B
0
C
0
Output
1
0
Other cases
OR gates
A
B
C
A
0
B
0
C
0
Output
≥1
≥1
≥1
0
1
Output
Output
Output
Other cases
A
B
C
A
0
B
0
C
1
Output
0
1
Other cases
A
B
C
A
0
B
1
C
1
Output
0
1
Other cases
⎯ 268 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Signal inversion
A
0
1
Output
A
1
Output
1
0
Timer
Delaye pick-up timer with fixed setting
XXX: Set time
t
0
XXX
XXX
Delayed drop-off timer with fixed setting
XXX: Set time
0
t
t
Delaye pick-up timer with variable setting
XXX - YYY: Setting range
0
XXX - YYY
Delayed drop-off timer with variable setting
XXX - YYY: Setting range
0
t
XXX - YYY
One-shot timer
A
A
Output
Output
XXX - YYY
XXX - YYY: Setting range
Flip-flop
S
0
1
0
1
R
0
0
1
1
Output
No change
S
R
1
0
0
Output
F/F
Scheme switch
A
1
Switch
ON
Output
A
Output
1
0
ON
Other cases
Switch
Output
+
Output
ON
OFF
1
0
ON
⎯ 269 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 270 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix N
Implementation of Thermal Model to
IEC60255-8
⎯ 271 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Implementation of Thermal Model to IEC60255-8
Heating by overload current and cooling by dissipation of an electrical system follow exponential time
constants. The thermal characteristics of the electrical system can be shown by equation (1).
I2
−t
⎛
⎜
⎝
⎞
⎟
⎠
τ
θ =
1− e
×100%
(1)
2
IAOL
where:
θ = thermal state of the system as a percentage of allowable thermal capacity,
I = applied load current,
I
AOL = kI = allowable overload current of the system,
B
τ = thermal time constant of the system.
The thermal stateθis expressed as a percentage of the thermal capacity of the protected system, where 0%
represents the cold state and 100% represents the thermal limit, that is the point at which no further
temperature rise can be safely tolerated and the system should be disconnected. The thermal limit for any
given electrical plant is fixed by the thermal setting IAOL. The relay gives a trip output when θ = 100%.
If current I is applied to a cold system, then θ will rise exponentially from 0% to (I2/IAOL × 100%), with time
2
constant τ, as in Figure N-1. If θ = 100%, then the allowable thermal capacity of the system has been reached.
θ (%)
100%
I 2
I A2OL
×100%
t
I 2
−
τ
⎛
⎞
⎜
⎟
θ
⎝1− e
⎠ ×100%
I 2AOL
=
t (s)
Figure N-1
A thermal overload protection relay can be designed to model this function, giving tripping times
according to the IEC60255-8 ‘Hot’ and ‘Cold’ curves.
I2
⎡
⎢
⎣
⎤
⎥
⎦
t =τ·Ln
(1) ····· Cold curve
(2) ····· Hot curve
I2 − I2AOL
2
I2 − IP
I2 − I2
⎡
⎢
⎤
⎥
t =τ·Ln
⎢
⎣
⎥
⎦
AOL
⎯ 272 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
where:
IP = prior load current.
In fact, the cold curve is simply a special case of the hot curve where prior load current IP = 0, catering for
the situation where a cold system is switched on to an immediate overload.
Figure N-2 shows a typical thermal profile for a system which initially carries normal load current, and is
then subjected to an overload condition until a trip results, before finally cooling to ambient temperature.
θ (%)
Overload Current
Condition
Trip at 100%
100%
Normal Load
Current Condition
Cooling Curve
t (s)
Figure N-2 (1) Thermal Curve without Prior Load Current
θ (%)
Overload Current
Condition
Trip at 100%
100%
Cooling Curve
80%
Normal Load
Current Condition
t (s)
Figure N-2 (2) Thermal curve with Prior Load Current (θ=80%)
⎯ 273 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 274 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix O
IEC60870-5-103: Interoperability and
Troubleshooting
⎯ 275 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC60870-5-103 Configurator
IEC103 configurator software is included in a same CD as RSM100, and can be installed easily as
follows:
Installation of IEC103 Configurator
Insert the CD-ROM (RSM100) into a CDROM drive to install this software on a PC.
Double click the “Setup.exe” of the folder “\IEC103Conf” under the root directory, and operate it
according to the message.
When installation has been completed, the IEC103 Configurator will be registered in the start
menu.
Starting IEC103 Configurator
Click [Start]→[Programs]→[IEC103 Configurator]→[IECConf] to the IEC103 Configurator
software.
Note: The instruction manual of IEC103 Configurator can be viewed by clicking
[Help]→[Manual] on IEC103 Configurator.
IEC60870-5-103: Interoperability
1. Physical Layer
1.1 Electrical interface: EIA RS-485
Number of loads, 32 for one protection equipment
1.2 Optical interface
Glass fibre (option)
ST type connector (option)
1.3 Transmission speed
User setting: 9600 or 19200 bit/s
2. Application Layer
COMMON ADDRESS of ASDU
One COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU (identical with station address)
3. List of Information
The following items can be customized with the original software tool “IEC103 configurator”.
(For details, refer to “IEC103 configurator” manual No.6F2S0812.)
-
Items for “Time-tagged message”: Type ID(1/2), INF, FUN, Transmission condition(Signal
number), COT
-
Items for “Time-tagged measurands”: INF, FUN, Transmission condition(Signal number),
COT, Type of measurand quantities
-
-
Items for “General command”: INF, FUN, Control condition(Signal number)
Items for “Measurands”: Type ID(3/9), INF, FUN, Number of measurand, Type of
measurand quantities
-
Common setting
• Transmission cycle of Measurand frame
⎯ 276 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
• FUN of System function
• Test mode, etc.
CAUTION: To be effective the setting data written via the RS232C, turn off the DC supply of
the relay and turn on again.
3. 1 IEC60870-5-103 Interface
3.1.1 Spontaneous events
The events created by the relay will be sent using Function type (FUN) / Information numbers
(INF) to the IEC60870-5-103 master station.
3.1.2 General interrogation
The GI request can be used to read the status of the relay, the Function types and Information
numbers that will be returned during the GI cycle are shown in the table below.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.3.
3.1.3 Cyclic measurements
The relay will produce measured values using Type ID=3 or 9 on a cyclical basis, this can be read
from the relay using a Class 2 poll. The rate at which the relay produces new measured values can
be customized.
3.1.4 Commands
The supported commands can be customized. The relay will respond to non-supported commands
with a cause of transmission (COT) of negative acknowledgement of a command.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.4.
3.1.5 Test mode
In test mode, both spontaneous messages and polled measured values, intended for processing in
the control system, are designated by means of the CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION ‘test mode’.
This means that CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION = 7 ‘test mode’ is used for messages normally
transmitted with COT=1 (spontaneous) or COT=2 (cyclic).
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.5.
3.1.6 Blocking of monitor direction
If the blocking of the monitor direction is activated in the protection equipment, all indications and
measurands are no longer transmitted.
For details, refer to the standard IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.6.
3.2 List of Information
The followings are the default settings.
⎯ 277 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
List of Information
IEC103 Configurator Default setting
INF
Description
Contents
GI Type
COT
FUN
DPI
Signal No.
ID
OFF ON
Standard Information numbers in monitor direction
System Function
0
0
2
3
4
5
End of General Interrogation Transmission completion of GI items.
--
--
--
--
--
8
6
5
5
5
10
255
255
176
176
176
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
Time Synchronization
Reset FCB
Time Synchronization ACK.
Reset FCB(toggle bit) ACK
Reset CU ACK
8
3
Reset CU
4
Start/Restart
Power On
Relay start/restart
5
Relay power on.
Not supported
Status Indications
If it is possible to use auto-recloser, this item is set
active, if impossible, inactive.
16 Auto-recloser active
Not supported
If protection using telecommunication is available,
this item is set to active. If not, set to inactive.
17 Teleprotection active
18 Protection active
19 LED reset
Not supported
If the protection is available, this item is set to
active. If not, set to inactive.
1, 7, 9, 12,
20, 21
GI
--
1
1
1
1
176
176
1413
1409
1241
1242
1
--
1
1
2
2
2
2
1, 7, 11, 12,
20, 21
Reset of latched LEDs
Block the 103 transmission from a relay to control
system. IECBLK: "Blocked" settimg.
20 Monitor direction blocked
21 Test mode
GI
GI
9, 11
9, 11
176
Transmission of testmode situation froma relay to
control system. IECTST "ON" setting.
176
When a setting change has done at the local, the
event is sent to control system.
22 Local parameter Setting
23 Characteristic1
24 Characteristic2
25 Characteristic3
26 Characteristic4
Not supported
176
1, 7, 9, 11,
12, 20, 21
Setting group 1 active
Setting group 2 active
Setting group 3 active
Setting group 4 active
GI
GI
GI
GI
1
1
1
1
1243
1244
1245
1246
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
1, 7, 9, 11,
12, 20, 21
176
1, 7, 9, 11,
12, 20, 21
176
1, 7, 9, 11,
12, 20, 21
176
27 Auxiliary input1
28 Auxiliary input2
29 Auxiliary input3
30 Auxiliary input4
No
No
No
No
Supervision Indications
32 Measurand supervision I
Zero sequence current supervision
Zero sequence voltage supervision
GI
1
1, 7, 9
176
1271
1
2
33 Measurand supervision V
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
176
35 Phase sequence supervision Negative sequence voltage supevision
36 Trip circuit supervision
37 I>>backup operation
38 VT fuse failure
Output circuit supervision
VT failure
39 Teleprotection disturbed
46 Group warning
CF(Communication system Fail) supervision
Only alarming
GI
GI
1
1
1, 7, 9
1, 7, 9
1258
1252
1
1
2
2
47 Group alarm
Trip blocking and alarming
176
Earth Fault Indications
48 Earth Fault L1
A phase earth fault
B phase earth fault
C phase earth fault
Earth fault forward
Earth fault reverse
No
No
49 Earth Fault L2
50 Earth Fault L3
51 Earth Fault Fwd
52 Earth Fault Rev
No
Not supported
Not supported
⎯ 278 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC103 Configurator Default setting
INF
Description
Contents
GI Type
COT
FUN
DPI
Signal NO.
ID
OFF ON
Fault Indications
64 Start/pick-up L1
65 Start/pick-up L2
66 Start/pick-up L3
67 Start/pick-up N
68 General trip
69 Trip L1
A phase, A-B phase or C-A phase element pick-up
B phase, A-B phase or B-C phase element pick-up
C phase, B-C phase or C-A phase element pick-up
Earth fault element pick-up
No
No
No
No
Any trip
--
2
1, 7
176
1280
--
2
A phase, A-B phase or C-A phase trip
B phase, A-B phase or B-C phase trip
C phase, B-C phase or C-A phase trip
Back up trip
No
70 Trip L2
No
No
71 Trip L3
72 Trip I>>(back-up)
Not supported
Fault location (prim. [ohm] / second. [ohm] / km
selectable by IECFL)
73 Fault location X In ohms
Not supported
74 Fault forward/line
Forward fault
Reverse fault
Not supported
Not supported
75 Fault reverse/Busbar
Teleprotection Signal
transmitted
76
Carrier signal sending
Not supported
Not supported
77 Teleprotection Signal received Carrier signal receiving
78 Zone1
Zone 1 trip
Not supported
79 Zone2
Zone 2 trip
Not supported
80 Zone3
Zone 3 trip
Not supported
81 Zone4
Zone 4 trip
Not supported
82 Zone5
Zone 5 trip
Not supported
83 Zone6
Zone 6 trip
Not supported
84 General Start/Pick-up
85 Breaker Failure
86 Trip measuring system L1
87 Trip measuring system L2
88 Trip measuring system L3
89 Trip measuring system E
90 Trip I>
Any elements pick-up
CBF trip or CBF retrip
No
Not supported
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Inverse time OC trip
91 Trip I>>
Definite time OC trip
92 Trip IN>
Inverse time earth fault OC trip
Definite time earth fault OC trip
93 Trip IN>>
Autoreclose indications
128 CB 'ON' by Autoreclose
CB close command output
Autoreclose block
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
CB 'ON' by long-time
Autoreclose
129
130 Autoreclose Blocked
⎯ 279 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC103 configurator Default setting
INF
Description
Contents
Type
ID
GI
COT
FUN Max. No.
Measurands
144 Measurand I
<meaurand I>
No
0
145 Measurand I,V
146 Measurand I,V,P,Q
147 Measurand IN,VEN
Ib1, Vab measurand <meaurand I>
<meaurand I>
--
3.2
9
2, 7
2, 7
176
176
2
0
0
No
No
<meaurand I>
Measurand IL1,2,3, VL1,2,3,
148
Ia1, Ib1, Ic1, f measurand <meaurand II>
--
9
P,Q,f
Generic Function
240 Read Headings
Not supported
Not supported
Read attributes of all entries
241
of a group
243 Read directory of entry
244 Real attribute of entry
245 End of GGI
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
249 Write entry with confirm
250 Write entry with execute
251 Write entry aborted
Details of MEA settings in IEC103 configurator
Offset Data type
Limit
Lower
Co eff
INF MEA Tb1
Upper
4096
4096
4096
4096
4096
145
148
Ib1
Vab
Ia1
Ia2
Ia3
1
1
1
1
1
28
12
24
28
32
short
short
short
short
short
0
0
0
0
0
1.706666
3.413333
1.706666
1.706666
1.706666
f
2
28
short
0
4096
0.0000833
⎯ 280 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC103 Configurator Default setting
INF
Description
Contents
Type
ID
COM
COT
FUN
Selection of standard information numbers in control direction
System functions
Initiation of general
interrogation
0
--
--
7
6
9
8
255
255
0
Time synchronization
General commands
16 Auto-recloser on/off
Not supported
Not supported
17 Teleprotection on/off
18 Protection on/off
(*1)
ON/OFF
ON
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
176
176
176
176
176
176
19 LED reset
Reset indication of latched LEDs.
Setting Group 1
Setting Group 2
Setting Group 3
Setting Group 4
23 Activate characteristic 1
24 Activate characteristic 2
25 Activate characteristic 3
26 Activate characteristic 4
ON
ON
ON
ON
Generic functions
Read headings of all defined
groups
240
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Not supported
Read values or attributes of all
entries of one group
241
Read directory of a single
entry
243
Read values or attributes of a
single entry
244
General Interrogation of
generic data
245
248 Write entry
249 Write entry with confirmation
250 Write entry with execution
(∗1) Note: While the relay receives the "Protection off" command, " IN SERVICE LED" is off.
Details of Command settings in IEC103 configurator
DCO
Sig off Sig on
INF
Rev
Valid time
0
18
19
23
24
25
26
2686
2686
2688
2640
2641
2642
2643
✓
0
0
0
0
0
200
1000
1000
1000
1000
✓: signal reverse
⎯ 281 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GRT100
supported
Description
Contents
Comment
Basic application functions
Test mode
Yes
Yes
No
Blocking of monitor direction
Disturbance data
Generic services
No
Private data
Yes
Miscellaneous
Measurand
Max. MVAL = rated
value times
Current L1
Ia
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
No
Current L2
Ib
Current L3
Ic
Voltage L1-E
Voltage L2-E
Voltage L3-E
Active power P
Reactive power Q
Frequency f
Va
Vb
Vc
P
No
No
No
Q
No
f
Configurable
Configurable
Voltage L1 - L2
Vab
Details of Common settings in IEC103 configurator
- Setting file’s remark:
GRT100_1.00
- Remote operation valid time [ms]:
- Local operation valid time [ms]:
- Measurand period [s]:
4000
4000
2
- Function type of System functions: 176
- Signal No. of Test mode:
1242
- Signal No. for Real time and Fault number: 1279
⎯ 282 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
[Legend]
GI: General Interrogation (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.4.3)
Type ID: Type Identification (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.1)
1 : time-tagged message
2 : time-tagged message with relative time
3 : measurands I
4 : time-tagged measurands with relative time
5 : identification
6 : time synchronization
8 : general interrogation termination
9 : measurands II
10: generic data
11: generic identification
20: general command
23: list of recorded disturbances
26: ready for transmission for disturbance data
27: ready for transmission of a channel
28: ready for transmission of tags
29: transmission of tags
30: transmission of disturbance values
31: end of transmission
COT: Cause of Transmission (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.3)
1: spontaneous
2: cyclic
3: reset frame count bit (FCB)
4: reset communication unit (CU)
5: start / restart
6: power on
7: test mode
8: time synchronization
9: general interrogation
10: termination of general interrogation
11: local operation
12: remote operation
20: positive acknowledgement of command
21: negative acknowledgement of command
31: transmission of disturbance data
40: positive acknowledgement of generic write command
41: negative acknowledgement of generic write command
42: valid data response to generic read command
43: invalid data response to generic read command
44: generic write confirmation
FUN: Function type (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.5.1)
DPI: Double-point Information (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.6.5)
DCO: Double Command (refer to IEC60870-5-103 section 7.2.6.4)
⎯ 283 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC103 setting data is recommended to be saved as follows:
(1) Naming for IEC103setting data
The file extension of IEC103 setting data is “.csv”. The version name is recommended to be
provided with a revision number in order to be changed in future as follows:
First draft:
Second draft: ∗∗∗∗∗∗_02.csv
Third draft: ∗∗∗∗∗∗_03.csv
∗∗∗∗∗∗_01.csv
Revision number
The name “∗∗∗∗∗∗” is recommended to be able to discriminate the relay type such as GRZ100 or
GRL100, etc. The setting files remark field of IEC103 is able to enter up to 12 one-byte characters.
It is utilized for control of IEC103 setting data.
(2) Saving theIEC103 setting data
The IEC103 setting data is recommended to be saved in external media such as FD (floppy disk) or
CD-R, not to remain in the folder.
⎯ 284 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Troubleshooting
No.
Phenomena
Supposed causes
Check / Confirmation
Procedure
Object
BCU
1
Communication
trouble (IEC103
communication is
not available.)
Address setting is incorrect.
Match address setting between BCU and relay.
Avoid duplication of address with other relay.
RY
Transmission baud rate setting is
incorrect.
BCU
RY
Match transmission baud rate setting between
BCU and relay.
Start bit, stop bit and parity settings of
data that BCU transmits to relay is
incorrect.
BCU
Go over the following settings by BCU. Relay
setting is fixed as following settings.
- Start bit: 1bit
- Stop bit: 1bit
- Parity setting: even
RS485 or optical cable interconnection
is incorrect.
Cable
- Check the connection port.
- Check the interconnection of RS485 A/B/COM
- Check the send and received interconnection of
optical cable.
The setting of converter is incorrect.
(RS485/optic conversion is executed
with the transmission channel, etc.)
Converter In the event of using G1IF2, change the DIPSW
setting in reference to INSTRUCTION MANUAL
(6F2S0794).
The relationship between logical “0/1” of BCU
the signal and Sig.on/off is incorrect. (In
the event of using optical cable)
Check the following;
Logical0 : Sig.on
Logical1:Sig.off
Terminal resistor is not offered.
(Especially when RS485 cable is long.)
cable
BCU
Impose terminal resistor (150[ohms]) to both ends
of RS 485 cable.
Relay cannot receive the requirement
frame from BCU.
Check to secure the margin more than 15ms
between receiving the reply frame from the relay
and transmitting the next requirement frame on
BCU.
(The timing coordination of sending and
receiving switch control is irregular in
half-duplex communication.)
The requirement frame from BCU and
the reply frame from relay contend.
BCU
Check to set the time-out of reply frame from the
relay.
(The sending and receiving timing
coordination is irregular in half-duplex
communication.)
Time-out setting: more than 100ms (acceptable
value of response time 50ms plus
margin)
⎯ 285 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2
HMI does not
display IEC103
event on the SAS
side.
The relevant event sending condition is RY
not valid.
Change the event sending condition (signal
number) of IEC103 configurator if there is a setting
error. When the setting is correct, check the signal
condition by programmable LED, etc.
The relevant event Information Number RY
(INF) and/or Function Type (FUN) may
be different between the relay and SAS.
Match the relevant event Information Number
(INF) or Function Type (FUN) between the relay
and SAS.
SAS
The relay is not initialised after writing
IEC103 configurator setting.
RY
Check the sum value of IEC103 setting data from
the LCD screen. When differing from the sum
value on IEC103 configurator, initialise the relay.
It changes to the block mode.
RY
Change the IECBR settling to Normal.
3
Time can be
BCU does not transmit the frame of time BCU
Transmit the frame of time synchronisation.
synchronised with synchronisation.
IEC103
The settling of time synchronisation
RY
Change the settling of time synchronisation
source to IEC.
communication.
source is set to other than IEC.
(Note) BCU: Bay control unit, RY: Relay
⎯ 286 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix P
IEC61850: MICS & PICS
⎯ 287 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MICS: IEC61850 Model Implementation Conformance Statement
The GRT100 relay supports IEC 61850 logical nodes and common data classes as indicated in the
following tables.
Logical nodes in IEC 61850-7-4
Logical Nodes
GRT100
GGIO
Nodes
GSAL
Yes
GRT100
---
L: System Logical Nodes
LPHD
Common Logical Node
LLN0
P: Logical Nodes for Protection functions
PDIF
PDIR
Yes
Yes
Yes
I: Logical Nodes for Interfacing and archiving
IARC
IHMI
ITCI
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
ITMI
PDIS
---
A: Logical Nodes for Automatic control
PDOP
PDUP
PFRC
PHAR
PHIZ
---
---
---
Yes
---
ANCR
ARCO
ATCC
AVCO
---
---
---
---
M: Logical Nodes for Metering and measurement
PIOC
PMRI
PMSS
POPE
PPAM
PSCH
PSDE
PTEF
PTOC
PTOF
PTOV
PTRC
PTTR
PTUC
PTUV
PUPF
PTUF
PVOC
PVPH
PZSU
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
Yes
---
Yes
Yes
---
---
---
Yes
---
Yes
---
MDIF
MHAI
MHAN
MMTR
MMXN
MMXU
MSQI
MSTA
---
---
---
---
Yes
Yes
Yes
---
S: Logical Nodes for Sensors and monitoring
SARC
SIMG
SIML
---
---
---
---
SPDC
X: Logical Nodes for Switchgear
XCBR
XSWI
T: Logical Nodes for Instrument transformers
TCTR
TVTR
---
---
---
---
Y: Logical Nodes for Power transformers
R: Logical Nodes for protection related functions
YEFN
YLTC
YPSH
YPTR
---
---
---
---
RDRE
---
RADR
RBDR
RDRS
RBRF
RDIR
RFLO
RPSB
RREC
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Z: Logical Nodes for Further power system equipment
ZAXN
ZBAT
ZCAB
ZCAP
ZCON
ZGEN
ZGIL
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
RSYN
C: Logical Nodes for Control
CALH
CCGR
CILO
CPOW
---
---
---
---
---
ZLIN
ZMOT
ZREA
ZRRC
ZSAR
ZTCF
ZTCR
CSWI
G: Logical Nodes for Generic references
GAPC
Yes
⎯ 288 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Common data classes in IEC61850-7-3
Common data classes
GRT100
Status information
SPS
DPS
Yes
---
INS
ACT
ACD
SEC
Yes
Yes
Yes
---
BCR
---
Measured information
MV
CMV
SAV
Yes
Yes
---
WYE
DEL
Yes
---
SEQ
HMV
Yes
---
HWYE
---
HDEL
---
Controllable status information
SPC
DPC
Yes
---
INC
BSC
Yes
---
ISC
---
Controllable analogue information
APC
---
Status settings
SPG
---
ING
Yes
Analogue settings
ASG
CURVE
Yes
---
Description information
DPL
LPL
CSD
Yes
Yes
---
⎯ 289 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
LPHD class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
PhyName
PhyHealth
OutOv
Proxy
InOv
NumPwrUp
WrmStr
WacTrg
PwrUp
PwrDn
PwrSupAlm
RsStat
DPL
INS
SPS
SPS
SPS
INS
INS
INS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPC
Physical device name plate
Physical device health
Output communications buffer overflow
Indicates if this LN is a proxy
Input communications buffer overflow
Number of Power ups
Number of Warm Starts
Number of watchdog device resets detected
Power Up detected
M
M
O
M
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Power Down detected
External power supply alarm
Reset device statistics
T
Common Logical Node class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Mandatory Logical Node Information (Shall be inherited by ALL LN but LPHD)
Mod
Beh
Health
NamPlt
INC
INS
INS
LPL
Mode
Behaviour
Health
M
M
M
M
Y
Y
Y
Y
Name plate
Optional Logical Node Information
Loc
SPS
INS
DPL
INC
INS
INS
Local operation
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
EEHealth
EEName
OpCntRs
OpCnt
External equipment health
External equipment name plate
Operation counter resetable
Operation counter
OpTmh
Operation time
Data Sets (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Inherited and pecialized from Logical Node class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Control Blocks (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Inherited and pecialized from Logical Node class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Services (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Inherited and pecialized from Logical Node class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
⎯ 290 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
LLNO class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
Loc
SPS
INS
Local operation for complete logical device
Operation time
O
O
Y
N
OpTmh
Controls
Diag
SPC
SPC
Run Diagnostics
LED reset
O
O
Y
Y
LEDRs
T
PDIF class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Str
Op
TmAst
ACD
ACT
CSD
Start
Operate
Active curve charactristic
M
M
O
Y
Y
N
T
Measured Values
DifAClc
RstA
WYE
WYE
Differential Current
Restraint Current
O
O
Y
N
Settings
LinCapac
LoSet
ASG
ING
ING
ING
ING
ING
ING
CURVE
Line capacitance (for load currents)
Low operate value, percentage of the nominal current
High operate value, percentage of the nominal current
Minimum Operate Time
Maximum Operate Time
Restraint Mode
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
HiSet
MinOpTmms
MaxOpTmms
RstMod
RsDlTmms
TmACrv
Reset Delay Time
Operating Curve Type
⎯ 291 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PHAR class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
Status Information
Str
INC
ACD
Resetable operation counter
Start
O
N
Y
M
Settings
HarRst
PhStr
PhStop
OpDlTmms
RsDlTmms
ING
ASG
ASG
ING
ING
Number of harmonic restrained
Start Value
Stop Value
Operate Delay Time
Reset Delay Time
O
O
O
O
O
N
Y
N
N
N
PTOC class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Str
Op
TmASt
ACD
ACT
CSD
Start
Operate
Active curve characteristic
M
M
O
Y
Y
N
T
Settings
TmACrv
StrVal
CURVE
ASG
ASG
ING
ING
ING
ING
ING
ING
Operating Curve Type
Start Value
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
TmMult
Time Dial Multiplier
Minimum Operate Time
Maximum Operate Time
Operate Delay Time
Type of Reset Curve
Reset Delay Time
Directional Mode
MinOpTmms
MaxOpTmms
OpDlTmms
TypRsCrv
RsDlTmms
DirMod
⎯ 292 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PTOF class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Str
Op
BlkV
ACD
ACT
SPS
Start
Operate
Blocked because of voltage
M
M
O
Y
Y
Y
T
Settings
StrVal
BlkVal
OpDITmms
RsDITmms
ASG
ASG
ING
ING
Start Value (frequency)
Voltage Block Value
Operate Delay Time
Reset Delay Time
O
O
O
O
Y
Y
Y
N
PTRC class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Tr
Op
Str
ACT
ACT
ACD
Trip
C
C
O
Y
N
N
Operate (combination of subscribed Op from protection functions)
Sum of all starts of all connected Logical Nodes
Settings
TrMod
TrPlsTmms
ING
ING
Trip Mode
Trip Pulse Time
O
O
N
N
Condition C: At least one of the two status information (Tr, Op) shall be used.
⎯ 293 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PTTR class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
Measured Values
Amp
Tmp
TmpRl
LodRsvAlm
LodRsvTr
AgeRat
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
Current for thermal load model
Temperature for thermal load
Relation between temperature and max. temperature
Load reserve to alarm
Load reserve to trip
Ageing rate
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
Status Information
Str
Op
AlmThm
TmTmpSt
TmASt
ACD
ACT
ACT
CSD
CSD
Start
Operate
Thermal Alarm
Active curve characteristic
Active curve characteristic
O
M
O
O
O
Y
Y
Y
N
N
T
Settings
TmTmpCrv
TmACrv
TmpMax
StrVal
OpDlTmms
MinOpTmms
MaxOpTmms
RsDlTmms
ConsTms
AlmVal
CURVE
CURVE
ASG
ASG
ING
ING
ING
ING
ING
Characteristic Curve for temperature measurement
Characteristic Curve for current measurement /Thermal model
Maximum allowed temperature
Start Value
Operate Delay Time
Minimum Operate Time
Maximum Operate Time
Reset Delay Time
Time constant of the thermal model
Alarm Value
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
ASG
PTUF class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Str
Op
BlkV
ACD
ACT
SPS
Start
Operate
Blocked because of voltage
M
M
O
Y
Y
Y
T
Settings
StrVal
BlkVal
OpDlTmms
RsDlTmms
ASG
ASG
ING
ING
Start Value (frequency)
Voltage Block Value
Operate Delay Time
Reset Delay Time
O
O
O
O
Y
Y
Y
N
⎯ 294 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PVPH class
Attribute Name Attr. Type Explanation
T
M/O GRT100
LNName
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
OpCntRs
INC
Resetable operation counter
O
N
Status Information
Str
Op
VHzSt
ACD
ACT
CSD
Start
Operate
Active curve characteristic
M
M
O
Y
Y
N
T
Settings
VHzCrv
StrVal
OpDlTmms
TypRsCrv
RsDlTmms
TmMult
CURVE
ASG
ING
ING
ING
ASG
ING
ING
Operating Curve Type
Volts per hertz Start Value
Operate Delay Time
Type of Reset Curve
Reset Delay Time
Time Dial Multiplier
Minimum Operate Time
Maximum Operate Time
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
MinOpTmms
MaxOpTmms
GAPC class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
Loc
SPS
INC
Local operation
Resetable operation counter
O
O
N
N
OpCntRs
Controls
SPCSO
DPCSO
ISCSO
SPC
DPC
INC
Single point controllable status output
Double point controllable status output
Integer status controllable status output
O
O
O
N
N
N
Status Information
Auto
Str
Op
SPS
ACD
ACT
Automatic operation
Start
Operate
O
M
M
N
Y
Y
T
Setting
StrVal
ASG
Start Value
O
N
⎯ 295 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GGIO class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
EEHealth
EEName
Loc
OpCntRs
Measured values
AnIn
INS
DPL
SPS
INC
External equipment health (external sensor)
External equipment name plate
Local operation
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
Resetable operation counter
MV
Analogue input
O
N
Controls
SPCSO
DPCSO
ISCSO
SPC
DPC
INC
Single point controllable status output
Double point controllable status output
Integer status controllable status output
O
O
O
N
N
N
Status Information
IntIn
Alm
INS
Integer status input
General single alarm
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
SPS
Ind01
Ind02
Ind03
Ind04
Ind05
Ind06
Ind07
Ind08
Ind09
Ind10
Ind11
Ind12
Ind13
Ind14
Ind15
Ind16
Ind17
Ind18
Ind19
Ind20
Ind21
Ind22
Ind23
Ind24
Ind25
Ind26
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
General indication (binary input)
⎯ 296 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MMXN class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
EEHealth
EEName
Measured values
Amp
Vol
Watt
VolAmpr
VolAmp
PwrFact
Imp
INS
DPL
External equipment health (external sensor)
External equipment name plate
O
O
N
N
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
CMV
MV
Current I (rms) not allocated to a phase
Voltage V (rms) not allocated to a phase
Power (P) not allocated to a phase
Reactive Power (Q) not allocated to a phase
Apparent Power (S) not allocated to a phase
Power Factor not allocated to a phase
Impedance
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Hz
Frequency
MMXU class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
EEHealth
INS
External equipment health (external sensor)
O
N
Measured values
TotW
TotVAr
TotVA
TotPF
Hz
PPV
PhV
A
W
VAr
VA
PF
Z
MV
MV
MV
MV
Total Active Power (Total P)
Total Reactive Power (Total Q)
Total Apparent Power (Total S)
Average Power factor (Total PF)
Frequency
Phase to phase voltages (VL1VL2, …)
Phase to ground voltages (VL1ER, …)
Phase currents (IL1, IL2, IL3)
Phase active power (P)
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
MV
DEL
WYE
WYE
WYE
WYE
WYE
WYE
WYE
Phase reactive power (Q)
Phase apparent power (S)
Phase power factor
Phase Impedance
⎯ 297 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MSQI class
Attribute Name
LNName
Attr. Type Explanation
Shall be inherited from Logical-Node Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
T
M/O GRT100
Data
Common Logical Node Information
LN shall inherit all Mandatory Data from Common Logical Node Class
M
EEHealth
EEName
Measured values
SeqA
SeqV
DQ0Seq
ImbA
ImbNgA
ImbNgV
ImbPPV
ImbV
ImbZroA
ImbZroV
MaxImbA
MaxImbPPV
MaxImbV
INS
DPL
External equipment health (external sensor)
External equipment name plate
O
O
N
N
SEQ
SEQ
SEQ
WYE
MV
Positive, Negative and Zero Sequence Current
Positive, Negative and Zero Sequence Voltage
DQ0 Sequence
C
C
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Imbalance current
Imbalance negative sequence current
Imbalance negative sequence voltage
Imbalance phase-phase voltage
Imbalance voltage
Imbalance zero sequence current
Imbalance zero sequence voltage
Maximum imbalance current
MV
DEL
WYE
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
Maximum imbalance phase-phase voltage
Maximum imbalance voltage
Condition C: At least one of either data shall be used.
⎯ 298 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
SPS class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
DataAttribute
status
stVal
q
t
BOOLEAN
Quality
TimeStamp
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
TRUE | FALSE
M
M
M
Y
Y
Y
substitution
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
Quality
VISIBLE STRING64
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
TRUE | FALSE
subID
configuration, description and extension
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
Text
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 13
INS class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
status
stVal
q
t
INT32
Quality
TimeStamp
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
M
M
M
Y(*1)
Y
Y
Substitution
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
INT32
Quality
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
subID
VISIBLE STRING64
configuration, description and extension
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
Text
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 13
(*1): “ENUM” type is also used.
⎯ 299 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
ACT class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
status
general
phsA
phsB
phsC
neut
q
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
Quality
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
M
O
O
O
O
M
M
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
t
TimeStamp
configuration, description and extension
operTm
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
TimeStamp
CF
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
Text
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 13
ACD class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
status
general
dirGeneral
BOOLEAN
ENUMERATED
ST dchg
ST dchg
M
M
Y
Y
unknown | forward | backward |
both
phsA
dirPhsA
phsB
dirPhsB
phsC
dirPhsC
neut
dirNeut
q
t
BOOLEAN
ENUMERATED
BOOLEAN
ENUMERATED
BOOLEAN
ENUMERATED
BOOLEAN
ENUMERATED
Quality
TimeStamp
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
GC_2 (1)
GC_2 (1)
GC_2 (2)
GC_2 (2)
GC_2 (3)
GC_2 (3)
GC_2 (4)
GC_2 (4)
M
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
unknown | forward | backward
unknown | forward | backward
unknown | forward | backward
unknown | forward | backward
M
configuration, description and extension
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
Text
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 13
⎯ 300 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MV class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
DataAttribute
measured values
instMag
mag
range
AnalogueValue
AnalogueValue
ENUMERATED
MX
MX dchg
MX dchg
O
M
O
N
Y
N
normal | high | low | high-high |
low-low |…
q
t
Quality
TimeStamp
MX qchg
MX
M
M
Y
Y
substitution
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
AnalogueValue
Quality
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
subID
VISIBLE STRING64
configuration, description and extension
units
db
Unit
INT32U
INT32U
ScaledValueConfig
RangeConfig
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
see Annex A
0 … 100 000
0 … 100 000
O
O
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
zeroDb
sVC
rangeC
smpRate
d
O
AC_SCAV
GC_CON
O
INT32U
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
Text
O
O
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 21
⎯ 301 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
CMV class
Attribute
Name
DataName
DataAttribute
Attribute Type
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
measured values
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
instCVal
cVal
range
Vector
Vector
ENUMERATED
MX
MX dchg
MX dchg
O
M
O
N
Y
N
normal | high | low | high-high |
low-low |…
q
t
Quality
TimeStamp
MX qchg
MX
M
M
Y
Y
substitution
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
Vector
Quality
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
subID
VISIBLE STRING64
configuration, description and extension
units
db
Unit
INT32U
INT32U
RangeConfig
ScaledValueConfig
ScaledValueConfig
ENUMERATED
INT32U
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
see Annex A
0 … 100 000
0 … 100 000
O
O
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
zeroDb
rangeC
magSVC
angSVC
angRef
smpRate
d
O
GC_CON
AC_SCAV
AC_SCAV
O
V | A | other …
Text
O
O
O
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 21
⎯ 302 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
WYE class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
Data
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
phsA
phsB
phsC
neut
net
res
CMV
CMV
CMV
CMV
CMV
CMV
GC_1
GC_1
GC_1
GC_1
GC_1
GC_1
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
DataAttribute
configuration, description and extension
angRef
ENUMERATED
CF
Va | Vb | Vc | Aa | Ab | Ac | Vab | Vbc
| Vca | Vother | Aother
O
N
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
Text
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 21
SEQ class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
Data
c1
c2
c3
CMV
CMV
CMV
M
M
M
Y
Y
Y
DataAttribute
measured attributes
pos-neg-zero | dir-quad-zero
configuration, description and extension
seqT
ENUMERATED
MX
M
Y
phsRef
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
ENUMERATED
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
A | B | C | …
Text
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 21
⎯ 303 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
SPC class
Attribute
Name
DataName
DataAttribute
Attribute Type
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
control and status
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
ctlVal
operTm
origin
ctlNum
SBO
BOOLEAN
TimeStamp
Originator
INT8U_RO
CO
CO
CO, ST
CO, ST
CO
off (FALSE) | on (TRUE)
AC_CO_M
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_O
N
N
Y
N
N
0..255
VISIBLE STRING65
AC_CO_SBO_N_
M
SBOw
SBOW
CO
AC_CO_SBOW_E
_M
N
Oper
Cancel
Oper
Cancel
CO
CO
AC_CO _M
AC_CO_SBO_N_
M and
Y
N
AC_CO_SBOW_E
_M and
AC_CO_TA_E_M
stVal
q
t
BOOLEAN
Quality
TimeStamp
BOOLEAN
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
FALSE | TRUE
AC_ST
AC_ST
AC_ST
Y
Y
Y
N
stSeld
ST dchg
AC_CO_O
substitution
FALSE | TRUE
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
BOOLEAN
Quality
VISIBLE STRING64
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
subID
configuration, description and extension
pulseConfig
CtlModel
sboTimeout
sboClass
d
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
PulseConfig
CtlModels
INT32U
SboClasses
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
CF
CF
CF
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
AC_CO_O
M
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_O
O
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Text
O
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 31
⎯ 304 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
INC class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
DataAttribute
control and status
ctlVal
operTm
origin
ctlNum
SBO
SBOw
Oper
INT32
CO
CO
CO, ST
CO, ST
CO
AC_CO_M
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_O
Y(*2)
N
N
N
N
TimeStamp
Originator
INT8U
VISIBLE STRING65
SBOW
0..255
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_SBO_N_M
AC_CO_SBOW_E_M
AC_CO _M
CO
CO
N
N
Oper
Cancel
Cancel
CO
AC_CO_SBO_N_M
and
N
AC_CO_SBOW_E_M
and AC_CO_TA_E_M
stVal
Q
T
INT32
Quality
TimeStamp
BOOLEAN
ST dchg
ST qchg
ST
M
M
M
Y
Y
Y
N
stSeld
ST dchg
AC_CO_O
substitution
subEna
subVal
subQ
BOOLEAN
INT32
Quality
SV
SV
SV
SV
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
PICS_SUBST
N
N
N
N
FALSE | TRUE
subID
VISIBLE STRING64
configuration, description and extension
CtlModel
sboTimeout
sboClass
minVal
maxVal
stepSize
D
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
CtlModels
INT32U
SboClasses
INT32
INT32
INT32U
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
M
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
AC_CO_O
AC_CO_O
O
O
O
O
O
1 … (maxVal – minVal)
Text
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 31
(*2): “ENUM” type is used.
⎯ 305 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
ING class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
DataAttribute
setting
setVal
setVal
INT32
INT32
SP
SG, SE
AC_NSG_M
AC_SG_M
Y(*3)
N
configuration, description and extension
minVal
maxVal
stepSize
d
INT32
INT32
INT32U
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
CF
CF
O
O
O
O
O
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
1 … (maxVal – minVal)
Text
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 39
(*3): “ENUM” type is also used.
ASG class
Attribute
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
Name
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
setting
setMag
setMag
AnalogueValue
AnalogueValue
SP
SG, SE
AC_NSG_M
AC_SG_M
Y
N
configuration, description and extension
units
sVC
minVal
maxVal
stepSize
d
Unit
CF
CF
CF
CF
CF
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
see Annex A
O
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
ScaledValueConfig
AnalogueValue
AnalogueValue
AC_SCAV
O
O
O
O
O
AnalogueValue
1 … (maxVal – minVal)
Text
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
dU
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 42
⎯ 306 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
DPL class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
configuration, description and extension
DC
vendor
hwRev
swRev
serNum
model
location
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
M
O
O
O
O
O
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
DC
DC
DC
DC
DC
EX
EX
EX
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
As defined in Table 45
LPL class
Attribute
Name
Attribute Type
FC
TrgOp
Value/Value Range
M/O/C
GRT100
DataName
DataAttribute
Inherited from Data Class (see IEC 61850-7-2)
configuration, description and extension
DC
vendor
swRev
d
dU
configRev
ldNs
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
UNICODE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
M
M
M
O
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
DC
DC
DC
DC
EX
AC_LN0_M
AC_LN0_EX
shall be included in LLN0 only;
for example "IEC
61850-7-4:2003"
lnNs
cdcNs
cdcName
dataNs
Services
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
VISIBLE STRING255
EX
EX
EX
EX
AC_DLD_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLNDA_M
AC_DLN_M
N
N
N
N
As defined in Table 45
⎯ 307 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PICS: IEC61850 ASCI Conformance Statement
Client/
subscriber publisher
Server/
GRT10
0
Remarks
Client-server roles
B11
Server side (of TWO-PARTY-
APPLICATION-ASSOCIATION)
Client side of (TWO-PARTY-
APPLICATION-ASSOCIATION)
-
c1
-
Y
-
B12
c1
SCSMs supported
B21
B22
B23
B24
SCSM: IEC61850-8-1 used
Y
N
N
-
SCSM: IEC61850-9-1 used
SCSM: IEC61850-9-2 used
SCSM: other
Generic substation event model (GSE)
B31
B32
Publisher side
Subscriber side
-
O
O
-
Y
Y
Transmission of sampled value model (SVC)
B41
B42
Publisher side
Subscriber side
-
O
O
-
N
N
If Server side (B11) supported
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
Logical device
Logical node
Data
Data set
Substitution
c2
c3
c4
c5
O
c2
c3
c4
c5
O
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Setting group control
Reporting
O
O
M7
Buffered report control
sequence-number
report-time-stamp
reason-for-inclusion
data-set-name
data-reference
buffer-overflow
entryID
O
O
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
M7-1
M7-2
M7-3
M7-4
M7-5
M7-6
M7-7
M7-8
M7-9
BufTm
IntgPd
M7-10 GI
Unbuffered report control
O
O
M8-1
M8-2
M8-3
M8-4
M8-5
M8-6
M8-7
M8-8
sequence-number
report-time-stamp
reason-for-inclusion
data-set-name
data-reference
BufTm
IntgPd
GI
Logging
Log control
IntgPd
O
O
O
O
M9
M9-1
M10
M11
Log
Control
O
M
O
M
If GSE (B31/B32) is supported
GOOSE
O
O
Y
M12-1 entryID
⎯ 308 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
M12-2 DataRefInc
M13 GSSE
If SVC (B41/B42) is supported
O
O
N
M14
M15
M16
M17
Server
S1
Multicast SVC
Unicast SVC
Time
O
O
M
O
O
O
M
O
N
N
Y
Y
File Transfer
ServerDirectory
M
Y
Application association
S2
S3
S4
Associate
Abort
Release
M
M
M
M
M
M
Y
Y
Y
Logical device
S5
LogicalDeviceDirectory
M
M
Y
Logical node
S6
S7
LogicalNodeDirectory
GetAllDataValues
M
O
M
M
Y
Y
Data
S8
S9
GetDataValues
SetDataValues
GetDataDirectory
GetDataDefinition
M
O
O
O
M
O
M
M
Y
N
Y
Y
S10
S11
Data set
S12
S13
S14
S15
S16
GetDataSetValues
SetDataSetValues
CreateDataSet
DeleteDataSet
GetDataSetDirectory
O
O
O
O
O
M
O
O
O
O
Y
N
N
N
Y
Substitution
S17
SetDataValues
M
M
N
Setting group control
S18
S19
S20
S21
S22
S23
SelectActiveSG
SelectEditSG
SetSGValues
ConfirmEditSGValues
GetSGValues
GetSGCBValues
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Reporting
Buffered report control block (BRCB)
S24
Report
c6
c6
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
S24-1
S24-2
S24-3
S25
data-change (dchg)
quality-change (qchg)
data-update (dupd)
GetBRCBValues
SetBRCBValues
c6
c6
c6
c6
S26
Unbuffered report control block (BRCB)
S27
Report
c6
c6
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
S27-1
S27-2
S27-3
S28
data-change (dchg)
quality-change (qchg)
data-update (dupd)
GetURCBValues
SetURCBValues
c6
c6
c6
c6
S29
Logging
Log control block
S30 GetLCBValues
M
M
N
⎯ 309 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
S31
Log
S32
S33
S34
SetLCBValues
O
M
N
QueryLogByTime
QueryLogAfter
GetLogStatusValues
c7
c7
M
M
M
M
N
N
N
Generic substation event model (GSE)
GOOSE-CONTROL-BLOCK
S35
S36
S37
S38
S39
SendGOOSEMessage
GetGoReference
GetGOOSEElementNumber
GetGoCBValues
c8
O
O
O
O
c8
c9
c9
O
Y
N
N
Y
Y
SetGoCBValues
O
GSSE-CONTROL-BLOCK
S40
S41
S42
S43
S44
SendGSSEMessage
GetGsReference
GetGSSEElementNumber
GetGsCBValues
c8
O
O
O
O
c8
c9
c9
O
N
N
N
N
N
SetGsCBValues
O
Transmission of sampled value model (SVC)
Multicast SVC
S45
S46
S47
SendMSVMessage
GetMSVCBValues
SetMSVCBValues
c10
O
O
c10
O
O
N
N
N
Unicast SVC
S48
S49
S50
SendUSVMessage
GetUSVCBValues
SetUSVCBValues
c10
O
O
c10
O
O
N
N
N
Control
S51
S52
S53
S54
Select
SelectWithValue
Cancel
Operate
CommandTermination
TimeActivatedOperate
M
M
O
M
M
O
O
O
O
M
O
O
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
S55
S56
File Transfer
S57
S58
S59
S60
Time
T1
GetFile
SetFile
DeleteFile
GetFileAttributeValues
O
O
O
O
M
O
O
O
Y
N
N
Y
Time resolution of internal clock
Time accuracy of internal clock
Supported TimeStamp resolution
1ms
1ms
1ms
T2
T3
T1
M – Mandatory
O – Optional
c1 – shall be ‘M’ if support for LOGICAL-DEVICE model has been declared.
c2 – shall be ‘M’ if support for LOGICAL-NODE model has been declared.
c3 – shall be ‘M’ if support for DATA model has been declared.
c4 – shall be ‘M’ if support for DATA-SET, Substitution, Report, Log Control, or Time model has been declared.
c5 – shall be ‘M’ if support for Report, GSE, or SV models has been declared.
c6 – shall declare support for at least one (BRCB or URCB)
c7 – shall declare support for at least one (QueryLogByTime or QueryLogAfter).
c8 – shall declare support for at least one (SendGOOSEMessage or SendGSSEMessage)
c9 – shall declare support if TWO-PARTY association is available.
⎯ 310 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
c10 – shall declare support for at least one (SendMSVMessage or SendUSVMessage).
⎯ 311 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
PICS for A-Profile support
Client Server
F/S F/S
A-Profile Profile Description
shortcut
GRT100
Remarks
A1
A2
Client/server A-Profile
GOOSE/GSE
c1
c2
c1
c2
Y
Y
management A-Profile
GSSE A-Profile
TimeSync A-Profile
A3
A4
c3
c4
c3
c4
N
Y
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if support for any service specified in Table 2 are declared within the ACSI basic conformance statement.
c2 Shall be ‘m’ if support for any service specified in Table 6 are declared within the ACSI basic conformance statement.
c3 Shall be ‘m’ if support for any service specified in Table 9 are declared within the ACSI basic conformance statement.
c4 Support for at least one other A-Profile shall be declared (e.g. in A1-A3) in order to claim conformance to IEC 61850-8-1.
PICS for T-Profile support
A-Profile Profile Description
shortcut
Client
F/S
Server
F/S
GRT100
Remarks
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
TCP/IP T-Profile
OSI T-Profile
GOOSE/GSE T-Profile
GSSE T-Profile
c1
c2
c3
c4
o
c1
c2
c3
c4
o
Y
N
Y
N
Y
TimeSync T-Profile
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if support for A1 is declared. Otherwise, shall be 'i'.
c2 Shall be ‘o’ if support for A1 is declared. Otherwise, shall be 'i'.
c3 Shall be ‘m’ if support for A2 is declared. Otherwise, shall be 'i.
c4 Shall be ‘m’ if support for A3 is declared. Otherwise, shall be 'i.
⎯ 312 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MMS InitiateRequest general parameters
Client-CR
Server-CR
InitiateRequest
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
InitiateRequest
localDetailCalling
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Y
Y
proposedMaxServOutstandingCalling
proposedMaxServOustandingCalled
initRequestDetail
1 or greater
1 or greater
1 or greater
1 or greater
InitiateRequestDetail
proposedVersionNumber
m
m
m
m
m
x
shall be 2.1
m
m
m
m
m
x
shall be 2.1
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
proposedParameterCBB
servicesSupportedCalling
additionalSupportedCalling
additionalCbbSupportedCalling
privilegeClassIdentityCalling
c1 Conditional upon Parameter CBB CSPI
m
m
c1
c1
c1
c1
c1
c1
x
x
x
x
MMS InitiateResponse general parameters
Client-CR
Server-CR
InitiateRequest
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
InitiateResponse
localDetailCalled
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Y
Y
negotiatedMaxServOutstandingCalling
negotiatedMaxServOustandingCalled
initResponseDetail
1 or greater
1 or greater
1 or greater
1 or greater
InitiateResponseDetail
negotiatedVersionNumber
negotiatedParameterCBB
servicesSupportedCalled
m
m
m
m
m
x
shall be 2.1
m
m
m
m
m
x
shall be 2.1
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
m
m
additionalSupportedCalled
additionalCbbSupportedCalled
privilegeClassIdentityCalled
c1 Conditional upon Parameter CBB CSPI
c1
c1
c1
c1
c1
c1
x
x
x
x
⎯ 313 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
MMS service supported conformance table
Client-CR
Server-CR
MMS service supported CBB
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
status
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
i
o
o
m
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
m
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
getNameList
c1
identify
m
rename
o
read
c2
write
c3
getVariableAccessAttributes
defineNamedVariable
defineScatteredAccess
getScatteredAccessAttributes
deleteVariableAccess
defineNamedVariableList
getNamedVariableListAttributes
deleteNamedVariableList
defineNamedType
getNamedTypeAttributes
deleteNamedType
input
c4
o
i
i
i
o
o
o
o
i
o
o
c5
c6
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
output
i
i
takeControl
i
i
relinquishControl
i
i
defineSemaphore
deleteSemaphore
reportPoolSemaphoreStatus
reportSemaphoreStatus
initiateDownloadSequence
downloadSegment
terminateDownloadSequence
initiateUploadSequence
uploadSegment
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
terminateUploadSequence
requestDomainDownload
requestDomainUpload
loadDomainContent
storeDomainContent
deleteDomain
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
c14
i
getDomainAttributes
createProgramInvocation
o
i
⎯ 314 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Client-CR
Server-CR
MMS service supported CBB
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
deleteProgramInvocation
start
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
m
o
o
o
i
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
m
o
o
o
i
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
i
i
stop
i
i
resume
i
i
reset
i
i
kill
i
i
getProgramInvocationAttributes
obtainFile
i
i
c9
c9
defineEventCondition
deleteEventCondition
getEventConditionAttributes
reportEventConditionStatus
alterEventConditionMonitoring
triggerEvent
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
defineEventAction
deleteEventAction
alterEventEnrollment
reportEventEnrollmentStatus
getEventEnrollmentAttributes
acknowledgeEventNotification
getAlarmSummary
getAlarmEnrollmentSummary
readJournal
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
c13
o
c13
writeJournal
o
initializeJournal
reportJournalStatus
createJournal
o
c12
i
i
i
i
i
deleteJournal
i
fileOpen
c8
c8
c8
i
c8
c8
c8
i
fileRead
fileClose
fileRename
fileDelete
c9
c11
i
c9
c11
i
fileDirectory
unsolicitedStatus
informationReport
eventNotification
attachToEventCondition
attachToSemaphore
conclude
c7
i
c7
i
i
i
i
i
m
o
m
m
c10
c10
cancel
getDataExchangeAttributes
exchangeData
c10
c10
⎯ 315 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Client-CR
Server-CR
MMS service supported CBB
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
defineAccessControlList
getAccessControlListAttributes
reportAccessControlledObjects
deleteAccessControlList
alterAccessControl
o
o
o
o
o
o
c10
c10
c10
c10
c10
c10
o
o
o
o
o
o
c10
c10
c10
c10
c10
c10
N
N
N
N
N
N
reconfigureProgramInvocation
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if logical device or logical node model support is declared in ACSI basic conformance statement.
c2 Shall be ‘m’ if logical node model support is declared in ACSI basic conformance statement or if support for the MMS
write service is declared.
c3 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI support for SetDataValues service is declared or implied.
c4 Shall be ‘m’ if logical node model support is declared in ACSI basic conformance statement.
c5 Shall be ‘m’ if data set support is declared in the ACSI basic conformance statement.
c6 Shall be ‘m’ if support for defineNamedVariableList is declared.
c7 Shall be 'm' if support for ACSI Report or ACSI command termination is declared.
c8 Shall be 'm' if support for ACSI GetFile is declared.
c9 Shall be 'm' if support for ACSI SetFile is declared.
c10 Shall not be present since MMS minor version is declared to be 1.
c11 Shall be 'm' if support for ACSI GetFileAttributeValues is declared.
c12 Shall be 'm' if support for the ACSI log model is declared.
c13 Shall be 'm' if support for the ACSI QueryLogByTime or QueryLogAfter is declared.
c14 Shall be 'm' if support for the ACSI logical device model is declared.
MMS Parameter CBB
Client-CR
Server-CR
MMS parameter CBB
GRT100
Base
F/S
Value/range Base F/S Value/range
STR1
STR2
NEST
VNAM
VADR
VALT
bit
o
o
1
o
o
o
x
o
o
x
x
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
1
o
o
o
x
o
o
x
x
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
c1
o
Y
N
o
1 or greater
c2
c1
o
Y(10)
Y
o
o
N
o
c1
x
Y
x
N
TPY
o
o
N
VLIS
bit
c1
x
c3
x
Y
N
bit
x
x
N
CEI
i
i
N
ACO
SEM
CSR
CSNC
CSPLC
CSPI
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
c4
N
N
N
N
N
N
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI logical node model support declared.
c2 Shall be five(5) or greater if ACSI logical node model support is declared.
c3 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI data set, reporting, GOOSE, or logging model support is declared.
c4 Shall not be present. Receiving implementations shall assume not supported.
⎯ 316 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GetNameList conformance statement
Client-CR Server-CR
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
GetNameList
GRT100
Request
ObjectClass
ObjectScope
DomainName
ContinueAfter
Response+
m
m
o
m
m
o
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Y
Y
o
m
List Of Identifier
MoreFollows
Response-
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Error Type
m
m
m
m
Y
NOTE Object class ‘vmd' (formerly VMDSpecific in MMS V1.0) shall not appear. If a request contains this ObjectClass,
an MMS Reject shall be issued.
AlternateAccessSelection conformance statement
Not applicable.
VariableAccessSpecification conformance statement
Client-CR
Base F/S Value/range
Server-CR
Base F/S Value/range
VariableAccessSpecification
GRT100
listOfVariable
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
c1
c1
c1
c2
Y
Y
Y
Y
variableSpecification
alternateAccess
variableListName
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI support for Logical Node Model is declared.
c2 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI support for ACSI DataSets, reporting, or logging is declared.
VariableSpecification conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
VariableSpecification
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S
Value/range
name
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
x
x
o
o
o
o
o
m
i
Y
N
N
N
N
address
variableDescription
scatteredAccessDescription
invalidated
i
x
x
⎯ 317 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Read conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
Base F/S Value/range
Read
GRT100
Base F/S
Value/range
Request
specificationWithResult
variableAccessSpecification
Response
o
o
o
m
m
Y
Y
m
m
m
variableAccessSpecification
listOfAccessResult
o
o
o
m
m
Y
Y
m
m
m
Write conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
Write
GRT100
Base F/S
Value/range
Base F/S
Value/range
Request
variableAccessSpecification
listOfData
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Response
failure
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
success
InformationReport conformance statement
Client-CR Server-CR
InformationReport
GRT100
Base
F/S
Value/range
Base
F/S
Value/range
Request
variableAccessSpecification
listOfAccessResult
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
GetVariableAccessAttributes conformance statement
GetVariableAccessAttribute
Client-CR
Base F/S Value/range
Server-CR
Base F/S Value/range
GRT100
s
Request
name
o
o
o
o
m
m
m
x
Y
N
address
Response
mmsDeletable
address
m
o
m
x
m
o
m
x
Y
N
Y
typeSpecification
m
m
m
m
DefineNamedVariableList conformance statement
Not applicable.
⎯ 318 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GetNamedVariableListAttributes conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
GetNamedVariableListAttributes
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S Value/range
Request
ObjectName
Response
m
m
m
m
Y
mmsDeletable
listOfVariable
variableSpecification
alternateAccess
m
m
m
o
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
o
m
m
m
i
Y
Y
Y
N
DeleteNamedVariableList conformance statement
ReadJournal conformance statement
Not applicable.
Not applicable.
Not applicable.
Not applicable.
JournalEntry conformance statement
InitializeJournal conformance statement
FileDirectory conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
Value/range
FileDirectory
GRT100
Base F/S Value/range Base F/S
Request
filespecification
continueAfter
Response+
o
o
o
o
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
listOfDirectoryEntry
MoreFollows
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
FileOpen conformance statement
Client-CR
Base F/S
Server-CR
Value/range Base F/S Value/range
FileOpen
GRT100
Request
filename
m
o
m
o
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
initialPosition
Response+
frsmID
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
fileAttributes
⎯ 319 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
FileRead conformance statement
Client-CR
Base F/S
Server-CR
Value/range Base F/S Value/range
FileRead
GRT100
Y
Request
frsmID
m
m
m
m
Response+
fileData
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
MoreFollows
FileClose conformance statement
Client-CR
Server-CR
FileClose
GRT100
Base F/S
Value/range Base F/S
Value/range
Request
frsmID
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
Y
Y
Response+
GOOSE conformance statement
Subscriber
Publisher
Value/comment
GRT100
GOOSE Services
c1
m
o
c1
m
c3
c4
o
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
SendGOOSEMessage
GetGoReference
GetGOOSEElementNumber
GetGoCBValues
o
o
SetGoCBValues
o
o
GSENotSupported
c2
c5
GOOSE Control Block (GoCB)
o
o
c1 Shall be ‘m’ if support is declared within ACSI basic conformance statement.
c2 Shall be ‘m’ if ACSI basic conformance support for either GetGoReference or GetGOOSEElementNumber is declared.
c3 Shall be ‘m’ if support for ACSI basic conformance of GetGoReference is declared.
c4 Shall be ‘m’ if support for ACSI basic conformance of GetGOOSEElementNumber.
c5 Shall be ‘m’ if no support for ACSI basic conformance of GetGOOSEElementNumber is declared.
GSSE conformance statement
Not applicable.
⎯ 320 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 321 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix Q
Inverse Time Characteristics
⎯ 322 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC/UK Inverse Curves (VI)
(Time Multiplier TMS = 0.1 - 1.5)
IEC/UK Inverse Curves (NI)
(Time Multiplier TMS = 0.1 - 1.5)
100
100
10
1
10
TMS
TMS
1.5
1.
1.5
1.0
1
0.5
0.5
0.2
0.1
0.1
0.2
0.1
0.01
0.1
1
10
100
1
10
100
Current (Multiple of Setting)
Current (Multiple of Setting)
Normal Inverse
Very Inverse
⎯ 323 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
IEC/UK Inverse Curves (EI)
(Time Multiplier TMS = 0.1 - 1.5)
1000
100
10
UK Inverse Curves (LTI)
(Time Multiplier TMS = 0.1 - 1.5)
1000
100
10
1
TMS
TMS
1.5
1.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.5
0.1
0.2
0.1
1
0.2
0.1
0.1
0.01
1
10
100
1
10
100
Current (Multiple of Setting)
Current (Multiple of Setting)
Extremely Inverse
Long Time Inverse
⎯ 324 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
⎯ 325 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix R
Failed Module Tracing and Replacement
⎯ 326 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
1. Failed module tracing and its replacement
If the “ALARM” LED is ON, the following procedure is recommended. If not repaired, contact
the vendor.
Procedure
Countermeasure
No
No
No failure
“ALARM” LED ON?
Not displayed
Contact the vendor.
Press [VIEW] key
Yes
Any LCD messages?
Yes
Not displayed
Press [VIEW] key
Contact the vendor.
Locate the failed module referring to Table R-1.
Locate the failed module.
DC supply “OFF”
Caution: Check that the replacement module has an
identical module name (VCT, SPM, IO1,
IO2, etc.) and hardware type-form as the
failed module. Furthermore, the SPM
module must have the same software
name and version. Refer to Section
4.2.5.1.
Module replacement
DC supply “ON”
As shown in the table, some of the messages cannot
identify the fault location definitely but suggest plural
possible failure locations. In these cases, the failure
location is identified by replacing the suggested
failed modules with spare modules one by one until
the "ALARM" LED is turned off.
No
“ALARM” LED OFF?
If both “IN SERVICE” LED and “ALARM” LED are
OFF, check the followings.
Check: Is DC supply voltage available with the correct
polarity and of adequate magnitude, and
connected to the correct terminals?
End
⎯ 327 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Table R-1 LCD Message and Failure Location
Message
Failure location
VCT
SPM
IO1 or
IO8
IO2
IO3
HMI
AC
LAN
PLC,
cable cable/ IEC61850
network
data
Checksum err
ROM data err
ROM-RAM err
SRAM err
CPU err
×
×
×
×
×
Invalid err
NMI err
×
×
BU-RAM err
EEPROM err
A/D err
×
×
×
Sampling err
CT1 err
×
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (2)
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
CT2 err
CT3 err
DIO err
× (1)
× (1)
× (1)
RSM err
× (2)
LCD err
×
DC supply off
RTC err
×
×
×
PCI err
LAN err
×
GOOSE stop
Ping err
× (2)
× (2)
× (1)
×(1)
PLC stop
MAP stop
×
×
No-working of
LCD
× (2)
× (1)
Note: This table shows the relationship between messages displayed on the LCD
and the estimated failure location. Locations marked with (1) have a higher
probability than locations marked with (2).
⎯ 328 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
2. Methods of Replacing the Modules
CAUTION
When handling a module, take anti-static measures such as wearing an earthed
wrist band and placing modules on an earthed conductive mat. Otherwise, many
of the electronic components could suffer damage.
CAUTION
After replacing the SPM module, check all of the settings including the data
related the PLC, IEC103 and IEC61850, etc. are restored the original settings.
The initial replacement procedure is as follows:
1). Switch off the DC power supply.
WARNING
Hazardous voltage may remain in the DC circuit just after switching off the
DC power supply. It takes about 30 seconds for the voltage to discharge.
2). Remove the front panel cover.
3). Open the front panel.
Open the front panel of the relay by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of the
front panel.
Case size : 1/2”inchs
4). Detach the holding bar.
Detach the module holding bar by unscrewing the binding screw located on the left side of the
bar.
⎯ 329 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
5). Unplug the cables.
Unplug the ribbon cable running among the modules by nipping the catch (in case of black
connector) and by pushing the catch outside (in case of gray connector) on the connector.
Gray connector
Black connector
6). Pull out the module.
Pull out the failure module by pulling up or down the top and bottom levers (white).
SPM module
7). Insert the replacement module.
Insert the replacement module into the same slots where marked up.
.
8). Do the No.5 to No.1 steps in reverse order.
CAUTION
Supply DC power after checking that all the modules are in their original
positions and the ribbon cables are plugged in. If the ribbon cables are not
plugged in enough (especially the gray connectors), the module could suffer
damage.
Details of the gray connector on modules (top side)
○Enough
×Not enough
⎯ 330 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
9). Lamp Test
RESET
•
key is pushed 1 second or more by LCD display off.
•
It checks that all LCDs and LEDs light on.
10). Check the automatic supervision functions.
•
•
LCD not display “Auto-supervision” screens in turn, and Event Records
Checking the “IN SERVICE” LED light on and “ALARM LED” light off.
⎯ 331 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Appendix S
Ordering
⎯ 332 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Ordering
GRT100
D
Model 100 series
Type:
Transformer protection Relay
Model:
GRT100
-Model 100 series: 2 three-phase current inputs for
2-winding transformer
- 16 BIs, 13 BOs, 5 trip BOs
- 16 BIs, 23 BOs, 5 trip BOs
101
102
CT Rating:
1A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
CT Rating-2:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
Q
R
Single CT Rating
0
1
2
Mix, Primary:1A, Secondary: 5A
Mix, Primary:5A, Secondary: 1A
Communications:
RS485 + 100BASE-TX
RS485 + 100BASE-FX
Fibre optic + 100BASE-FX
Miscellaneous:
A
B
E
None
0
LED label:
Standard
None
J
Option: User configurable LED label
Note: Please inform us which is ordered panel surface mount type or 19-inch rack mount type.
In 19 inch rack mount type, please order optional attachment kit.
- for relay case Type-A attachment kit: EP101
⎯ 333 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
GRT100
D
Model 200 series
Type:
Transformer protection Relay
Model:
GRT100
-Model 200 series: 3 three-phase current inputs for
3-winding transformer
- 16 BIs, 13 BOs, 5 trip BOs
- 16 BIs, 23 BOs, 5 trip BOs
- 15 BIs (12-independent), 13 BOs, 3 trip BOs
- 15 BIs (12-independent), 23 BOs, 3 trip BOs
CT Rating:
201
202
203
204
1A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
1A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
B
C
D
E
F
1A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
5A, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
Mix, 50Hz, 110V/125Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 110V/125Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 220V/250Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 220V/250Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 48V/54V/60Vdc
Mix, 50Hz, 24V/30Vdc
Mix, 60Hz, 24V/30Vdc
CT Rating-2:
Q
R
Single CT Rating
0
1
2
3
Mix, Primary:1A, Secondary:5A, Tertiary:5A
Mix, Primary:5A, Secondary:1A, Tertiary:5A
Mix, Primary:1A, Secondary:1A, Tertiary:5A
Communications:
RS485 + 100BASE-TX
RS485 + 100BASE-FX
Fibre optic + 100BASE-FX
Miscellaneous:
A
B
E
None
0
LED label:
Standard
None
J
Option: User configurable LED label
Note: Please inform us which is ordered panel surface mount type or 19-inch rack mount type.
In 19 inch rack mount type, please order optional attachment kit.
- for relay case Type-A attachment kit: EP101
⎯ 334 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 F 2 S 0 8 5 7
Version-up Records
Version
No.
Date
Revised Section
Contents
0.0
1.0
Sep. 12, 2007
Apr. 14, 2008
--
2.2.2
3.1.3
First issue
Modified the description and Figure 2.2.2.1.
Modified the description.
4.2.6.4, 4.2.6.6
4.4.2
Modified the description.
Modified the description.
Precaution
4.2.2,4.2.6.2,4.2.7
Appendixes
2.2.5
Modified the description of ‘Disposal’.
Modified the description.(Add explanation of password for test screen.)
Modified Appendix E and S.
2.0
3.0
Jul. 31, 2009
Oct. 16, 2009
Modified the description and Table numbers.
2.3
Modified Figure 2.3.3. (Add “ ON” under the scheme switch)
2.5
Modified the description and Figure 2.5.1. (Add “ ON” under the scheme
switch)
Modified Figure 2.9.1. (Add “ ON” under the scheme switch)
Modified the description
Modified the description
2.9
2.10.6
3.1.3
Modified Appendix N.
Appendix
2.2.1
4.0
Dec. 11, 2009
Modified Table 2.2.1.1 and Figure 2.2.1.4.
⎯ 335 ⎯
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|
Taylor Juicer AJ 1450 BL User Manual
Texas Instruments Stereo System TMS320C2801 User Manual
Toyota Stove DTC P0135 User Manual
Tripp Lite Network Cables N002 020 GY User Manual
Troy Bilt Trimmer TB25CS User Manual
U Line Refrigerator 2075DWRR User Manual
United States Stove Furnace 1600EF User Manual
Vector Automobile Battery Charger VEC078 User Manual
ViewEra Computer Monitor V195MV User Manual
ViewSonic Projector PJ559D User Manual